Commercial Suggested Answers 1990 2006 Word
Commercial Suggested Answers 1990 2006 Word
Commercial Suggested Answers 1990 2006 Word
QUESTIONS IN
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 1 of 103
MERCANTILE LAW
ARRANGED BY TOPIC
(1990 2006)
Edited and Arranged by:
Silliman University College
of Law Batch 2005
Updated by:
Dondee
D BAR-Retake 2007
From the ANSWERS TO BAR EXAMINATION QUESTIONS bythe
UP LAW COMPLEX & PHILIPPINE ASSOCIATION OF LAW SCHOOLS
2005
June 27, 2007
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 2 of 103
F O R E W A R D
This work is not intended for sale or commerce. This work is freeware. It may be
freely copied and distributed. It is primarily intended for all those who desire to have a
deeper understanding of the issues touched by the Philippine Bar Examinations and its
trend. It is specially intended for law students from the provinces who, very often, are
recipients of deliberately distorted notes from other unscrupulous law schools and
students. Share to others this work and you will be richly rewarded by God in heaven.
It is also very good karma.
We would like to seek the indulgence of the reader for some Bar Questions which are
improperly classified under a topic and for some topics which are improperly or
ignorantly phrased, for the authors are just Bar Reviewees who have prepared this
work while reviewing for the Bar Exams under time constraints and within their
limited knowledge of the law. We would like to seek the readers indulgence for a lot
of typographical errors in this work.
The Authors
July 26, 2005
Updated: June
27, 2007
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 3 of 103
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Principles of Mercantile Law..............................................................................12
Commercial Transaction (2003) 12 Joint Account (2000) 12 Joint Account vs. Partnership (2000) 12 Theory of
Cognition vs. Theory of Manifestation (1997) 12
Banking Law...........................................................................................................................12
Banks: Applicability: Foreign Currency Deposit Act & Secrecy of Bank Deposits (2005) 12 Banks: Collateral
Security (2002) 12 Banks: Secrecy of Bank Deposits; Garnishment (2004) 13 Banks; Classifications of Banks
(2002) 13 Banks; Conservator vs. Receiver (2006) 13 Banks; Diligence Required (1992) 14 Banks; Insolvency;
Prohibited Transactions (2000) 14 Banks; Insolvency; Requirements (1997) 14 Banks; Restrictions on Loan
Accommodations (2002) 14 Banks; Restrictions on Loan Accommodations (2006) 15 Banks; Safety Deposit Box;
Liability 15 Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposit; AMLC (2006) 15 Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposit; Exceptions
(2006) 16 Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1990) 16 Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1991) 16 Banks;
Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1992) 17 Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1994) 17 Banks; Secrecy of Bank
Deposits (1995) 17 Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1998) 17 Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (2000) 18
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits; Exceptions (2004) 18 Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits; Garnishment (2001)
18 BSP; Receivership; Jurisdiction (1992) 18 Legal Tender (2000) 19 PDIC Law vs. Secrecy of Bank Deposits
Act (1997) 19 Responsibilities & Objectives of BSP (1998) 19 Truth in Lending Act (1991) 19 Truth in Lending
Act (2000) 19
Bulk Sales Law ......................................................................................................................20
Bulk Sales Law; Covered Transactions (1994) 20 Bulk Sales Law; Covered Transactions (2000) 20 Bulk Sales
Law; Covered Transactions (2006) 20 Bulk Sales Law; Exclusions (1993) 20 Bulk Sales Law; Obligation of the
Vendor (1995) 21 Bulk Sales Law; Obligation of the Vendor (1997) 21 Bulk Sales Law; Obligation of the Vendor
(2001) 21
Consumer Protection Law..................................................................................................21
Metric System Law (1994) 21
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 4 of 103 Corporation
Law....................................................................................................................22
BOD: Election of Aliens as members (2005) 22 BOD; Capacity of Directors (1996) 22 BOD; Compensation
(1991) 22 BOD; Conflict of Interest (1994) 22 BOD; Interlocking Directors (1995) 22 BOD; Interlocking Directors
(1996) 23 By-Laws; Validity; limiting qualifications of BOD members (1998) 23 By-Laws; Validity; limiting
qualifications of BOD members (2000) 23 By-Laws; Validity; limiting qualifications of BOD members (2001) 23
By-Laws; Validity; limiting qualifications of BOD members (2003) 24 Close Corporations; Deadlocks (1995) 24
Closed Corporation; Restriction; Transfer of shares (1994) 24 Controversy; Intra-Corporate (1994) 25
Controversy; Intra-Corporate (1996) 25 Controversy; Intra-Corporate (1996) 25 Controversy; Intra-Corporate
(2006) 25 Controversy; Intra-corporate; Jurisdiction (1997) 25 Corporation Sole; Definition (2004) 26
Corporation: Issuance of shares of stock to pay for the services (2005) 26 Corporation: Right of Repurchase of
Shares; Trust Fund Doctrine (2005) 26 Corporation: Sole Proprietorship (2004) 26 Corporation; Articles of
Incorporation (1990) 26 Corporation; Bulk Sales Law (2005) 27 Corporation; By-laws (2001) 28 Corporation;
Commencement; Corporate Existence (2003) 28 Corporation; Conversion of Stock Corporation (2001) 28
Corporation; De Facto Corporation (1994) 28 Corporation; Dissolution; Methods of Liquidation (2001) 28
Corporation; Incorporation; Requirements (2006) 28 Corporation; Incorporation; Requisites (2002) 29
Corporation; Meetings; BOD & Stockholders (1993) 29 Corporation; Nationality of Corporation (1998) 29
Corporation; Non-Stock Corporation (1993) 29 Corporation; Power to Invest Corporate Funds for other Purpose
(1995) 30 Corporation; Power to Invest Corporate Funds in another Corporation (1996) 30 Corporation;
Recovery of Moral Damages (1998) 30 Corporation; Separate Juridical Personality (1995) 31 Corporation;
Separate Juridical Personality (1996) 31 Corporation; Separate Juridical Personality (1996) 31 Corporation;
Separate Juridical Personality (1999) 31 Corporation; Separate Juridical Personality (2000) 32 Corporation;
Separate Juridical Personality (2000) 32 Corporation; Set-Off; Unpaid Subscription (1994) 32 Corporation; Stock
Corporation (2001) 32 Corporation; Validity of Corporate Acts (1998) 33 Corporation; Validity of Corporate Acts
(2002) 33 Corporation; Voluntary Dissolution (2002) 33 Corporation; Voting Trust Agreement (1992) 33
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 5 of 103
Derivative Suit: Requisites (2004) 34 Derivative Suit: Watered Stock (1993) 34 Derivative Suit; Close
Corporation; Corporate Opportunity (2005) 34 Derivative Suit; Minority Stockholder (2003) 35 Distinction: De
facto Corporation vs. Corporation by Estoppel (2004) 35 Distinction: Dividends vs. Profit: Cash Dividend vs.
Stock Dividend (2005) 35 Distinction; Private vs. Public Corporation (2004) 35 Distinction; Stock vs. Non-Stock
Corporation (2004) 36 Dividends: Declaration of Dividends (2005) 36 Dividends: Sources of Dividends; Trust
Fund Doctrine (2005) 36 Dividends; Declaration of Dividends (1990) 36 Dividends; Declaration of Dividends
(1991) 36 Dividends; Declaration of Dividends (2001) 36 Dividends; Right; Managing Corporation (1991) 37
Doctrine of Corporate Opportunity (2005) 37 Effect: Expiration of Corporate Term (2004) 37 Effects; Merger of
Corporations (1999) 37 Effects; Winding Up Period of a Corporation (1997) 38 Effects; Winding Up Period of a
Corporation (2000) 38 Foreign Corporation; Doing Business in the Philippines (1998) 38 Foreign Corporation;
Doing Business in the Philippines; Acts or Activities (2002) 38 Foreign Corporation; Doing Business in the
Philippines; Test (2002) 39 Joint Venture; Corporation (1996) 39 Liabilities; BOD; Corporate Acts (1996) 39
Liabilities; Stockholders, Directors, Officers (1997) 39 Piercing the Corporate Veil (1994) 39 Piercing the
Corporate Veil (1996) 40 Piercing the Corporate Veil (2001) 40 Piercing the Corporate Veil (2004) 40 Piercing
the Corporate Veil (2006) 40 Pre-emptive Right (2001) 40 Pre-Emptive Right vs. Appraisal Right (1999) 41 SEC;
Jurisdiction; Transferred Jurisdiction (1996) 41 Stockholder; Delinquent; Unpaid Subscription (1997) 41
Stockholders: Preemptive Right (2004) 42 Stockholders; Appraisal Right (2003) 42 Stockholders; Removal of
Officers & BOD (2001) 42 Stockholders; Removal; Minority Director (1991) 42 Stockholders; Rights (1996) 42
Stockholders; Voting Power of Stockholders (1990) 42 Stocks; Increase of Capital Stock (2001) 42 Stocks; Sale,
Transfer of Certificates of Stock (1996) 43 Stocks; Sale, Transfer of Certificates of Stock (2001) 43 Stocks; Sale,
Transfer of Certificates of Stock (2004) 43 Trust Fund Doctrine (1992) 43 Trust Fund Doctrine; Intra-Corporate
Controversy (1991) 43
Credit Transactions..............................................................................................................44
Chattel Mortgage vs. After-Incurred Obligations (1991) 44
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 6 of 103
Chattel Mortgage vs. After-Incurred Obligations (1999) 44 Chattel Mortgage; Foreclosure (1997) 44 Chattel
Mortgage; Ownership of Thing Mortgaged (1990) 45 Credit Transactions (1999) 45 Mortgage (1999) 45
Mortgage vs. Levy (2003) 46 Mortgage; Extrajudicial Foreclose (2006) 46 Mortgage; Foreclosure (2003) 46
Mortgage; Foreclosure (2003) 46 Mortgage; Foreclosure of Improvements (1999) 46 Mortgage; Foreclosure;
Effect of mere taking by creditor-mortgagor of property (1992) 47 Mortgage; Redemption Period; Foreclosed
Property (2002) 47 Mortgage; Remedies (2003) 48 Preference of Credits (2002) 48 Promissory Note: Liability
(2001) 48 Remedies; Available to Mortgagee-Creditor (1996) 48 Remedies; Available to Mortgagee-Creditor
(2001) 49 Remedies; Secured Debt (1991) 49
Insurance Law........................................................................................................................49
Beneficiary: Effects: Irrevocable Beneficiary (2005) 49 Beneficiary: Rights; Irrevocable Beneficiary (2005) 50
Beneficiary; Life Insurance; Prohibited Beneficiaries (1998) 50 Concealment; Material Concealment (2001) 50
Concealment; Material Concealment: Incontestability Clause (1994) 50 Concealment; Material Concealment:
Incontestability Clause (1996) 50 Concealment; Material Concealment: Incontestability Clause (1997) 51
Concealment; Material Concealment; Incontestability Clause (1991) 51 Concealment; Material Concealment;
Incontestability Clause (1998) 51 Insurable Interest: Bank Deposit (2000) 51 Insurable Interest: Public Enemy
(2000) 52 Insurable Interest: Separate Insurable Interest (1999) 52 Insurable Interest; Equitable Interest (1991)
52 Insurable Interest; Life vs. Property Insurance (1997) 52 Insurable Interest; Life vs. Property Insurance (2000)
52 Insurable Interest; Life vs. Property Insurance (2002) 53 Insurable Interest; Property Insurance (1994) 53
Insurable Interest; Property Insurance (2001) 53 Insurance; Cash & Carry Basis (2003) 53 Insurance;
Co-Insurance vs. Re-Insurance (1994) 53 Insurance; Double Insurance (2005) 54 Insurance; Double Insurance;
effect (1993) 54 Insurance; Effects; Payment of Premiums by Installment (2006) 54 Insurance; Life Insurance;
Assignment of Policy (1991) 54 Insurance; Perfection of Insurance Contracts (2003) 54 Insurance; Property
Insurance; Prescription of Claims (1996) 54 Insurance; Return of Premiums (2000) 55 Insured; Accident Policy
(2004) 55 Insured; Accident vs. Suicide (1990) 55
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 7 of 103
Insured; Accident vs. Suicide (1993) 56 Insured; Accident vs. Suicide (1995) 56 Insurer: Effects: Several Insurers
(2005) 56 Insurer; 3rd Party Liability (1996) 56 Insurer; 3rd Party Liability (2000) 57 Insurer; 3rd Party Liability;
No Fault Indemnity (1994) 57 Insurer; 3rd Party Liability; Quitclaim (1994) 57 Insurer; Authorized Driver Clause
(1991) 57 Insurer; Authorized Driver Clause (2003) 57 Insurer; Authorized Driver Clause; vehicle is stolen (1993)
58 Insurer; Group Insurance; Employer-Policy Holder (2000) 58 Insurer; Liability of the Insurers (1990) 58 Loss:
Actual Total Loss (1996) 59 Loss: Constructive Total Loss (2005) 59 Loss: Total Loss Only (1992) 59 Marine
Insurance; Implied Warranties (2000) 60 Marine Insurance; Peril of the Ship vs. Peril of the Sea (1998) 60 Mutual
Insurance Company; Nature & Definition (2006) 60
Intellectual Property .............................................................................................................60
Copyright (1995) 60 Copyright; Commissioned Artist (1995) 60 Copyright; Commissioned Artist (2004) 60
Copyright; Infringement (1994) 60 Copyright; Infringement (1997) 61 Copyright; Infringement (1998) 61
Copyright; Infringement (2006) 61 Copyright; Photocopy; when allowed (1998) 61 Infringement vs. Unfair
Competition (1996) 61 Infringement vs. Unfair Competition (2003) 61 Infringement; Jurisdiction (2003) 61 Patent;
Non-Patentable Inventions (2006) 61 Patents: Gas-Saving Device: first to file rule (2005) 62 Patents:
Infringement; Remedies & Defenses (1993) 62 Patents; Infringement (1992) 62 Patents; Rights over the
Invention (1990) 63 Trademark (1990) 63 Trademark (1994) 63 Trademark, Test of Dominancy (1996) 63
Trademark; Infringement (1991) 63 Trademark; Test of Dominancy (1996) 64 Tradename: International Affiliation
(2005) 64
Insolvency & Corporate Recovery ...................................................................................64
Insolvency vs. Suspension of Payment (1998) 64 Insolvency: Voluntary Insolvency (2005) 64 Insolvency; Assets
vs. Liabilities (1998) 65 Insolvency; Assignees (1996) 65 Insolvency; Effect; Declaration of Insolvency (1991) 65
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 8 of 103
Insolvency; Fraudulent Payment (2002) 65 Insolvency; Jurisdiction; Sole Proprietorship (1990) 66 Insolvency;
obligations that survive (1997) 66 Insolvency; Voluntary Insolvency Proceeding (1991) 66 Insolvency; Voluntary
vs. Involuntary Solvency (1995) 66 Law on Corporate Recovery (2003) 67 Rehabilitation; Stay Order (2006) 67
Suspension of Payment vs. Insolvency (1995) 67 Suspension of Payments vs. Stay Order (2003) 67 Suspension
of Payments; Rehabilitation Receiver (1999) 67 Suspension of Payments; Remedies (2003) 68
Letters of Credit ....................................................................................................................68
Letter of Credit: Mortgage (2005) 68 Letter of Credit; Certification from Consignee (1993) 68 Letters of Credit;
Liability of a confirming and notifying bank (1994) 69 Letters of Credit; Liability of a Notifying Bank (2003) 69
Letters of Credit; Three Distinct Contract Relationships (2002) 69
Maritime Commerce .............................................................................................................69
Average; Particular Average vs. General Average (2003) 69 Bottomry (1994) 70 Carriage of Goods: Deviation:
Liability (2005) 70 Carriage of Goods; Deviation; When Proper (2005) 70 Carriage of Goods; Exercise
Extraordinary Diligence (2005) 70 Charter Party (1991) 70 Charter Party (2004) 71 COGSA: Prescription of
Claims/Actions (2004) 71 COGSA; Prescription of Claims (1992) 71 COGSA; Prescription of Claims (2000) 72
COGSA; Prescriptive Period (1995) 72 Doctrine of Inscrutable Fault (1995) 72 Doctrine of Inscrutable Fault
(1997) 72 Doctrine of Inscrutable Fault (1998) 72 Limited Liability Rule (1994) 72 Limited Liability Rule (1997) 72
Limited Liability Rule (1999) 72 Limited Liability Rule (2000) 73 Limited Liability Rule; Doctrine of Inscrutable
Fault (1991) 73 Limited Liability Rule; General Average Loss (2000) 73 Limited Liability Rule; General Average
Loss (2000) 73
Nationalized Activities or Undertakings........................................................................74
Nationalized Activities or Undertakings (1993) 74 Nationalized Activities or Undertakings (1994) 74 Nationalized
Activities or Undertakings (1995) 75 Retail Trade Law (1990) 75 Retail Trade Law (1991) 75 Retail Trade Law
(1992) 75
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 9 of 103
Retail Trade Law (1993) 76 Retail Trade Law (1996) 76 Retail Trade Law (1996) 76 Retail Trade Law;
Consignment (1991) 76
Negotiable Instruments Law ..............................................................................................76
Bond: Cash Bond vs. Surety Bond (2004) 76 Checks: Crossed Checks (2005) 77 Checks: Crossed Checks vs.
Cancelled Checks (2004) 77 Checks; Crossed Check (1991) 77 Checks; Crossed Check (1994) 77 Checks;
Crossed Check (1995) 78 Checks; Crossed Check (1996) 78 Checks; Crossed Check (1996) 78 Checks; Effect;
Acceptance by the drawee bank (1998) 78 Checks; Effects; Alterations; Prescriptive Period (1996) 78 Checks;
Forged Check; Effects (2006) 79 Checks; Liability; Drawee Bank (1995) 80 Checks; Material Alterations; Liability
(1999) 80 Checks; Presentment (1994) 80 Checks; Presentment (2003) 80 Checks; Validity; Waiver of Banks
liability for negligence (1991) 80 Defenses; Forgery (2004) 81 Forgery; Liabilities; Prior & Subsequent Parties
(1990) 81 Forgery; Liabilities; Prior & Subsequent Parties (1995) 81 Incomplete & Delivered (2004) 82
Incomplete and Delivered (2005) 82 Incomplete Instruments; Incomplete Delivered Instruments vs. Incomplete
Undelivered Instrument (2006) 82 Indorser: Irregular Indorser vs. General Indorser (2005) 82 Negotiability (1993)
82 Negotiability (2002) 83 Negotiability; Holder in Due Course (1992) 83 Negotiability; Requisites (2000) 83
Negotiable Instrument: Ambiguous Instruments (1998) 84 Negotiable Instrument: Definition & Characteristics
(2005) 84 Negotiable Instrument: Identification (2005) 84 Negotiable Instrument: Negotiable Document vs.
Negotiable Instrument (2005) 85 Negotiable Instrument; Negotiability (1997) 85 Negotiable Instruments; Bearer
Instrument (1998) 85 Negotiable Instruments; Bearer Instruments (1997) 85 Negotiable Instruments; bearer
instruments; liabilities of maker and indorsers (2001) 85 Negotiable Instruments; incomplete and undelivered
instruments; holder in due course (2000) 86 Negotiable Instruments; Incomplete Delivered Instruments;
Comparative Negligence (1997) 86 Negotiable Instruments; kinds of negotiable instrument; words of negotiability
(2002) 86 Negotiable Instruments; Requisites (1996) 87 Notice Dishonor (1996) 87 Parties; Accommodation
Party (1990) 87 Parties; Accommodation Party (1991) 87 Parties; Accommodation Party (1996) 87
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 10 of 103
Parties; Accommodation Party (1998) 87 Parties; Accommodation Party (2003) 88 Parties; Accommodation
Party (2003) 88 Parties; Accommodation Party (2005) 88 Parties; Holder in Due Course (1993) 88 Parties;
Holder in Due Course (1996) 88 Parties; Holder in Due Course (1996) 88 Parties; Holder in Due Course (1998)
89 Parties; Holder in Due Course; Indorsement in blank (2002) 89 Place of Payment (2000) 89
Public Service Law ...............................................................................................................89
Certificate of public Convenience (1998) 89 Certificate of Public Convenience; inseparability of certificate and
vessel (1992) 90 Certificate of Public Convenience; Requirements (1995) 90 Powers of the Public Service
Commission (1993) 90 Public utilities (2000) 90 Revocation of Certificate (1993) 91 Revocation of Certificate
(1993) 91
Securities Regulation ..........................................................................................................91
Insider (2004) 91 Insider Trading (1995) 91 Insider Trading; Manipulative Practices (1994) 92 Manipulative
Practices (2001) 92 Securities Regulation Code; Purpose (1998) 92 Securities; Definition (1996) 92 Securities;
Selling of Securities; Meaning (2002) 92 Tender Offer (2002) 93
Transportation Law ..............................................................................................................93
Boundary System (2005) 93 Carriage; Breach of Contract; Presumption of Negligence (1990) 93 Carriage;
Breach of Contract; Presumption of Negligence (1997) 93 Carriage; Fortuitous Event (1995) 93 Carriage;
Liability; Lost Baggage or Acts of Passengers (1997) 94 Carriage; Prohibited & Valid Stipulations (2002) 94
Carriage; Valuation of Damaged Cargo (1993) 94 Common Carrier (1996) 94 Common Carrier; Breach of
Contract; Damages (2003) 94 Common Carrier; Defenses (2002) 95 Common Carrier; Defenses; Fortuitous
Events (1994) 95 Common Carrier; Defenses; Limitation of Liability (1998) 95 Common Carrier; Defenses;
Limitation of Liability (2001) 95 Common Carrier; Duration of Liability (1996) 95 Common Carrier; Duty to
Examine Baggages; Railway and Airline (1992) 96 Common Carrier; Test (1996) 96 Common Carriers; Defenses
(1996) 96 Common Carriers; Liability for Loss (1991) 96
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 11 of 103
Common vs. Private Carrier; Defenses (2002) 97 Kabit System (2005) 97 Kabit System; Agent of the Registered
Owner (2005) 97 Maritime Commerce; Bareboat (2003) 97 Prior Operator Rule (2003) 97 Registered Owner;
Conclusive Presumption (1990) 98 Trans-Shipment; Bill of Lading; binding contract (1993) 98
Trust Receipts Law...............................................................................................................98
Trust Receipts Law; Acts & Omissions; Covered (2006) 98 Trust Receipts Law; Liability for estafa (1991) 99
Trust Receipts Law; Liability for Estafa (1997) 99 Trusts Receipt Law (2003) 99
Usury Law ...............................................................................................................................99
Usury Law (199) 99
Warehouse Receipts Law .................................................................................................100
Bill of Lading (1998) 100 Delivery of Goods; Requisites (1998) 100 Delivery of the Goods (1991) 100
Garnishment or Attachment of Goods (1999) 100 Negotiable Documents of Title (1992) 100 Ownership of Goods
Stored (1992) 101 Right to the Goods (2005) 101 Unpaid Seller; Negotiation of the Receipt (1993) 101 Validity of
stipulations excusing warehouseman from negligence (2000) 101
Miscellaneous ......................................................................................................................102
Energy Regulatory Commission: Jurisdiction & Power (2004) 102 Four ACID Problems of Philippine Judiciary
(2006) 102 Government Deregulation vs. Privatization of an Industry (2004) 102 Political Law; WTO (1999) 102
Power of the State: Regulating of Domestic Trade (2004) 103 Tariff and Customs Code: Violation of Customs
Laws (2004) 103
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
General Principles of
Mercantile Law
Commercial Transaction (2003)
What do you understand by the term commercial
transaction? Is it essential that at least one party to a
contract be a merchant in order to consider such a
commercial transaction? (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A Commercial transaction is defined as ...... It is not
essential that at least one party to the commercial
transaction be a merchant. What is essential is that the
transaction evince an intent to engage in commerce or
trade.
Joint Account (2000)
What is a joint account? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A joint account is a transaction of merchants where other
merchants agree to contribute the amount of capital agreed
upon, and participating in the favorable or unfavorable
results thereof in the proportion they may determine.
Joint Account vs. Partnership (2000)
Distinguish joint account from partnership. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The following are the distinctions between joint account
and partnership:
(1) A partnership has a firm name while a joint account
has none and is conducted in the name of the ostensible
partner.
(2) While a partnership has juridical personality and may
sue or be sued under its firm name, a joint account has no
juridical personality and can sue or be sued only in the
name of the ostensible partner.
(3) While a partnership has a common fund, a joint
account has none.
(4) While in a partnership, all general partners have the
right of management, in a joint account, the ostensible
partner manages its business operations.
(5) While liquidations of a partnership may, by
agreement, be entrusted to a partner or partners, in a joint
account liquidation thereof can only be done by the
ostensible partner.
Theory of Cognition vs. Theory of Manifestation (1997)
The Civil Code adopts the theory of cognition, while the
Code of Commerce generally recognizes the theory of
manifestation, in the perfection of contracts. How do
these two theories differ?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Under the theory of cognition, the acceptance is considered
to effectively bind the offeror only from the time it came to
his knowledge. Under the theory of manifestation, the
contract is perfected at the moment when the acceptance is
declared or made by the offeree.
Page 12 of 103
Banking Law
Banks: Applicability: Foreign Currency Deposit Act &
Secrecy of Bank Deposits (2005)
Hi Yielding Corporation filed a complaint against five of its
officers for violation of Section 31 of the Corporation
Code. The corporation claimed that the said officers were
guilty of advancing their personal interests to the prejudice
of the corporation, and that they were grossly negligent in
handling its affairs. Aside from documents and contracts,
the corporation also submitted in evidence records of the
officers U.S. Dollar deposits in several banks overseas -
Boston Bank, Bank of Switzerland, and Bank of New
York.
For their part, the officers filed a criminal complaint
against the directors of Hi Yielding Corporation for
violation of Republic Act No. 6426, otherwise known as
the Foreign Currency Deposit Act of the Philippines. The
officers alleged that their bank deposits were illegally
disclosed for want of a court order, and that such deposits
were not even the subject of the case against them. a)
Will the complaint filed against the directors of Hi
Yielding Corporation prosper? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, because the Foreign Currency Deposit Act (R.A. No.
6426), including its punitive provisions, refers to foreign
currency deposits accounts constituted within the
Philippines. It has no application at all to accounts, even
though they are banks, opened and constituted abroad.
b) Was there a violation of the Secrecy of Bank
Deposits Law (Republic Act No. 1405)? Explain.
(5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, because the punitive provisions of the Secrecy of Bank
Deposits Law (R.A. No. 1405), including the statutory
exemptions provided therein, are not applicable to FCDU
accounts, even when constituted locally. (Intengan v. Court of
Appeals, G.R. No. 128996, February 15, 2002)
Banks: Collateral Security (2002)
Andrew is engaged in the business of building low-cost
housing units under contracts with real estate developers.
He applied for a loan of P3 Million from Ready Credit
Bank (the Bank), which required Andrew to provide
collateral security for it. Andrew offered to assign to the
Bank his receivables amounting to P4 million from Home
Builders Development Corporation (the Obligor). The
Bank accepted the offer. Accordingly, Andrew obtained
the loan and he executed a promissory note undertaking to
pay the loan in full in one lump sum on September 1, 2002,
together with interest thereon at the rate of 20% per
annum. At the same time, Andrew executed a Deed of
Assignment in favor of the Bank assigning to the Bank his
receivables from the Obligor. The deed of assignment read:
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
I, Andrew Lee, hereby assign, transfer and convey,
absolutely and unconditionally, to Ready Credit Bank
(hereinafter called the Bank) all of my right, title and
interest in and to my accounts receivable from Home
Builders Development Corporation (hereinafter called the
Obligor) arising from delivery of housing units with a total
contract price of P4,000,000.00, the description and
contract value of which are attached hereto as Annex A
(hereinafter called the Receivables).
In the event that I shall be unable to pay my outstanding
indebtedness owned to the Bank, the Bank shall have the
right, without any further formality or act on its part, to
collect the Receivables from the Obligor and to apply the
proceeds thereof toward payment of my said
indebtedness.
Andrew failed to pay the loan on its due date on
September 1, 2002. When the Bank attempted to collect
from the Obligor, the Bank discovered that the latter had
already closed operations and liquidated all its assets. The
Bank sued Andrew for collection, but Andrew moved to
dismiss the complaint on the ground that the debt had
already been paid by reason of his execution of the
aforesaid Deed of Assignment which, being absolute and
unconditional, was in essence a dacion en pago. The Bank
opposed the motion, contending that the Deed of
Assignment was only a security for a loan. If you were the
Judge, how would you resolve the motion to dismiss filed
by Andrew? Explain (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
(Since the question is outside the scope of the Bar Examination,
it is recommended that the candidate be given full credit of 5%,
whatever may be his answer, and he be given a bonus if he made
an answer in the following manner:)
The motion to dismiss should be granted. The simple
absolute and unconditional conveyance embodied in the
deed of assignment would be operative, and the assignment
would constitute essentially a mode of payment or dacion
en pago.
Banks: Secrecy of Bank Deposits; Garnishment (2004)
CDC maintained a savings account with CBank. On orders
of the MM Regional Trial Court, the Sheriff garnished
P50,000 of his account, to satisfy the judgment in favor of
his creditor, MO. CDC complained that the garnishment
violated the Law on the Secrecy of Bank Deposits because
the existence of his savings account was disclosed to the
public. (5%) Is CDC's complaint meritorious or not?
Reason briefly.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. CDC's complaint is not meritorious. It was held in
China Banking Corporation v. Ortega, 49 SCRA 355 (1973)
that peso deposits may be garnished and the depositary
bank can comply with the order of garnishment without
violating the Law on the Secrecy of Bank Deposits.
Execution is the goal of litigation as it is its fruit.
Garnishment is part of the execution process. Upon
service of the notice of garnishment on the bank where the
defendant deposited funds, such funds become part of the
subject matter of litigation.
Page 13 of 103
Banks; Classifications of Banks (2002)
There are six (6) classes of banks identified in the General
Banking Law of 2000. Name at least four (4) of them and
explain the distinguishing characteristic or function of each
one. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Any four (4) of the following six (6) classes of banks
identified in the General Banking Law of 2002, to wit:
1 Universal Banks These are those which used
to be called expanded commercial banks and the operations
of which are now primarily governed by the General
Banking Law of 2002. They can exercise the powers of an
investment house and invest in non-allied enterprises. They
have the highest capitalization requirement.
2 Commercial Banks These are ordinary or
regular commercial banks, as distinguished from a universal
bank. They have a lower capitalization requirement than
universal banks and cannot exercise the powers of an
investment house and invest in non-allied enterprises.
3 Thrift Banks These banks (such as savings and
mortgage banks, stock savings and loan associations, and
private development banks) may exercise most of the
powers and functions of a commercial bank except that
they cannot, among others, open current or check accounts
without prior Monetary Board approval, and they cannot
issue letters of credit. Their operations are governed
primarily by the Thrift Banks Act of 1995 (RA 7906).
4 Rural Banks these are those which are
organized primarily to extend loans and other credit
facilities to farmers, fishermen or farm families, as well as
cooperatives, merchants, and private and public employees
and whose operations are primarily governed by the Rural
Banks Act of 1992 (RA 7353).
5 Cooperative Banks these are those which are
organized primarily to provide financial and credit services
to cooperatives and whose operations are primarily
governed by the Cooperative Code of the Philippines (RA
6938).
6 Islamic Banks these are those which are
organized primarily to provide financial and credit services
in a manner or transaction consistent with the Islamic
Shariah. At present, only the Al Amanah Islamic
Investment Bank of the Philippines has been organized as
an Islamic Bank.
Banks; Conservator vs. Receiver (2006)
Distinguish between the role of a conservator and that of
a receiver of a bank. (2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The Conservator is appointed for a period not exceeding
one (1) year, to take charge of the assets, liabilities, and the
management of a bank or a quasi-bank in a state of
continuing inability, or unwillingness to maintain a
condition of liquidity deemed adequate to protect the
interest of depositors and creditors. On the other hand, the
Receiver is appointed to manage a bank or quasi-bank that
is unable to pay its liabilities in
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
the ordinary course of business, or has insufficient
realizable assets to meet its liabilities, or cannot continue in
business without probable losses to its depositors or
creditors; or has willfully violated a final cease and desist
order, involving acts or transactions amounting to fraud or
a dissipation of the assets of the institution. The main
purpose of the Receiver is to recommend the rehabilitation
or liquidation of the bank.
Banks; Diligence Required (1992)
Placido, a bank depositor, left his checkbook on his desk
at his house. Unknown to him, a visitor at the time,
noticing the same, took a check therefrom, filled it up in
the amount of P3,000.00 and succeeded in encashing the
check on the same day. Placidos account was thereby
debited in the same amount.
Discovering the erroneous debit, Placido demanded that
the bank credit him with a like amount. The bank refused
on the ground that Placido was negligent in leaving his
checkbook on his desk so that he could not put up the
defense of forgery or want of authority under the NIL.
The Facts disclose that even to the naked eye, there were
marked differences between Placidos signature and the
one in the check forged by the visitor. As between Placido
and the bank, who should bear the loss? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The bank should bear the loss. A drawee bank must
exercise the highest diligence in safeguarding the accounts
of its client-depositors. The bank is also charged with
genuineness of the signatures of its current account holders.
But what can be more striking is that there were marked
differences between Placidos signature and the one in the
check forged by the visitor. Certainly, Placido was not
negligent in leaving his checkbook in his own desk (PNB v
Quimpo 158 SCRA 582)
Banks; Insolvency; Prohibited Transactions (2000)
The Monetary Board of the BSP closed Urban Bank after
it encountered crippling financial difficulties that resulted
in a bank run. X, one of the members of the BOD of the
bank, attended and stayed throughout the entire meeting of
the Board that was held well in advance of the bank run
and before news had begun to trickle to the business
community about the dire financial pit the bank had fallen
into. Immediately after the meeting, X caused the
preparation and issuance of a managers check payable to
himself in the sum of 5 million pesos equivalent to the
amount placed or invested in the bank by a business
acquaintance. He now claims that he is keeping the funds
in trust for the owner and that he had committed no
violation of the General Banking Act (RA 337, as
amended) for which he should be punished. Do you agree
that there has been no violation of the statute? (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. I do not agree that there is no violation of the statute
(RA 337, as amended). X violated Sec 85 when he caused
the preparation and issuance of a managers check
Page 14 of 103 payable to himself in the sum of P5
million. This is paying out or permitting to be paid out
funds of the bank after the latter became insolvent. This
act is penalized by fine of not less than P1,000.00 nor
more than P10,000.00 and by imprisonment for not less
than two nor more than ten years.
Banks; Insolvency; Requirements (1997)
Give the basic requirements to be complied with by the
BSP before the Monetary Board can declare a bank
insolvent, order it closed and forbid it from doing further
business in the Philippines.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Before the Monetary Board can declare a bank insolvent,
order it closed and forbid it from doing further business
in the Philippines, the following basic requirements must
be complied with by the BSP, to wit:
1 There must be an examination by the head of the
Department of Supervision or his examiners or agents into
the condition of the bank.
2 The examination discloses that the condition of
the bank is one of insolvency, or that its continuance in
business would involve probable loss to creditors or
depositors.
3 The head of said Department shall inform in
writing the Monetary Board of such facts.
4 Upon finding said information or statement to be
true, the Monetary Board shall appoint a receiver to take
charge of the assets and liabilities of the bank.
5 Within 60 days, the Monetary Board shall
determine and confirm if the bank is insolvent, and public
interest requires, to order the liquidation of the bank.
Banks; Restrictions on Loan Accommodations (2002)
As part of the safeguards against imprudent banking, the
General Banking Law imposes limits or restrictions on
loans and credit accommodations which may be extended
by banks. Identify at least two (2) of these limits or
restrictions and explain the rationale of each of them. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Any two (2) of the following limits or restrictions on loan
and credit transactions which may be extended by banks,
as part of the safeguards against imprudent banking, to
wit:
1 SBL Rules (i.e., Single Borrowers Limit) rules
are those promulgated by the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas,
upon the authority of Section 35 of the General Banking
Law of 2000, which regulate the total amount of loans,
credit accommodations and guarantees that may be
extended by a bank to any person, partnership, association,
corporation or other entity. The rules seek to protect a
bank from making excessive loans to a single borrower by
prohibiting it from lending beyond a specified ceiling.
2 DOSRI Rules These rules promulgated by the
BSP, upon authority of Section 5 of the General Banking
Law of 2000, which regulate the amount of credit
accommodations that a bank may extend to its
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
directors, officers, stockholders and their related
interests (thus, DOSRI). Generally, a banks credit
accommodations to its DOSRI must be in the regular
course of business and on terms not less favorable to
the bank than those offered to non-DOSRI
borrowers.
3. No commercial bank shall make any loan or
discount on the security of shares of its own capital stock.
Banks; Restrictions on Loan Accommodations (2006)
Pio is the president of Western Bank. His wife applied for
a loan with the said bank to finance an internet cafe. The
loan officer told her that her application will not be
approved because the grant of loans to related interests of
bank directors, officers, and stockholders is prohibited by
the General Banking Law. Explain whether the loan
officer is correct. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Section 36 of the General Banking Law of 2000 does not
entirely prohibit directors or officers of the bank, directly
or indirectly, from borrowing from the bank. In this case,
Pio is the president of Western Bank, which makes him an
officer, director and stockholder of the said bank. The
General Banking Law provides for additional restrictions
to the bank before it can lend to its directors or officers. A
written approval of the majority vote of all the directors of
the bank, excluding the director concerned, is required.
Furthermore, such dealings must be upon terms not less
favorable to the bank than those offered to others (Section
1326, Central Bank's "Manual of Regulations for Banks and
Other Financial Intermediaries, cited in Ranioso v. CA, G.R. No.
117416, December 8, 2000). A violation of this provision will
cause his or her position to be declared vacant and the
erring director or officer subjected to the penal provisions
of the New Central Bank Act.
Banks; Safety Deposit Box; Liability
MN and OP rented a safety deposit box at SIBANK. The
parties signed a contract of lease with the conditions that:
the bank is not a depository of the contents of the safe
and has neither the possession nor control of the same;
the bank assumed no interest in said contents and assumes
no liability in connection therewith. The safety deposit box
had two keyholes: one for the guard key which remained
with the bank; and the other for the renters' key. The box
can be opened only with the use of both keys. The renters
deposited certificates of title in the box. But later, they
discovered that the certificates were gone. MN and OP
now claim for damages from SIBANK. Is the bank liable?
Explain briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The bank is liable, based on the decisions of the Supreme
Court in CA Agro-Industrial Development Corp. v. Court of Appeals,
219 SCRA 426 (1993) and Sia v. Court of Appeals, 222 SCRA 24
(1993). In those cases, the Supreme Court ruled that the
renting out of safety deposit boxes is a "special kind of
deposit" wherein the bank is the depositary. In the absence
of any stipulation prescribing the degree of diligence
required, that of a good father of a family is to be
Page 15 of 103 observed by the depositary. Any
stipulation exempting the depositary from any liability
arising from the loss of the thing deposited would be void
for being contrary to law and public policy. The deposit
box is located in the bank premises and is under the
absolute control of the bank.
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposit; AMLC (2006)
Rudy is jobless but is reputed to be a jueteng operator. He
has never been charged or convicted of any crime. He
maintains several bank accounts and has purchased 5
houses and lots for his children from the Luansing Realty,
Inc. Since he does not have any visible job, the company
reported his purchases to the Anti-Money Laundering
Council (AMLC). Thereafter, AMLC charged him with
violation of the Anti-Money Laundering Law. Upon
request of the AMLC, the bank disclosed to it Rudy's bank
deposits amounting to P100 Million. Subsequently, he was
charged in court for violation of the Anti-Money
Laundering Law.
1. Can Rudy move to dismiss the case on the ground that
he has no criminal record? (2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. Under the Anti-Money Laundering Law, Rudy would
be guilty of a "money laundering crime" committed when
the proceeds of an "unlawful activity," like jueteng
operations, are made to appear as having originated from
legitimate sources. The money laundering crime is separate
from the unlawful activity of being a jueteng operator, and
requires no previous conviction for the unlawful activity
(See also Sec. 3, Anti-Money Laundering Act of 2001).
2. To raise funds for his defense, Rudy sold the houses and
lots to a friend. Can Luansing Realty, Inc. be compelled to
transfer to the buyer ownership of the houses and lots?
(2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Luansing Realty, Inc. is a real estate company, hence it is
not a covered institution under Section 3 of the
Anti-Money Laundering Act. Only banking institutions,
insurance companies, securities dealers and brokers,
pre-need companies and other entities administering or
otherwise dealing in currency, commodities or financial
derivatives are covered institutions. Hence, Luansing
Realty, Inc. may not use the Anti-Money Laundering Act to
refuse to transfer to the buyer ownership of the houses and
lots.
3. In disclosing Rudy's bank accounts to the AMLC, did
the bank violate any law? (2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, the bank did not violate any law. The bank being
specified as a "covered institution" under the Anti-Money
Laundering Law, is obliged to report to the AMLC covered
and suspicious transactions, without thereby violating any
law. This is one of the exceptions to the Secrecy of Bank
Deposit Act.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
4. Supposing the titles of the houses and lots are in
possession of the Luansing Realty, Inc., is it under
obligation to deliver the titles to Rudy? (2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, it has an obligation to deliver titles to Rudy. As
Luansing Realty, Inc. is not a covered institution under
Section 3 of the Anti-Money Laundering Act, it may not
invoke this law to refuse delivery of the titles to Rudy.
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposit; Exceptions (2006)
Under Republic Act No.1405 (The Bank Secrecy Law),
bank deposits are considered absolutely confidential and
may not be examined, inquired or looked into by any
person, government official, bureau or office. What are
the exceptions? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The exceptions to the Bank Secrecy Law are the following:
1. Special or general examination of a bank,
authorized by the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas' Monetary
Board, in connection with a bank fraud or serious
irregularity.
2. Examination by an independent Auditor, hired
by the Bank and for the Bank's exclusive use.
3. Disclosure with the Depositor's written permission.
In case of Impeachment.
In cases of Bribery or dereliction of duty by a
Public Officer, upon order of a competent court.
In cases of money deposited/invested which, in
turn, is the subject of Litigation, upon order of a
competent Court.
4. DOSRI Loans: Loans with their Banks of Bank
Directors, Officers, Stockholders and related interests.
Loans in excess of 5% of the Bank's Capital &
Surplus
The Borrower waived his right as regards the
Secrecy of Bank Deposits
5. Violation of the Anti-Graft and Corrupt
Practices Act.
6. Coup d' etat Law (RA 6968, Oct
24,1990).
7. BIR Commissioner's authority to verify a
decedent's Gross Estate and a taxpayer's request for a
compromise agreement due to incapacity to pay his tax
liability.
8. Foreign Currency Deposits by foreign lenders &
investors under PDs 1034.
9. Violations of the Anti-Money Laundering
Law.
10. When the State exercises/invokes its Police
Power. (NOTA BENE: It is suggested that any 6 of the above be
given full credit)
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1990)
Manosa, a newspaper columnist, while making a deposit in
a bank, overheard a pretty bank teller informing a co-
employee that Gigi, a well known public official, has just a
few hundred pesos in her bank account and that her next
check will in all probability bounce. Manosa wrote this
information in his newspaper column. Thus, Gigi
Page 16 of 103 filed a complaint with the City Fiscal of
Manila for unlawfully disclosing information about her
bank account. a) Will the said suit prosper? Explain your
answer.
b) Supposing that Gigi is charged with unlawfully acquiring
wealth under RA 1379 and that the fiscal issued a subpoena
duces tecum for the records of the bank account of Gigi. May
Gigi validly oppose the said issuance on the ground that
the same violates the law on secrecy of bank deposits?
Explain your answer.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) The Secrecy of Bank Deposits Act prohibits, subject to
its exclusionary clauses, any person from examining,
inquiring or looking into all deposits of whatever nature
with banks or banking institutions in the Philippines which
by law are declared absolutely confidential in nature.
Manosa who merely overheard what appeared to be a
vague remark of a Bank employee to a co-employee and
writing the same in his newspaper column is neither the
inquiry nor disclosure contemplated by law.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
a) The complaint against Manosa will not prosper because
merely writing a vague remark of a Bank employee to a
co-employee is not the disclosure contemplated by law. If
anyone should be liable, it will be the bank employee who
disclosed the information.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
b) Among the instances excepted from the coverage of the
Secrecy of Bank Deposits Act are Anti-graft cases. Hence
Gigi may not validly oppose the issuance of a subpoena duces
tecum for the bank records on her.
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1991)
The law (RA 6832) creating a Commission to conduct a
Thorough Fact-Finding Investigation of the Failed Coup
detat of Dec 1989, Recommend Measures to Prevent the
Occurrence of Similar Attempts At a Violent Seizure of
Power and for Other Purposes, provides that the
Commission may ask the Monetary Board to disclose
information on and/or to grant authority to examine any
bank deposits, trust or investment funds, or banking
transactions in the name of and/or utilized by a person,
natural or juridical, under investigation by the Commission,
in any bank or banking institution in the Philippines, when
the Commission has reasonable ground to believe that said
deposits, trust or investment funds, or banking transactions
have been used in support or in furtherance of the
objectives of the said coup detat. Does the above provision
not violate the Law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits (RA
1405)?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The Law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits is itself merely a
statutory enactment, and it may, therefore, be modified, or
amended (such as by providing further exceptions
therefrom), or even repealed, expressly or impliedly, by a
subsequent law. The Secrecy of Bank Deposits Act did not
amount to a contract between the depositors and
depository banks within the meaning of the
non-impairment clause of the Constitution. Even if it did,
the police power of the State is superior to the non-
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
impairment clause. RA 6832, creating a commission to
conduct an investigation of the failed 1989 coup detat and
to recommend measures to prevent similar attempts to
seize power is a valid exercise of police power.
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1992)
Socorro received $10,000 from a foreign bank although she
was entitled only to $1,000.00. In an apparent plan to
conceal the erroneously sent amount, she opened a dollar
account with her local bank, deposited the $10,000 and
issued 4 checks in the amount of $2,000 and 1 check for
$1,000 each payable to different individuals who deposited
the same in their respective dollar accounts with different
local banks.
The sender bank then brought a civil suit before the RTC
for the recovery of the erroneously sent amount. In the
course of the trial, the sender presented testimonies of
bank officials to show that the funds were, in fact,
deposited in a bank by Socorro and paid out to several
persons, who participated in the concealment and
dissipation of the amount that Socorro had erroneously
received.
Socorro moved to strike out said testimonies from the
record invoking the law on secrecy of bank deposits. If
you were the Judge, would you issue an order to strike
them out? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
I will not strike out the testimonies from the record. The
testimonies of bank officials indicating where the
questioned dollar accounts were opened in depositing
misappropriated sums must be considered as likewise
involved in litigation one which is among the excepted
cases under the Secrecy of Bank Deposits Act (Melon Bank
v Magsino 190 SCRA 633)
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1994)
Miguel, a special customs agent is charged before the
Ombudsman with having acquired property out of
proportion to his salary, in violation of the Anti-Graft and
Corrupt Practices Act. The Ombudsman issued a subpoena
duces tecum to the Banco de Cinco commanding its
representative to furnish the Ombudsman records of
transactions by or in the name of Miguel, his wife and
children. A second subpoena was issued expanding the
first by including the production of records of friends of
Miguel in said bank and in all its branches and extension
offices, specifically naming them.
Miguel moved to quash the subpoenas arguing that they
violate the Secrecy of Bank Deposits Law. In addition, he
contends that the subpoenas are in the nature of fishing
expedition or general warrants and are constitutionally
impermissible with respect to private individuals who are not
under investigation. Is Miguels contention tenable?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. Miguels contention is not tenable. The inquiry into
illegally acquired property extends to cases where such
property is concealed by being held by or recorded in the
Page 17 of 103 name of other persons. To sustain
Miguels theory and restrict the inquiry only to property
held by or in the name of the government official would
make available to persons in government who illegally
acquire property an easy means of evading prosecution.
All they have to do would be to simply place the property
in the name of persons other than their spouses and
children (Banco Filipino Savings vs. Purisima 161 scra 576; Sec 8
Anti-Graft Law as amended by BP 195)
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1995)
Michael withdrew without authority funds of the
partnership in the amounts of P500th and US$50th for
services he claims he rendered for the benefit of the
partnership. He deposited the P500th in his personal peso
current account with Prosperity Bank and the US$50th in
his personal foreign currency savings account with Eastern
Bank.
The partnership instituted an action in court against
Michael, Prosperity, and Eastern to compel Michael to
return the subject funds to the partnership and pending
litigation to order both banks to disallow any withdrawal
from his accounts.
At the initial hearing of the case the court ordered
Prosperity to produce the records of Michaels peso
current account, and Eastern to produce the records of his
foreign currency savings account.
Can the court compel Prosperity and Eastern to disclose
the bank deposits of Michael? Discuss fully.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, as far as the peso account is concerned. Sec 2 of RA
1405 allows the disclosure of bank deposits in case where
the money deposited is the subject matter of litigation.
Since the case filed against Michael is aimed at recovering
the amount he withdrew from the funds of the partnership,
which amount he allegedly deposited in his account, a
disclosure of his bank deposits would be proper.
No, with respect to the foreign currency account. Under
the Foreign Currency Law, the exemption to the
prohibition against disclosure of information concerning
bank deposits is the written consent of the depositor.
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (1998)
1998 (20) An insurance company is deluded into releasing a
check to A for P35th to pay for Treasury Bills (T-bills)
which A claims to be en route on board an armored truck
from a government bank. The check is delivered to A who
deposits it to his account with XYZ Bank before the
insurance company realizes it is a scam. Upon such
realization, the insurance company files an action against A
for recovery of the amount defrauded and obtains a writ of
preliminary attachment. In addition to the writ, the Bank is
also served a subpoena to examine the account records of
A. The Bank declines to provide any information in
response to the writ and moves to quash the subpoena
invoking secrecy of bank
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
deposits under RA 1405, as amended. Can the Bank
justifiably invoke RA 1405 and a) not respond to the writ
and b) quash the subpoena for examination? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. Whether the transaction is considered a sale or money
placement does not make the money subject matter of
litigation within the meaning of Sec 2 of RA 1405 which
prohibits the disclosure or inquiry into bank deposit
except in cases where the money deposited or invested is
the subject matter of litigation nor will it matter whether
the money was swindled.
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits (2000)
GP is a suspected jueteng lord who is rumored to be
enjoying police and military protection. The envy of many
drug lords who had not escaped the dragnet of the law, GP
was summoned to a hearing of the Committee on
Racketeering and Other Syndicated Crimes of the House of
Representatives, which was conducting a congressional
investigation in aid of legislation on the involvement of
police and military personnel, and possibly even of local
government officials, in the illegal activities of suspected
gambling and drug lords. Subpoenaed to attend the
investigation were officers of certain identified banks with a
directive to them to bring the records and documents of
bank deposits of individuals mentioned in the subpoenas,
among them GP. GP and the banks opposed the
production of the banks records of deposits on the ground
that no such inquiry is allowed under the Law on Secrecy of
Bank Deposits (RA 1405 as amended). Is the opposition of
GP and the banks valid? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. The opposition is valid. GP is not a public official. The
investigation does not involve one of the exceptions to the
prohibition against disclosure of any information
concerning bank deposits under the Law on Secrecy of
Bank Deposits. The Committee conducting the
investigation is not a competent court or the Ombudsman
authorized under the law to issue a subpoena for the
production of the bank record involving such disclosure.
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits; Exceptions (2004)
The Law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits provides that all
deposits of whatever nature with banks or banking
institutions are absolutely confidential in nature and may
not be examined, inquired or looked into by any person,
government official, bureau or office. However, the law
provides exceptions in certain instances. Which of the
following may not be among the exceptions:
1. In cases of impeachment.
2. In cases involving bribery
3. In cases involving BIR inquiry.
4. In cases of anti-graft and corrupt practices.
5. In cases where the money involved is the subject of
litigation. Explain your answer or choice
briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Page 18 of 103 Under Section 6(F) of the National
Internal Revenue Code, the Commissioner of Internal
Revenue can inquire into the deposits of a decedent for the
purpose of determining the gross estate of such decedent.
Apart from this case, a BIR inquiry into bank deposits
cannot be made. Thus, exception 3 may not always be
applicable.
Turning to exception 4, an inquiry into bank deposits is
possible only in prosecutions for unexplained wealth under
the Anti-Graft and Corrupt Practices Act, according to the
Supreme Court in the cases of Philippine National Bank v.
Gancayco, 15 SCRA 91 (1965) and Banco Filipino Savings and Mortgage
Bank v. Purisima, 161 SCRA 576 (1988).
However, all other cases of anti-graft and corrupt practices
will not warrant an inquiry into bank deposits. Thus,
exception 4 may not always be applicable. Like any other
exception, it must be interpreted strictly.
Exceptions 1, 2 and 5, on the other hand, are provided
expressly in the Law on Secrecy of Bank Depositors. They
are available to depositors at all times.
Banks; Secrecy of Bank Deposits; Garnishment (2001)
The Law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits, otherwise known as
RA 1405, is intended to encourage people to deposit their
money in banking institutions and also to discourage
private hoarding so that the same may be properly utilized
by banks to assist in the economic development of the
country. Is a notice of garnishment served on a bank at the
instance of a creditor of a depositor covered by the said
law? State the reason(s) for your answer. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The notice of garnishment served on a bank at the
instance of a creditor is not covered by the Law on Secrecy
of Bank Deposits. Garnishment is just a part of the process
of execution. The moment a notice of garnishment is
served on a bank and there exists a deposit by the
judgment debtor, the bank is directly accountable to the
sheriff, for the benefit of the judgment creditor, for the
whole amount of the deposit. In such event, the amount of
the deposit becomes, in effect, a subject of the litigation.
BSP; Receivership; Jurisdiction (1992)
Family Bank was placed under statutory receivership and
subsequently ordered liquidated by the Central Bank (CB)
due to fraud and irregularities in its lending operations
which rendered it insolvent. Judicial proceedings for
liquidation were thereafter commenced by the CB before
the RTC. Family Bank opposed the petition. Shortly
thereafter, Family Bank filed in the same court a special civil
action against the CB seeking to enjoin and dismiss the
liquidation proceeding on the ground of grave abuse of
discretion by the CB. The court poised to: 1) restrain the
CB from closing Family Bank; and 2) authorize Family Bank
to withdraw money from its deposits during the pendency
of the case. If you were the Judge, would you issue such
orders? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
No. The RTC has no authority to restrain the monetary
board of the BSP from statutory authority to undertake
receivership and ultimate liquidation of a bank. Any
opposition to such an action could be made to the court
itself where assistance is sought. The action of the RTC
where the proceeding is pending appeal have to be made
in the Court of Appeals.
Legal Tender (2000)
After many years of shopping in the Metro Manila area,
housewife HW has developed the sound habit of making
cash purchases only, none on credit. In one shopping trip
to Mega Mall, she got the shock of her shopping life for
the first time, a stores smart salesgirl refused to accept her
coins in payment for a purchase worth not more than one
hundred pesos. HW was paying seventy pesos in 25centavo
coins and twenty five pesos in 10 centavo coins. Strange as
it may seem, the salesgirl told HW that her coins were not
legal tender. Do you agree with the salesgirl in respect of
her understanding of legal tender? Explain (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The salesgirls understanding that coins are not legal
tender is not correct. Coins are legal tender in amounts
not exceeding fifty pesos for denominations from twenty
five centavos and above, and in amounts not exceeding
twenty pesos for denominations ten centavos and less.
PDIC Law vs. Secrecy of Bank Deposits Act (1997)
An employee of a large manufacturing firm earns a salary
which is just a bit more than what he needs for a
comfortable living. He is thus able to still maintain a
P10,000 savings account, a P20,000 checking account, a
P30,000 money market placement and a P40,000 trust
fund in a medium-size commercial bank. a) State which of
the four accounts are deemed insured
by the PDIC. b) State which of the above accounts are
covered by
the Law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) The P10th savings account and the P20th checking
account are deemed insured by the PDIC. b) The P10th
savings account and the P20th checking
account are covered by the Law on Secrecy of Bank
Deposits.
Responsibilities & Objectives of BSP (1998)
What are the responsibilities and primary objectives of the
BSP? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The BSP shall provide policy directions in the areas of
money, banking and credit. It shall have supervision over
the operations of banks and exercise such regulatory
powers as provided in the Central Bank Act and other
pertinent laws over the operations of finance companies
and non-bank financial institutions performing
quasi-banking functions, such as quasi-banks and
institutions performing similar functions.
The primary objective of the BSP is to maintain price
stability conducive to a balanced and sustainable growth
Page 19 of 103 of the economy. It shall promote and
maintain monetary stability and convertibility of the Peso.
Truth in Lending Act (1991)
Dana Gianina purchased on a 36 month installment basis
the latest model of the Nissan Sentra Sedan car from the
Jobel Cars Inc. In addition to the advertised selling price,
the latter imposed finance charges consisting of interests,
fees and service charges. It did not, however, submit to
Dana a written statement setting forth therein the
information required by the Truth in Lending Act (RA
3765). Nevertheless, the conditional deed of sale which the
parties executed mentioned that the total amount indicated
therein included such finance charges.
Has there been substantial compliance of the
aforesaid Act?
If your answer to the foregoing question is in the
negative, what is the effect of the violation on the contract?
In the event of a violation of the Act, what
remedies may be availed of by Dana?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) There was no substantial compliance with the
Truth in Lending Act. The law provides that the creditor
must make a full disclosure of the credit lost. The statement
that the total amount due includes the principal and the
financial charges, without specifying the amounts due on
each portion thereof would be insufficient and
unacceptable.
b) A violation of the Truth in Lending Act will not
adversely affect the validity of the contract itself.
c) It would allow Dana to refuse payment of
financial charges or, if already paid, to recover the same.
Dana may also initiate criminal charges against the creditor.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
c) (Per Atty Jomby Paras if u read the provisions closely)
Under the Truth in Lending Act, said financial charges are
valid, and Dana may not refuse payment thereof. Only
criminal charges may be initiated against the creditor.
Truth in Lending Act (2000)
Embassy Appliances sells home theater components that
are designed and customized as entertainment centers for
consumers within the medium-to-high price bracket. Most,
if not all, of these packages are sold on installment basis,
usually by means of credit cards allowing a maximum of 36
equal monthly payments. Preferred credit cards of this type
are those issued by banks, which regularly hold mall wide
sales blitzes participated in by appliance retailers like
Embassy Appliances. You are a buyer of a home theater
center at Embassy Appliances. The salesclerk who is
attending to you simply swipes your credit card on the
electronic approval machine (which momentarily prints out
your charge slip since you have unlimited credit), tears the
slip from the machine, hands the same over to you for
your signature, and
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
without more, proceeds to arrange the delivery and
installation of your new home theater system. You know
you will receive a statement on your credit card purchases
from the bank containing an option to pay only a
minimum amount, which is usually 1/36 of the total price
you were charged for your purchase. Did Embassy
Appliances comply with the provisions of the Truth in
Lending Act (RA 3765)?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
There is no need for Embassy Appliances to comply with
the Truth in Lending Act. The transaction is not a sale on
installment basis. Embassy Appliances is a seller on cash
basis. It is the credit card company which allows the buyer
to enjoy the privilege of paying the price on installment
basis.
Bulk Sales Law
Bulk Sales Law; Covered Transactions (1994)
Stanrus Inc a department store with outlets in Makati,
Mandaluyong, and Quezon City, is contemplating to
refurbish and renovate its Makati store in order to introduce
the most modern and state of the art equipment in
merchandise display. To carry out its plan, it intends to sell
ALL of the existing fixtures and equipment (display cases,
wall decorations, furniture, counters, etc.) to Crossroads
Department Store. Thereafter, it will buy and install new
fixtures and equipment and continue operations.
Crossroads wants to know from you as counsel: 1) Whether
the intended sale is bulk sale. 2) How can it protect itself
from future claims of
creditors of Stanrus.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) Yes. The sale involves all fixtures and equipment, not in
the ordinary course of trade and the regular prosecution of
business of Stanrus, Inc. (Sec 2 Act 3952, as amended)
2) Crossroads should require from Stanrus Inc. submission
of a written waiver of the Bulk Sales Law by the creditors as
shown by verified statements or to comply with the
requirements of the Bulk Sales Law, that is, the seller must
notify his creditors of the terms and conditions of the sale,
and also, before receiving from the vendee any part of the
purchase price, deliver to such vendee a written sworn
statement of the names and addresses of all his creditors
together with the amount of indebtedness due to each (Sec
2 Act 3952, amended)
Bulk Sales Law; Covered Transactions (2000)
Company X, engaged in the business of manufacturing car
parts and accessories, operates a factory with equipment,
machinery and tools for this purpose. The manufactured
goods are sold wholesale to distributors and dealers
throughout the Philippines. Company X was among the
business entities adversely hit by the 1997 Asian business
crisis. Its sales dropped with the decline in car sales and its
operating costs escalated, while its creditor banks and other
financial institutions tightened
Page 20 of 103 their loan portfolios. Company X was
faced with the dismal choice of either suspending its
operations or selling its business. It chose the latter.
Having struck a deal with Company Z, a more viable entity
engaged in the same business, Company X sold its entire
business to the former without much fanfare or any form
of publicity. In fact, evidence exists that the transaction
was furtively entered into to avoid the prying eyes of
Company Xs creditors. The creditor banks and other
financial institutions sued Company X for violation of the
Bulk Sales Law. Decide. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Company X violated the Bulk Sales Law when it sold its
entire business to Company Z furtively to avoid the prying
eyes of its creditors. Its manufactured goods are sold
wholesale to distributors and dealers. The sale of all or
substantially all of its stocks, not in the ordinary course of
business, constitutes bulk sale. The transaction being a
bulk sale, entering into such transaction without complying
with the requirements of the Bulk Sales Law, Company X
violated said law.
Bulk Sales Law; Covered Transactions (2006)
Pursuant to a writ of execution issued by the Regional Trial
Court in "Express Bank v. Don Rubio," the sheriff levied
and sold at public auction 8 photocopying machines of
Don Rubio. Is the sheriff's sale covered by the Bulk Sales
Law? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The sale by sheriff at public sale is not a sale by a
merchant. Section 8 of the Bulk Sales Law itself provides
that it has no application to executors, administrators,
receivers, assignees in insolvency, or public officers, acting
under process. The Bulk Sales Law only applies to the sale
or encumbrance of a merchant of goods, merchandise or
commodity done "in bulk" as defined by the Law itself.
Bulk Sales Law; Exclusions (1993)
In the annual meeting of XYZ Corporation, the
stockholders unanimously adopted a resolution proposed
by the BOD to sell substantially all the fixtures and
equipment used in and about its business. The President of
the Corporation approached you and asked for legal
assistance to effect the sale. 1) What steps should you take
so that the sale may be
valid? 2) What are the two instances when the sale,
transfer,
mortgage or assignment of stock of goods, wares,
merchandise, provision, or materials otherwise than
in the ordinary course of trade and the regular
prosecution of the business of the vendor are not
deemed to be a sale or transfer in bulk?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) The requirements of the Bulk Sales Law must be
complied with. The seller delivers to the purchaser a list of
his creditors and the purchaser in turn notifies such
creditors of the proposed sale at a stipulated time in
advance.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
2) If the sale and transfer is made a) by the vendor,
mortgagor, transferor or assignor who produces and
delivers a written waiver of the provisions of the Bulk Sales
Law from his creditors as shown by verified statement; and
b) by a vendor, mortgagor, transferor or assignor who is an
executor, administrator, receiver, assignee in insolvency, or
public officer acting under judicial process, the sale or
transfer is not covered by the Bulk Sales Law.
Bulk Sales Law; Obligation of the Vendor (1995)
House of Pizza (Pizza) is the owner and operator of a
nationwide chain of pizza outlets. House of Liquor
(Liquor) is a retailer of all kinds of liquor.
House of Foods (Foods) has offered to purchase all of the
outlets, equipment, fixtures and furniture of Pizza. Foods
also offered to purchase from Liquor all of its moderately
priced stock constituting 50% of its total inventory.
Both Pizza and Liquor have creditors. What legal
requirements must Pizza and Liquor comply with in order
for Foods to consummate the transactions? Discuss fully.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Pizza and Liquor must prepare an affidavit stating the
names of all their creditors, their addresses, the amounts
of their credits and their respective maturities. Pizza and
Liquor must submit said affidavit to Foods which, in turn,
should notify the creditors about the transaction which is
about to be concluded with Pizza and Liquor.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
As far as Liquor is concerned, it must prepare an affidavit
stating the names of all its creditors, their addresses, the
amounts of their credits and their respective maturities. It
must submit said affidavit to its buyer, who in turn, should
notify the creditors about the transaction which is about to
be concluded with his seller.
But as far as Pizza is concerned, it is not covered by the
Bulk Sales Law. So Foods can consummate the transaction
without doing anything.
Bulk Sales Law; Obligation of the Vendor (1997)
The sole proprietor of a medium-size grocery shop,
engaged in both wholesale and retail transactions, sells the
entire business lock, stock and barrel because of his plan
to emigrate abroad with his family. Is he covered by the
provisions of the Bulk Sales Law? In the affirmative, what
must be done by the parties so as to comply with the law?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. This is a sale of the stock of goods, fixtures and entire
business, not in the ordinary course of business or trade of
the vendor. Before receiving from the vendee any part of
the purchase price, the vendor must deliver to such vendee
a written statement, duly sworn, of the names and
addresses of all creditors to whom said vendor may be
indebted, together with the amount of
Page 21 of 103 indebtedness due or owing, on account
of the goods, fixtures or business subject matter of the
bulk sale.
Bulk Sales Law; Obligation of the Vendor (2001)
A is a merchant engaged in the sale of a variety of goods
and merchandise. Because of the economic crisis, he
incurred indebtedness to X, Y and Z. Thereafter, A sold to
B all the stock of goods and merchandise. a) What steps
should A undertake to effect a valid sale
in bulk of his goods to B. (2%).
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A must prepare an affidavit stating the names of all his
creditors, in this case, X, Y, and Z, their addresses, the
amount of their credits and their maturity. A should give
the affidavit to B who, in turn, should furnish a copy to
each creditor and notify the creditors that there is a
proposed bulk sale in order to enable the latter to protect
their interests.
b) Suppose A submitted a false statement on the
schedule of his creditors. What is the effect of such
false statement as to Vendee B. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
If the vendee does not have knowledge of the falsity of
the schedule, the sale is valid. However, if the vendee has
knowledge of such falsity, the sale is void because he is in
bad faith.
c) What is the right of creditors X, Y, and Z if A failed
to comply with the procedure/steps required by law
under question letter (a) hereof? (1%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The recourse of X, Y, and Z is to question the validity of
the sale from A to B so as to recover the goods and
merchandise to satisfy their credits.
Consumer Protection Law
Metric System Law (1994)
Angelene is a customer of Meralco Electric Company
(MECO). Because of the abrupt rise in electricity rates,
Angelene complained with MECO insisting that she
should be charged the former rates. However, Angelene
did not tender any payment.
When MECOs employees served the first 48-hour notice of
disconnection, Angelene protested. MECO, however, did
not implement the 48-hour notice of disconnection. Instead,
its employees examined Angelenes electric meter, changed
the same, and installed another. Still, Angelene, made no
tender of payment.
MECO served a second 48-hour notice of disconnection
on June 22, 1984. It gave Angelene until 5 pm of June 25,
1984 within which to pay. As no payment had been made,
MECO cut Angelenes electric service on June 28, 1984.
Angelene contends that the 48-hour written notice of
disconnection rule cannot be invoked by MECO
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
when there is a bona fide and just dispute as to the
amount due as her electric consumption rate. Is
Angelenes contention valid?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. Angelenes only legal recourse in this case was to pay
the electric bill under protest. Her failure to do so justified
MECO to cut the electric service (Ceniza v CA 218 S 290)
Corporation Law
BOD: Election of Aliens as members (2005)
A Korean national joined a corporation which is engaged
in the furniture manufacturing business. He was elected to
the Board of Directors. To complement its furniture
manufacturing business, the corporation also engaged in
the logging business. With the additional logging activity,
can the Korean national still be a member of the Board of
Directors? Explain. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, just as long as sixty percent (60%) of the Board of
Directors are Filipinos. Corporations that are sixty percent
(60%) owned by Filipinos can engage in the business of
exploration, development and utilization of natural
resources. (Art. XII, Sec. 2, 1987 Constitution) The
election of aliens as members of the Board Of Directors
engaging in partially-nationalized activities is allowed in
proportion to their allowable participation or share in the
capital of such entities. (Sec. 2-A, Anti-Dummy Law)
Nothing in the facts shows that more than forty percent
(40%) of the Board of Directors are foreigners.
BOD; Capacity of Directors (1996)
Rodman, the President of TF Co, wrote a letter to
Gregorio, offering to sell to the latter 5,000 bags of fertilizer
at P100 per bag. Gregorio signed his conformity to the
letter-offer, and paid a down-payment of P50th. A few days
later, the Corporate Secretary of TF informed Gregorio of
the decision of their BOD not to ratify the letter offer.
However, since Gregorio had already paid the
down-payment, TF delivered 500 bags of fertilizer which
Gregorio accepted. TF made it clear that the delivery should
be considered an entirely new transaction. Thereafter,
Gregorio sought enforcement of the letter-offer. Is there a
binding contract for the 5,000 bags of fertilizer? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, there is no binding contract for the 5,000 bags of
fertilizer. First, the facts do not indicate that Rodman, the
President of TF Co, was authorized by the BOD to enter
into the said contract or that he was empowered to do so
under some provision of the by-laws of TF Co. The facts
do not also indicate that Rodman has been clothed with the
apparent power to execute the contract or agreements
similar to it. Second, TF Co has specifically informed
Gregorio that it has not ratified the contract for the sale of
5,000 bags of fertilizer and that the delivery to
Page 22 of 103 Gregorio of 500 bags, which Gregorio
accepted, is an entirely new transaction. (Yao Ka Sin Trading v
CA GR 53820 June 15, 1992 209s763)
BOD; Compensation (1991)
After many difficult years, which called for sacrifices on the
part of the companys directors, ABC Manufacturing Inc
was finally earning substantial profits. Thus, the President
proposed to the BOD that the directors be paid a bonus
equivalent to 15% of the companys net income before tax
during the preceding year. The Presidents proposal was
unanimously approved by the BOD. A stockholder of
ABC questioned the bonus. Does he have grounds to
object?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, the stockholder as a valid and legal ground to object
to the payment to the directors of a bonus equivalent to
15% of the companys net income. The law provides that
the total annual compensation of the directors, in the
preceding year, cannot exceed 10% of the companys net
income before income tax (Sec 30 Corp Code).
BOD; Conflict of Interest (1994)
ABC Pigger Inc is engaged in raising and selling hogs in
the local market. Mr. De Dios, one of its directors while
traveling abroad, met a leather goods manufacturer who
was interested in buying pig skins from the Philippines. Mr
De Dios set up a separate company and started exporting
pig skins to his foreign contact but the pig skins exported
were not sourced from ABC. His fellow directors in ABC
complained that he should have given this business to
ABC. How would you decide on this matter?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
I would decide in favor of Mr De Dios. ABC is engaged in
raising and selling hogs in the local market. The company
that Mr De Dios had set up was to engage, as it did, in the
export of pigs skins. There is thus no conflict of interest
between Mr. De Dios and ABC Pigger Inc so as to make
the case fall within the conflict of interest situation under
the law (Sec 34 Corp Code)
Observation: The term conflict of interest is susceptible to
varied views and interpretations.
BOD; Interlocking Directors (1995)
Chito Santos is a director of both Platinum Corporation
and Kwik Silver Corporation. He owns 1% of the
outstanding capital stock of Platinum and 40T of Kwik.
Platinum plans to enter into a contract with Kwik that will
make both companies earn very substantial profits. The
contract is presented at the respective board meetings of
Platinum and Kwik.
1. In order that the contract will not be voidable, what
conditions will have to be complied with? Explain.
2. If these conditions are not met, how may this
contract be ratified? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. At the meeting of the BOD of Platinum to approve the
contract, Chito would have to make sure that
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
a) his presence as director at the meeting is not
necessary to constitute a quorum for such meeting;
b) his vote is not necessary for the approval of the
contract; and c) the contract is fair and reasonable
under the circumstances.
At the meeting of the BOD of Kwik to approve the
contract, Chito would have to make sure that - a) there is
no fraud involved; and b) the contract is fair and
reasonable under the
circumstances.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
2. If the conditions relating to the quorum and required
number of votes are not met, the contract must be ratified
by the vote of stockholders representing at least 2/3 of the
outstanding capital stock in a meeting called for the
purpose. Furthermore, the adverse interest of Chito in the
contract must be disclosed and the contract is fair and
reasonable. (Secs. 32 and 33, BP 68)
BOD; Interlocking Directors (1996)
Leonardo is the Chairman and President, while Raphael is a
Director of NT Corporation. On one occasion, NT Co,
represented by Leonardo and A Ent, a single
proprietorship owned by Raphael, entered into a dealership
agreement whereby NT Co appointed A Ent as exclusive
distributor of its products in Northern Luzon. Is the
dealership agreement valid? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The dealership agreement is voidable at the option of NT
Co inasmuch as the facts do not indicate that the same was
approved by the BOD of NT Co before it was signed or,
assuming such approval, that it was approved under the
following conditions: 1) That the presence of Raphael, the
owner of A Ent,
in the meeting of the BOD at which the agreement
was approved was not necessary to constitute a
quorum for such meeting;
2) That the vote of Raphael was not necessary for the
approval of the agreement; 3) That the agreement is fair
and reasonable under the circumstances (Sec 32 Corp
Code)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
The dealership agreement is valid upon the assumption
that the same was approved by the BOD of NT Co before
it was signed and that such approval was made under the
following conditions: 1) That the presence of Raphael, the
owner of A Ent,
in the meeting of the BOD at which the agreement
was approved was not necessary to constitute a
quorum for such meeting;
2) That the vote of Raphael was not necessary for the
approval of the agreement; 3) That the agreement is fair
and reasonable under the circumstances (Sec 32 Corp
Code)
By-Laws; Validity; limiting qualifications of BOD
members (1998)
Page 23 of 103 The BOD of X Co, acting on a standing
authority of the stockholders to amend the by-laws,
amended its by-laws so as to disqualify any of its
stockholders who is also a stockholder and director of a
competitor from being elected to its BOD.
Y, a stockholder holding sufficient assets to assure him of a
seat in the BOD, filed a petition with the SEC for a
declaration of nullity of the amended by-laws. He alleged
among other things that as a stockholder, he had acquired
rights inherent in stock ownership such as the right to vote
and be voted upon in the election of directors. Is the
stockholders petition tenable? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. There is no vested right of a stockholder to be elected
as director. When a person buys stock in a corporation he
does so with the knowledge that its affairs are dominated
by a majority of the stockholders. To this extent, the
stockholder parted with his personal right to regulate the
disposition of his property which he invested in the capital
stock of the corporation and surrendered it to the will of
the majority of his fellow incorporators or stockholders.
Corporations have the power to make by-laws declaring a
person employed in the service of a rival company to be
ineligible for the Corporations BOD. An amendment
which renders a director ineligible, or if elected, subjects
him to removal, if he is also a director in a corporation
whose business is in competition with or is antagonistic to
the other corporation is valid.
By-Laws; Validity; limiting qualifications of BOD
members (2000)
At the annual stockholders meeting of MS Corporation,
the stockholders unanimously passed a resolution
authorizing the Board of Directors to amend the corporate
by-laws so as to disqualify any stockholder who is also a
director or stockholder of a competing business from being
elected to the Board of Directors of MS Corporation. The
by-laws were accordingly amended. GK, a stockholder of
MS Corporation and a majority stockholder of a
competitor, sought election to the Board of Directors of
MS Corporation. His nomination was denied on the ground
that he was ineligible to run for the position. Seeking a
nullification of the offending disqualification provision, GK
consults you about its validity under the Corporation Code
of the Phils. What would your legal advice be? (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The provision in the amended by-laws disqualifying any
stockholder who is also a director or stockholder of a
competing business from being elected to the Board of
Directors of MS Corp is valid. The corporation is
empowered to adopt a code of by-laws for its government
not inconsistent with the Corp Code. Such disqualifying
provision is not inconsistent with the Corp Code.
By-Laws; Validity; limiting qualifications of BOD
members (2001)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Is a by-law provision of X Corporation rendering
ineligible or if elected, subject to removal, a director if he is
also a director in a corporation whose business is in
competition with or is antagonistic to said corporation
valid and legal? State your reasons. (5%).
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, the by-law provision is valid. It is the right of a
corporation to protect itself against possible harm and
prejudice that may be caused by its competitors. The
position of director is highly sensitive and confidential. To
say the least, to allow a person, who is a director in a
corporation whose business is in competition with or is
antagonistic to X Corporation, to become also a director in
X Corporation would be harboring a conflict of interest
which is harmful to the latter (Gokongwei Jr v SEC 89 S 336
(1979); 97 S 78 (1980)).
By-Laws; Validity; limiting qualifications of BOD
members (2003)
To prevent the entry of Marlo Enriquez, whom it
considered as one antagonistic to its interests, into its
Board of Directors, Bayan Corporation amended its
articles of incorporation and by-laws to add certain
qualifications of stockholders to be elected as members of
its Board of Directors. When presented for approval at a
meeting of its stockholders duly called for the purpose, the
amendments were overwhelmingly ratified. Marlo
Enriquez brought suits against Bayan Corporation to
question the amendments. Would the action prosper?
Why? (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
(per Dondee) The SC reiterated in the case of SMC vs. SEC
decided in April 11, 1979, that it is recognized by all
authorities that 'every corporation has the inherent power
to adopt by-laws 'for its internal government, and to
regulate the conduct and prescribe the rights and duties of
its members towards itself and among themselves in
reference to the management of its affairs.'" At common
law, the rule was "that the power to make and adopt by-
laws was inherent in every corporation as one of its
necessary and inseparable legal incidents. And it is settled
throughout the United States that in the absence of
positive legislative provisions limiting it, every private
corporation has this inherent power as one of its necessary
and inseparable legal incidents, independent of any specific
enabling provision in its charter or in general law, such
power of self-government being essential to enable the
corporation to accomplish the purposes of its creation."
Close Corporations; Deadlocks (1995)
Robert, Rey and Ben executed a joint venture agreement to
form a close corporation under the Corp Code the
outstanding capital stock of which the three of them would
equally own. They also provided therein that any corporate
act would need the vote of 70% of the outstanding capital
stock. The terms of the agreement were accordingly
implemented and the corresponding close corporation was
incorporated. After 3 years, Robert, Rey and Ben could not
agree on the business in
Page 24 of 103 which to invest the funds of the
corporation. Robert wants the deadlock broken.
1. What are the remedies available to Robert under the
Corp code to break the deadlock? Explain.
2. Are there any remedies to prevent the paralyzation
of the business available to Robert under PD 902-A
while the petition to break the deadlock is pending
litigation? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. Robert can petition the SEC to arbitrate the dispute,
with such powers as provided in Sec 104 of the Corp
Code.
2. The SEC can appoint a rehabilitation receiver or a
management committee.
Closed Corporation; Restriction; Transfer of shares
(1994)
Rafael inherited from his uncle 10,000 shares of Sta. Ana
Corporation, a close corporation. The shares have a par
value of P10.00 per share. Rafael notified Sta. Ana that he
was selling his shares at P70.00 per share. There being no
takers among the stockholders, Rafael sold the same to his
cousin Vicente (who is not a stockholder) for P700,000.
The Corporate Secretary refused to transfer the shares in
Vicentes name in the corporate books because Alberto,
one of the stockholders, opposed the transfer on the
ground that the same violated the by-laws. Alberto offered
to buy the shares at P12.50 per share, as fixed by the
by-laws or a total price of P125,000 only.
While the by-laws of Sta. Ana provides that the right of
first refusal can be exercised at a price not exceeding
25% more than the par value of such shares, the Articles
of Incorporation simply provides that the stockholders of
record shall have preferential right to purchase said
shares. It is silent as to pricing.
Is Rafael bound by the pricing proviso under the by-laws
of Sta. Ana Corporation?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. In a close corporation, the restriction as to the
transfer of shares has to be stated/ annotated in the
Articles of Incorporation, the By-Laws and the certificate
of stock. This serves as notice to the person dealing with
such shares like Rafael in this case. With such notice, he is
bound by the pricing stated in the By-laws.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
No, Rafael is not bound by the pricing proviso under the
By-laws of Sta Ana Corporation. Under the corporation
law, the restrictions on the right to transfer shares must
appear in the articles of incorporation and in the by-laws as
well as in the certificate of stock, otherwise, the same shall
not be binding on any purchaser thereof in good faith.
Moreover the restriction shall not be more onerous than
granting the existing stockholders or the corporation the
option to purchase the shares of the transferring
stockholder with such reasonable term or period stated
therein.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Here, limiting the price to be paid, when the right of first
refusal is exercised, to not more than 25% par value,
without any qualification whatsoever, is not in the articles.
It is merely stated in the By-laws. Therefore such limitation
shall not be binding on the purchaser. (GoSock & Sons & Sy
Gui Huat Inc v IAC 19 Feb 87 Min Res)
Controversy; Intra-Corporate (1994)
Because of disagreement with the BOD and a threat by the
BOD to expel her for misconduct and inefficiency, Carissa
offered in writing to resign as President and member of the
BOD, and to sell to the company all her shares therein for
P300,000.00 Her offer to resign was effective as soon as
my shares are fully paid. At its meeting, the BOD accepted
Carissas resignation, approved her offer to sell back her
shares of stock to the company, and promised to buy the
stocks on a staggered basis. Carissa was informed of the
BOD Resolution in a letter-agreement to which she affixed
her consent. The Companys new President singed the
promissory note. After payment P100,000 the company
defaulted in paying the balance of P200,000.
Carissa wants to sue the Company to collect the balance.
If you were retained by Carissa as her lawyer, where will
you file the suit? A) Labor Arbiter; b) RTC; or c) SEC?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The RTC has jurisdiction over this case which involves
intra-corporate controversy. As of 2006, the applicable
rule is that there is a TRANSFERRED JURISDICTION
under Sec. 5.2 of the SRC, the Commissions jurisdiction
over all cases enumerated under PD 902-A sec. 5 has been
transferred to the Courts of general jurisdiction or the
appropriate Regional Trial Court.
Controversy; Intra-Corporate (1996)
In 1970, Magno joined AMD Co as a Junior Accountant.
He steadily rose from the ranks until he became AMDs
Executive VP. Subsequently, however because of his
involvement in certain anomalies, the AMD BOD
considered him resigned from the company due to loss of
confidence.
Aggrieved, Magno filed a complaint in the SEC questioning
the validity of his termination, and seeking reinstatement to
his former position, with backwages, vacation and sick
leave benefits, 13th month pay and Christmas bonus, plus
moral and exemplary damages, attorneys fees and costs.
AMD filed a motion to dismiss, arguing that the SEC has
no jurisdiction over cases of illegal dismissal, and has no
power to award damages. Should the motion to dismiss be
granted? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
As of 2006, the applicable rule is that there is a
TRANSFERRED JURISDICTION under Sec. 5.2 of the
SRC, the Commissions jurisdiction over all cases
enumerated under PD 902-A sec. 5 has been transferred to
the Courts of general jurisdiction or the appropriate
REGIONAL TRIAL COURT.
Controversy; Intra-Corporate (1996)
Page 25 of 103 Jennifer and Gabriel owned the
controlling stocks in MFF Co and CLO Inc, both family
corporations. Due to serious disagreements, Jennifer
assigned all her shares in MFF to Gabriel, while Gabriel
assigned all his shares in CLO to Jennifer. Subsequently,
Jennifer and CLO filed a complaint against Gabriel and
MFF in the SEC seeking to recover the corporate records
and funds of CLO which Gabriel allegedly refused to turn
over, and which remained in the offices of MFF. Is there
an intra-corporate controversy in this case?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, there is an intra-corporate controversy in this case.
The fact that, when the complaint against Gabriel and MFF
was filed with the SEC (per 2006, RTCs Jurisdiction),
Jennifer and CLO were no longer stockholders of MFF did
not divest the SEC (per 2006, RTCs Jurisdiction) of its
jurisdiction over the case inasmuch as Jennifer was a former
stockholder of MFF and the controversy arose out of this
relation. (SEC v CA GR 93832 Aug 23 91; 201s124)
Controversy; Intra-Corporate (2006)
What is an intra-corporate controversy? (8%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
An intra-corporate controversy is a conflict between
stockholders, members or partners and the corporation,
association or partnership regarding the regulation of the
corporation. The controversy must arise out of
intra-corporate or partnership relations of the parties; or
between such corporation, partnership or association and
the State insofar as it concerns their individual franchises.
It is further required that the dispute be intrinsically
connected with the regulation of the corporation (Speed
Distributing Corp., et al. v. Court of Appeals, et al, G.R. No. 149351,
March 17, 2004; Intestate Estate of Alexander T.Tyv. Court of Appeals,
G.R. No. 112872, April 19, 2001).
Is the Securities and Exchange Commission the venue
for actions involving intra-corporate controversies? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, pursuant to Subsection 5.2 of the Securities Regulation
Code, the quasi-judicial jurisdiction of the Securities and
Exchange Commission to hear corporate cases, including
intra-corporate controversies, under Section 5 of Pres.
Decree No. 902-A, has been expressly transferred to the
designated Regional Trial Court. Pursuant to a
memorandum circular issued by the Supreme Court, only
particularly designated RTC special commercial courts in
each judicial region have original and exclusive jurisdiction
over such cases (See Intestate Estate of Alexander T. Ty v. Court of
Appeals, G.R. No. 112872, April 19, 2001).
Controversy; Intra-corporate; Jurisdiction (1997)
Juan was a stockholder of X Co. He owned a total of 500
shares evidenced by Cert of Stock No 1001. He sold the
shares to Pedro. After getting paid, Juan indorsed and
delivered said Certificate of Stock No 1001 to Pedro. The
following day, Juan went to the offices of the corporation
and claimed that his Certificate of Stock No 1001 was lost
and that, despite diligent efforts, the certificate could
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
not be located. The formalities prescribed by law for the
replacement of the lost certificate were complied with.
Eventually X Co issued in substitution of the lost
certificate, Cert of Stock No 2002. Juan forthwith
transferred for valuable consideration the new certificate to
Jose who knew nothing of the previous sale to Pedro. In
time, the corporation was confronted with the conflicting
claims of Jose and Pedro. The BOD of X Co invited you
to enlighten them on these questions; viz: a) If a suit were
to be initiated in order to resolve the
controversy between Pedro and Jose, should the
matter be submitted to the SEC or to the regular
courts? b) Between Jose and Pedro, whom should the
corporation so recognize as the rightful stockholder?
How would you respond to the above queries?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) The matter should be submitted to the regular courts
specifically in the Regional Trial Court where the principal
office of the corporation is located. The controversy
between Pedro and Jose is not an intra-corporate
controversy.
b) If there is no over-issuance of shares resulting from the
two-transactions of Juan, the corporation should recognize
both Pedro and Jose as rightful stockholders. This is
without prejudice to the right of the corporation to claim
against Juan for the value of the shares which Juan sold to
Jose.
Corporation Sole; Definition (2004)
What is a corporation sole?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Section 110 of the Corporation Code defines a
"corporation sole" as one formed for the purpose of
administering and managing, as trustee, the affairs, property
and temporalities of any religious denomination, sect or
church. It is formed by the chief archbishop, bishop, priest,
minister, rabbi or other presiding elder of such religious
denomination, sect or church.
Corporation: Issuance of shares of stock to pay for the
services (2005)
Janice rendered some consultancy work for XYZ
Corporation. Her compensation included shares of stock
therein. Can XYZ Corporation issue shares of stock to pay
for the services of Janice as its consultant? Discuss your
answer. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, provided the approval of stockholders representing
two-thirds (2/3) of the outstanding capital stock is obtained.
Although the facts indicate that the consultancy work has
already been "rendered" constituting "previously contracted
debt," under Section 39 of the Corporation Code, the
pre-emptive rights of existing stockholders need not be
respected "in payment of a previously contracted debt," but
only with the indicated stockholders' approval. Under
Section 62 of the Corporation Code, consideration for the
issuance of
Page 26 of 103 stock may include labor performed for or
services actually rendered to the corporation.
Corporation: Right of Repurchase of Shares; Trust Fund
Doctrine (2005)
Under what conditions may a stock corporation acquire
its own shares? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
In line with the trust fund doctrine that generally renders it
unlawful for the corporation to return assets to the
stockholders representing capital, a corporation may
acquire its own shares only when there exists in the books
unrestricted retained earnings to cover the repurchase of shares. The
purpose of the repurchase of shares must be a legitimate
business purpose of the corporation, such as to:
1 ELIMINATE fractional shares arising out of
stock dividends;
2 COLLECT or COMPROMISE an indebtedness
to the corporation arising out of unpaid subscription in a
delinquency sale;
3 to PURCHASE delinquent shares sold during the
sale; and
4 to PAY dissenting or withdrawing stockholders
entitled to such payment under the Corporation Code.
(Sees. 41 and 82, Corporation Code)
Corporation: Sole Proprietorship (2004)
YKS Trading filed a complaint for specific performance
with damages against PWC Corporation for failure to
deliver cement ordered by plaintiff. In its answer, PWC
denied liability on the ground, inter alia, that YKS has no
personality to sue, not being incorporated, and that the
President of PWC was not authorized to enter into a
contract with plaintiff by the PWC Board of Directors,
hence the contract is ultra vires. YKS Trading replied that
it is a sole proprietorship owned by YKS, and that the
President of PWC had made it appear in several letters
presented in evidence that he had authority to sign
contracts on behalf of the Board of Directors of PWC.
Will the suit prosper or not? Reason briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes the suit will prosper. As a sole proprietorship, the
proprietor of YKS Trading has the capacity to act and the
personality to sue PWC. It is not necessary for YKS
Trading to be incorporated before it can sue. On the other
hand, PWC is estopped from asserting that its President
had no authority to enter into the contract, considering
that, in several of PWC's letters, it had clothed its
President with apparent authority to deal with YKS
Trading.
Corporation; Articles of Incorporation (1990)
The articles of incorporation to be registered in the SEC
contained the following provisions -- a) First Article.
The name of the corporation shall be Toho Marketing
Company.
b) Third Article. The principal office of such corporation
shall be located in Region III, in such municipality therein
as its Board of Directors may designate.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 27 of 103
c) Seventh Article. The capital stock of the corporation is
One Million Pesos (P1,000,000) Philippine Currency.
What are your comments and suggested changes to the
proposed articles?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) On the First Article, I would suggest that the
corporate name indicate the fact of incorporation by using
either Toho Marketing Corporation or Toh Marketing
Company, Incorporated.
b) The Third Article should indicate the City or the
Municipality and the Province in the Philippines, and not
merely the region or as its BOD may later designate, to be
its place of principal office.
c) The Seventh Article must additionally point out
the number of shares into which the capital stock is
divided, as well as the par value thereof or a statement that
said stock or a portion thereof are without par value. (Sec
14 & 15 Corp Code)
Corporation; Bulk Sales Law (2005)
Divine Corporation is engaged in the manufacture of
garments for export. In the course of its business, it was
able to obtain loans from individuals and financing
institutions. However, due to the drop in the demand for
garments in the international market, Divine Corporation
could not meet its obligations. It decided to sell all its
equipment such as sewing machines, perma-press
machines, high speed sewers, cutting tables, ironing tables,
etc., as well as its supplies and materials to Top Grade
Fashion Corporation, its competitor. (5%) 1) How would
you classify the transaction?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The transactions would constitute a sale of "substantially all
of the assets of Divine Corporation complying with the test
under Sec. 40 of the Corporation Code, the transactions not
being "in the ordinary course of business," and one "thereby
the corporation would be rendered incapable of continuing
the business or accomplishing the purpose for which it was
incorporated."
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
It is a sale and transfer in bulk in contemplation of the
Bulk Sales Law. Under Sec. 2 of the Bulk Sales Law, a bulk
sale includes any sale, transfer, mortgage, or assignment of
all, or substantially all, of the business or trade theretofore
conducted by the vendor, mortgagor, transferor, or
assignor. This is exactly what happened in the case at bar.
2) Can Divine Corporation sell the aforesaid items
to its competitor, Top Grade Fashion Corporation? What
are the requirements to validly sell the items? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
For such a transaction to be valid, it requires not only the
favorable resolution of the Board of Directors of Divine
Corporation, but also the ratificatory vote of
stockholders representing at least two-thirds (2/3) of the
outstanding capital stock, as mandated under Sec. 40 of
the Corporation Code. The sale would be void in case of
failure to meet the twin approvals. (Islamic Directorate of the
Philippines v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 117897, May 14, 1997)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Divine Corporation can sell the items to its competitor,
Top Grade Fashion Corporation. However, Divine
Corporation must comply with Sections 3, 4 and 5 of the
Bulk Sales Law, namely: (1) deliver sworn statement of the
names and addresses of all the creditors to whom the
vendor or mortgagor may be indebted together with the
amount of indebtedness due or owing to each of the said
creditors; (2) apply the purchase or mortgage money to the
pro-rata payment of bona fide claims of the creditors; and
(3) make a full detailed inventory of the stock of goods,
wares, merchandise, provisions or materials, in bulk, and
notify every creditor at least ten (10) days before
transferring possession.
3) How would you protect the interests of the
creditors of Divine Corporation?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Considering that Divine Corporation has entered a de facto
stage of dissolution with the ceasing of its operations, I
would invoke on behalf of the creditors the protection
under Sec. 122 of the Corporation Code, that the proceeds
of the sale should first be applied towards the settlement of
the obligations of the corporation, before any amount can
be paid to the stockholders.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Under the Bulk Sales Law, if the proceeds are not; applied
proportionately towards the settlement of the accounts of
the corporate debts, to have the sale of the subject matters
to Top Grade Fashion Corp., as being "fraudulent and
void" and obtain satisfaction from the properties which are
deemed to still be owned by Divine Corporation in spite of
delivery to the buyer. The creditors can collect on the credit
against Divine Corporation, and if it cannot pay, the
creditors can apply for attachment on the property
fraudulently sold. (See People v. Mapoy, G.R. No. 48836,
September 21, 1942)
4) In case Divine Corporation violated the law, what
remedies are available to Top Grade Fashion
Corporation against Divine Corporation?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
If the sale by Divine Corporation did not obtain the
required two-thirds (2/3) vote of the outstanding capital
stock, then the transaction is void. (Islamic Directorate of the
Philippines v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No, 117897, May 14, 1997)
Top Grade Fashion Corporation can have the purchase
declared void and recover the purchase price paid, as well
as damages against the directors and officers who
undertook the transaction in violation of the law.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
For violation of the Bulk Sales Law, the principal officers
of the Divine Corporation can be held criminally liable. In
addition, Top Grade can sue Divine Corporation for
damages. Violation of the Bulk Sales Law would render
such a sale fraudulent and void. Since Top Grade would
be compelled to return the goods to Divine Corporation,
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Top Grade can compel Divine Corporation to return the
purchase price and pay damages.
Corporation; By-laws (2001)
Suppose that the by-laws of X Corp, a mining firm
provides that The directors shall be relieved from all
liability for any contract entered into by the corporation
with any firm in which the directors may be interested.
Thus, director A acquired claims which overlapped with
Xs claims and were necessary for the development and
operation of Xs mining properties. a) Is the by-law
provision valid? Why? (3%) b) What happens if director A
is able to consummate
his mining claims over and above that of the
corporations claims? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) No. It is in violation of Section 32 of the Corp Code.
b) A should account to the corporation for the profits
which he realized from the transaction. He grabbed the
business opportunity from the corporation. (Section 34,
Corp Code)
Corporation; Commencement; Corporate Existence
(2003)
1. When does a corporation acquire corporate
existence?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
2. CBY & Co., Inc., registered with the Securities
and Exchange Commission its articles of incorporation. It
failed, however, for one reason or another, to have its
by-laws filed with, and registered by, the Commission. It
nevertheless transacted and did business as a corporation
for sometime. A suit was commenced by its minority
stockholders assailing the continued existence of CBY &
Co., Inc., because of the non-adoption and registration of
its by-laws. Would the action prosper? Why? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Corporation; Conversion of Stock Corporation (2001)
X company is a stock corporation composed of the Reyes
family engaged in the real estate business. Because of the
regional crisis, the stockholders decided to convert their
stock corporation into a charitable non-stock and
non-profit association by amending the articles of
incorporation. a) Could this be legally done? Why? (3%) b)
Would your answer be the same if at the inception,
X Company is a non-stock corporation? Why? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Yes, it can be legally done. In converting the stock
corporation to a non-stock corporation by a mere
amendment of the articles of incorporation, the stock
corporation is not distributing any of its assets to the
stockholders. On the contrary, the stockholders are
deemed to have waived their right to share in the profits of
the corporation which is a gain not a loss to the
corporation.
Page 28 of 103
b) No, my answer will not be the same. In a non-stock
corporation, the members are not entitled to share in the
profits of the corporation because all present and future
profits belong to the corporation. In converting the
non-stock corporation to a stock corporation by a mere
amendment of the Articles of Incorporation, the
non-stock corporation is deemed to have distributed an
asset of the corporation i.e. its profits, among its
members, without a prior dissolution of the corporation.
Under Sec 122, the non-stock corporation must be
dissolved first.
(Observation: The question is rather vague more particularly question
1b. The question does not specify that the conversion is from a non-stock
corporation to a stock corporation. The candidate is likely to be confused
because of the words if at the inception, X Co is a nonstock
corporation. Hence, any answer along the same line should be treated
with liberality)
Corporation; De Facto Corporation (1994)
A corporation was created by a special law. Later, the law
creating it was declared invalid. May such corporation
claim to be a de facto corporation?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. A private corporation may be created only under the
Corporation Code. Only public corporations may be
created under special law.
Where a private corporation is created under a special law,
there is no attempt at a valid incorporation. Such
corporation cannot claim a de facto status.
Corporation; Dissolution; Methods of Liquidation (2001)
X Corporation shortened its corporate life by amending
its Articles of Incorporation. It has no debts but owns a
prime property located in Quezon City. How would the
said property be liquidated among the five stockholders of
said corporation? Discuss two methods of liquidation.
(5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The prime property of X Corporation can be liquidated
among the five stockholders after the property has been
conveyed by the corporation to the five stockholders, by
dividing or partitioning it among themselves in any two of
the following ways: 1) by PHYSICAL DIVISION or
PARTITION based on the proportion of the values of
their stockholdings; or
2) SELLING THE PROPERTY to a third person and
dividing the proceeds among the five stockholders in
proportion to their stockholdings; or
3) after the determination of the value of the property, by
ASSIGNING or TRANSFERRING THE PROPERTY to
one stockholder with the obligation on the part of said
stockholder to pay the other four stockholders the
amount/s in proportion to the value of the stockholding
of each.
Corporation; Incorporation; Requirements (2006)
What is the minimum and maximum number of in-
corporators required to incorporate a stock corporation?
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Is this also the same minimum and maximum number of
directors required in a stock corporation? (2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Under Section 10 of the Corporation Code, any number of
natural persons not less than five (5) but not more than
fifteen (15), all of legal age and a majority of whom are
residents of the Philippines, may form a private
corporation for any lawful purpose.
This is the same minimum and maximum number of
directors required in a stock corporation under Section
14(6) of the Corporation Code.
Corporation; Incorporation; Residency Requirements
(2006)
Must all incorporators and directors be residents of the
Philippines? (2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Not all directors and incorporators need to be residents of
the Philippines. Under Section 10 of the Corporation Code,
only a majority of the incorporators need to be residents of
the Philippines. As provided in Section 23 of the same
Code, only a majority of the members of the Board of
Directors need to be residents of the Philippines.
Corporation; Incorporation; Requisites (2002)
You have been asked to incorporate a new company to be
called FSB Savings & Mortgage Bank, Inc. List the
documents that you must submit to the Securities and
Exchange Commission (SEC) to obtain a certificate of
incorporation for FSB Savings & Mortgage Bank, Inc.
(5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The documents to be submitted to the Securities and
Exchange Commission (SEC) to incorporate a new
company to be called FSB Savings & Mortgage Bank, Inc.,
to obtain the certificate of incorporation for said company,
are: 1) Articles of Incorporation 2) Treasurers Affidavit; 3)
Certificate of Authority from the Monetary Board of
the BSP;
4) Verification slip from the records of the SEC
whether or not the proposed name has already been
adopted by another corporation, partnership or
association;
5) Letter undertaking to change the proposed name
if already adopted by another corporation, partnership or
association;
6) Bank certificate of deposit concerning the
paid-up capital;
7) Letter authorizing the SEC or Monetary Board
or its duly authorized representative to examine the bank
records regarding the deposit of the paid-up capital;
8) Registration Sheet;
Corporation; Meetings; BOD & Stockholders (1993)
Under the Articles of Incorporation of Manila Industrial
Corp, its principal place of business shall be in Pasig, MM.
The principal corporate offices are at the Ortigas
Page 29 of 103 Center, Pasig, MM while its factory
processing leather products, is in Manila. The corporation
holds its annual stockholders meeting at the Manila Hotel
in Manila and its BOD meeting at a hotel in Makati MM.
The by-laws are silent as to the place of meetings of the
stockholders and directors. 1) Who shall preside at the
meeting of the directors? 2) Can Ting, a stockholder, who
did not attend the
stockholders annual meeting in Manila, question the
validity of the corporate resolutions passed at such
meeting? 3) Can the same stockholder question the
validity of the resolutions adopted by the BOD at the
meeting held in Makati?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) The President presides over the meeting of the
directors, if there is no position of Chairman provided in
the By-Laws. If there is the position of Chairman provided
in the By-Laws, the Chairman presides over the meeting of
the Directors (Sec 54 Corp Code)
2) No. The law provides that the annual stockholders
meeting shall be held in the city or municipality where the
principal office of the Corporation is located. For this
purpose, the law also provides that Metro Manila is
considered a city or municipality. Since the principal place
of business of MIC is Pasig, MM, the holding of the
annual stockholders meeting in Manila is proper. (Sec 51
Corp)
3) No. The law allows the BOD to hold its meeting
anywhere in the Philippines. The holding of the BOD
meeting in Makati was proper and the validity of the
resolutions adopted by the Board in that meeting cannot
be questioned. (Sec 53 Corp code)
Corporation; Nationality of Corporation (1998)
What is the nationality of a corporation organized and
incorporated under the laws of a foreign country, but
owned 100% by Filipinos? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Under the control test of corporate nationality, this foreign
corporation is of Filipino Nationality. Where there are
grounds for piercing the veil of corporate entity, that is,
disregarding the fiction, the corporation will follow the
nationality of the controlling members or stockholders,
since the corporation will then be considered as one and
the same.
Corporation; Non-Stock Corporation (1993)
The AB Memorial Foundation was incorporated as a
non-profit, non-stock corporation in order to establish and
maintain a library and museum in honor of the deceased
parents of the incorporators. Its Articles of Incorporation
provided for a board of trustees composed of 5
incorporators, which authorized to admit new members.
The Articles of Incorporation also allow the foundation to
receive donations from members. As of Jan 30, 1993, 60
members had been admitted by the BOT.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
1) Can the Foundation use the funds donated to it by its
members for purchase of food and medicine for
distribution to the victims of the Pinatubo eruption? 2) Can
the Foundation operate a specialty restaurant that caters to
the general public in order to augment its funds? 3) One of
the original trustees died and the other two resigned
because they immigrated to the US. How will the vacancies
in the BOT be filled?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) Yes, (Sec 36(9) of the Corp Code) as long as the
amount of donation is reasonable.
2) If the purposes of the corporation are limited to the
establishment and maintenance of the library and museum
as stated in the problem, the foundation cannot operate a
specialty restaurant that caters to the general public. In
such case, the action of the foundation will be ultra vires.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
2) If the act of the corporation is justified by the secondary
purpose of the corporation which includes the act of
operating a restaurant, the foundation will be within its
power to do so.
3) Since there are only 2 of the members of the BOT
remaining and there is no quorum, the vacancies will have
to be filled up in a special meeting of the members (sec 29
Corp)
Corporation; Power to Invest Corporate Funds for other
Purpose (1995)
Stikki Cement Co was organized primarily for cement
manufacturing. Anticipating substantial profits, its President
proposed that Stikki invest in a) a power plant project, b) a
concrete road project, and c) quarry operations for
limestone in the manufacture of cement. 1) What corporate
approvals or votes are needed for
the proposed investments? Explain. 2) Describe the
procedure in securing these approvals.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. Unless the power plant and the concrete road project
are reasonable necessary to the manufacture of cement by
Stikki (and they do not appear to be so), then the approval
of said projects by a majority of the BOD and the
ratification of such approval by the stockholders
representing at least 2/3 of the outstanding capital stock
would be necessary.
As for the quarry operations for limestone, the same is an
indispensable ingredient in the manufacture of cement and
may, therefore, be considered reasonably necessary to
accomplish the primary purpose of Stikki. In such case,
only the approval of the BOD would be necessary (Sec 42
BP 68)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
1. The majority vote of the BOD is necessary. The
investment in a) a power plant project, b) a concrete road
project, and c) quarry operations of limestone used in the
manufacture of cement, is within the express or implied
power of the corporation, or at least the same is
Page 30 of 103 incidental to, or necessary for the
existence of the corporation.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
2.a) The procedure in securing the approval of the BOD
is as follows:
a notice of the BOD should be sent to all the
directors. The notice should state the purpose of the
meeting.
At the meeting, each of the project should be
approved by a majority of the BOD (not merely a majority
of those present at the meeting)
2.b) The procedure in securing the approval of the
stockholders is as follows:
Written notice of the proposed investment and
the time and place of the stockholders meeting should be
sent to each stockholder at his place of residence as shown
on the books of the corporation and deposited to the
addressee in the post office with postage prepaid, or
served personally.
At the meeting, each of the projects should be
approved by the stockholders representing at least 2/3 of
the outstanding capital stock. (Sec 42 BP 68)
Corporation; Power to Invest Corporate Funds in another
Corporation (1996)
When may a corporation invest its funds in another
corporation or business or for any other purposes?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A corporation may invest its funds in another corporation or
business or for any other purpose other than the primary
purpose for which it was organized when the said investment
is approved by a majority of the BOD and such approval is
ratified by the stockholders representing at least 2/3 of the
outstanding capital stock. Written notice of the proposed
investment and the date, time and place of the stockholders
meeting at which such proposal will be taken up must be
sent to each stockholder. (Sec 42 Corp Code)
Corporation; Recovery of Moral Damages (1998)
In a complaint filed against XYZ Corporation, Luzon
Trading Corporation alleged that its President & General
Manager, who is also a stockholder, suffered mental
anguish, fright, social humiliation and serious anxiety as a
result of the tortuous acts of XYZ Corporation.
In its counterclaim, XYZ Co claimed to have suffered
moral damages due to besmirched reputation or goodwill
as a result of Luzon Trading Cos complaint. 1) May
Luzon Trading Co recover damages based on
the allegations of the complaint? (2%) 2) May
XYZ Co recover moral damages? (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. A corporation, being an artificial person which has no
feelings, emotions or senses, and which cannot experience
physical suffering or mental anguish, is not entitled to
moral damages.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Yes. When a juridical person has a good reputation that is
debased, resulting in social humiliation, moral damages
may be awarded. Moreover, goodwill can be considered
an asset of the corporation.
TAKE NOTE: In the case of FBN Inc. vs AMEC,
January 17, 2005, the SC ruled that; FBNI contends that
AMEC is not entitled to moral damages because it is a
corporation.
A juridical person is generally not entitled to moral
damages because, unlike a natural person, it cannot
experience physical suffering or such sentiments as
wounded feelings, serious anxiety, mental anguish or moral
shock. The Court of Appeals cites Mambulao Lumber Co.
v. PNB, et al. to justify the award of moral damages.
However, the Court's statement in Mambulao that "a
corporation may have a good reputation which, if
besmirched, may also be a ground for the award of moral
damages" is an obiter dictum.
Nevertheless, AMEC's claim for moral damages falls under
item 7 of Article 2219 of the Civil Code. This provision
expressly authorizes the recovery of moral damages in
cases of libel, slander or any other form of defamation.
Article 2219(7) does not qualify whether the plaintiff is a
natural or juridical person. Therefore, a juridical person
such as a corporation can validly complain for libel or any
other form of defamation and claim for moral damages.
Moreover, where the broadcast is libelous per se, the law
implies damages. In such a case, evidence of an honest
mistake or the want of character or reputation of the party
libeled goes only in mitigation of damages. Neither in
such a case is the plaintiff required to introduce evidence of
actual damages as a condition precedent to the recovery of
some damages. In this case, the broadcasts are libelous per
se. Thus, AMEC is entitled to moral damages.
Corporation; Separate Juridical Personality (1995)
Ronald Sham doing business under the name of
SHAMRON Machineries (Shamron) sold to Turtle
Mercantile (Turtle) a diesel farm tractor. In payment,
Turtles President and Manager Dick Seldon issued a check
for P50th in favor of Shamron. A week later, Turtle sold
the tractor to Briccio Industries (Briccio) for P60th. Briccio
discovered that the engine of the tractor was reconditioned
so he refused to pay Turtle. As a result, Dick Seldon
ordered Stop Payment of the check issued to Shamron.
Shamron sued Turtle and Dick Seldon. Shamron obtained a
favorable judgment holding co-defendants Turtle and Dick
Seldon jointly and severally liable. Comment on the
decision of the trial court. Discuss fully.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The trial court erred in holding Dick Seldon, President
and GM of Turtle, jointly and severally liable with Turtle.
In issuing the check issued to Shamron and, thereafter,
Page 31 of 103 stopping payment thereof, Seldon was
acting in his capacity as an officer of Turtle. He was not
acting in his personal capacity. Furthermore, no facts have
been provided which would indicate that the action of
Seldon was dictated by an intent to defraud Shamron by
himself or in collusion with Turtle. Having acted in what
he considered as his duty as an officer of the corporation,
Seldon should not be held personally liable.
Corporation; Separate Juridical Personality (1996)
PR Co owns a beach resort with several cottages. Jaime,
the President of PR, occupied one of the cottages for
residential purposes. After Jaimes term expired, PR
wanted to recover possession of the cottage. Jaime refused
to surrender the cottage, contending that as a stockholder
and former President, he has a right to possess and enjoy
the properties of the corporation. Is Jaimes contention
correct? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Jaimes contention is not correct. Jaime may own shares of
stock in PR Corp but such ownership does not entitle him
to the possession of any specific property of the
corporation or a definite portion thereof. Neither is he a
co-owner of corporate property. Properties registered in
the name of the corporation are owned by it as an entity
separate and distinct from its stockholders.
Stockholders like Jaime only own shares of stock in the
corporation. Such shares of stock do not represent specific
corporate property. (Rebecca Boyer-Roxas v CA GR 100866 Jul 14,
92 211s470)
Corporation; Separate Juridical Personality (1996)
Richard owns 90% of the shares of the capital stock of
GOM Co. On one occasion, GOM represented by Richard
as President and General Manager executed a contract to
sell a subdivision lot in favor of Tomas. For failure of
GOM to develop the subdivision, Tomas filed an action
for rescission and damages against GOM and Richard. Will
the action prosper? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The action may prosper against GOM but definitely not
against Richard. Richard has a legal personality separate
and distinct from that of GOM. If he singed the contract
to sell, he did so as the President and General Manager of
GOM and not in his personal capacity. Mere ownership by
Richard of 90% of the capital stock of GOM is not of itself
sufficient ground to disregard his separate legal personality
absent a showing, for example that he acted maliciously or
in bad faith (EPG Const Co v CA GR 103372 Jn 22,92 210s230)
Corporation; Separate Juridical Personality (1999)
As a result of perennial business losses, a corporations net
worth has been wiped out. In fact, it is now in negative
territory. Nonetheless, the stockholders did not like to give
up. Creditor-banks, however, do not share the confidence
of the stockholders and refuse to grant more loans. a) What
tools are available to the stockholders to
replenish capital? (3%)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
b) Assuming that the corporation continues to
operate even with depleted capital, would the stockholders
or the managers be solidarily liable for the obligations
incurred by the corporation? Explain. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) In the face of the refusal of the creditor-banks to grant
more loans, the following are tools available to the
stockholders to replenish capital, to wit:
1) additional subscription to shares of stock of the
corporation by stockholders or by investors;
2) advances by the stockholders to the
corporation;
3) payment of unpaid subscription by the
stockholders.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
b) No. As a general rule, the stockholders or the managers
cannot be held solidarily liable for the obligations incurred
by the corporation. The corporation has a separate and
distinct personality from that of the stockholders or
managers. The latter are presumed to be acting in good
faith in continuing the operation of the corporation. The
obligations incurred by the corporation are those of the
corporation which alone is liable therefor. However, when
the corporation is already insolvent, the directors and
officers become trustees of the business and assets of the
corporation for the benefit of the creditors and are liable
for negligence or mismanagement.
Corporation; Separate Juridical Personality (2000)
Marulas Creative Technology Inc., an e-business enterprise
engaged in the manufacture of computer media accessories;
rents an office and store space at a commercial building
owned by X. Being a start-up company, Marulas enjoyed
some leniency in its rent payments; but after three years, X
put a stop to it and asked Marulas president and general
manager, Y, who is a stockholder, to pay the back rentals
amounting to a hundred thousand pesos or to vacate the
premises at the end of the month. Marulas neither paid its
debt nor vacated the premises. X sued Marulas and Y for
collection of the unpaid rentals, plus interest and costs of
litigation. Will the suit prosper against X? Against Y? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, the suit will prosper against Marulas. It is the one
renting the office and store space, as lessee, from the
owner of the building, X, as lessor.
But the suit against Y will not prosper. Y, as president and
general manager, and also stockholder of Marulas Creative
Technology, Inc., has a legal personality separate and
distinct from that of the corporation. The liability of the
corporation is that of the corporation and not that of its
officers and stockholders who are not liable for corporate
liabilities.
Corporation; Separate Juridical Personality (2000)
Nine individuals formed a private corporation pursuant to
the provisions of the Corporation Code of the
Page 32 of 103 Philippines (BP 68). Incorporator S was
elected director and president general manager. Part of
his emolument is a Ford Expedition, which the
corporation owns. After a few years, S lost his corporate
positions but he refused to return the motor vehicle
claiming that as a stockholder with a substantial equity
share, he owns that portion of the corporate assets now in
his possession. Is the contention of S valid? Explain (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The contention of S is not valid. The Ford Expedition
is owned by the corporation. The corporation has a legal
personality separate and distinct from that of its
stockholder. What the corporation owns is its own
property and not the property of any stockholder even
how substantial the equity share that stockholder owns.
Corporation; Set-Off; Unpaid Subscription (1994)
Victor was employed in MAIA Corporation. He subscribed
to 1,500 shares of the corporation at P100 per share or a
total of P150,000. He made an initial down payment of
P37,500.00. He was appointed President and General
Manager. Because of his disagreement with the BOD, he
resigned and demanded payment of his unpaid salaries, his
cost of living allowance, his bonus, and reimbursement of
his gasoline and representation expenses.
MAIA Corporation admits that it owed Victor P40,000.
but told him that this will be applied to the unpaid balance
of his subscription in the amount of P100,000.00 There
was no call or notice for the payment of the unpaid
subscription. Victor questioned the set-off. 1) May MAIA
set-off the unpaid subscription with victors claim for
salaries? 2) Would your answer be the same if indeed there
had been a call for the unpaid subscription?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) No. MAIA cannot setoff the unpaid subscription with
Victors claim for salaries. The unpaid subscription is not
yet due as there is no call.
2) Yes. The reason is that Victor is entitled to the payment
of his salaries which MAIA has no right to withhold in
payment of unpaid subscription. To do so would violate
Labor Laws (Apodaco v NLRC 172 S 442)
Corporation; Stock Corporation (2001)
XY is a recreational club which was organized to operate
a golf course for its members with an original authorized
capital stock of P100M. The articles of incorporation nor
the by-laws did not provide for distribution of dividends
although there is a provision that after its dissolution, the
assets shall be given to a charitable corporation. Is XY a
stock corporation? Give reasons for your answer? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
XY is a stock corporation because it is organized as a stock
corporation and there is no prohibition in its Articles of
Incorporation or its by-laws for it to declare dividends.
When a corporation is organized as a stock corporation
and its articles of Incorporation or By-Laws
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
are silent, the corporation is deemed to have the power to
declare dividends under Sec 43. Since it has the power to
declare dividends, XY is a stock corporation.
The provision of the Articles of Incorporation that at
dissolution the assets of the corporation shall be given to a
charitable corporation does not prohibit the corporation
from declaring dividends before dissolution.
Corporation; Validity of Corporate Acts (1998)
The stockholders of People Power Inc (PPI) approved
two resolutions in a special stockholders meeting: a)
Resolution increasing the authorized capital stock of PPI;
and b) Resolution authorizing the BOD to issue, for cash
payment, the new shares from the proposed capital stock
increase in favor of outside investors who are
non-stockholders.
The foregoing resolutions were approved by stockholders
representing 99% of the total outstanding capital stock. The
sole dissenter was Jimmy Morato who owned 1% of the
stock.
1. Are the resolutions binding on the corporation and its
stockholders including Jimmy Morato, the dissenting
stockholder? (3%)
2. What remedies, if any, are available to Morato? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. No. The resolutions are not binding on the corporation and
its stockholders including Jimmy Morato. While these
resolutions were approved by the stockholders, the directors
approval, which is required by law in such case, does not
exist.
2. Jimmy Morato can petition the SEC (Now RTC) to declare
the 2 resolutions, as well as any and all actions taken by the
BOD thereunder, null and void.
Corporation; Validity of Corporate Acts (2002)
Which of the following corporate acts are valid, void, or
voidable? Indicate your answer by writing the paragraph
number of the query, followed by your corresponding
answer as Valid, Void, or Voidable, as the case may
be. If your answer is Void, explain your answer. In case
of a Voidable answer, specify what conditions must be
present or complied with to make the corporate act valid.
(5%) 1) XL Foods Corporation, which is engaged in the
fast-
food business, entered into a contract with its President
Jose Cruz, whereby the latter would supply the
corporation with its meat and poultry requirements.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Voidable A contract of the corporation with one or
more of its directors or trustees or officers is voidable, at
the option of such corporation (Sec 32, Corporation
Code).
2) The Board of Directors of XL Foods
Corporation declared and paid cash dividends without
approval of the stockholders.
Page 33 of 103
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Valid
3) XL Foods Corporation guaranteed the loan of its
sister company XL Meat Products, Inc.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Void This is an ultra vires act on part of XL Foods
Corporation, and is not one of the powers provided for in
Sec. 36 of the Corporation Code.
Corporation; Voluntary Dissolution (2002)
Name three (3) methods by which a stock corporation
may be voluntarily dissolved. Explain each method. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The three (3) methods by which a stock corporation may
be voluntarily dissolved are: 1) Voluntary Dissolution
where no creditors are
affected. This is done by a majority vote of the
directors, and resolution of at least 2/3 vote of
stockholders, submitted to the Securities and
Exchange Commission.
2) Voluntary dissolution where creditors are affected.
This is done by a petition for dissolution which must be
filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission, signed
by a majority of the members of the board of directors,
verified by the president or secretary, and upon affirmative
vote of stockholders representing at least 2/3 of the
outstanding capital stock.
3) Dissolution by shortening of the corporate term.
This is done by amendment of the articles of
incorporation.
Corporation; Voting Trust Agreement (1992)
A distressed company executed a voting trust agreement
for a period of three years over 60% of its outstanding paid
up shares in favor of a bank to whom it was indebted, with
the Bank named as trustee. Additionally, the Company
mortgaged all its properties to the Bank. Because of the
insolvency of the Company, the Bank foreclosed the
mortgaged properties, and as the highest bidder, acquired
said properties and assets of the Company.
The three-year period prescribed in the Voting Trust
Agreement having expired, the company demanded the
turn-over and transfer of all its assets and properties,
including the management and operation of the Company,
claiming that under the Voting Trust Agreement, the Bank
was constituted as trustee of the management and
operations of the Company.
Does the demand of the Company tally with the concept
of a Voting Trust Agreement? Explain briefly.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The demand of the company does not tally with the
concept of a Voting Trust Agreement. The Voting Trust
Agreement merely conveys to the trustee the right to vote
the shares of grantor/s. The consequence of foreclosure of
the mortgaged properties would be alien to the Voting
Trust Agreement and its effects.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 34 of 103
NOTE: (per Dondee) The law simply provides that a voting trust
agreement is an agreementin writing whereby one or more
stockholders of a corporation consentto transfer his or
theirshares to a trustee in orderto vestin the lattervoting or other
rights pertaining to said shares for a period not exceeding five
years upon the fulfi mentofstat
utory
conditions
and such
other terms
and
conditions
specified in
the agreem
ent. The five
year-period
m ay be
extended in
cases where
the voting
trust is
executed
pursuant to
a loan
agreementw
hereby the
period is
made
contingentup
on full paym
entofthe
loan.
Undersection 59 ofthe C orporation C ode, supra, a voting trust
agreem ent may confer upon a trustee not only the stockholder's
voting rights butalso otherrights pertaining to his shares as long
as the voting trustagreem entis notentered "for the purpose of
circum venting the law againstmonopolies and
illegalcombinations in restraintoftrade orused forpurposes
offraud." (section 59, 5th paragraph ofthe Corporation Code).
Thus, the traditional concept of a voting trust agreem ent
primarily intended to single out a stockholder's right to vote from
his other rights as such and m ade irrevocable for a lim ited
duration m ay in practice becom e a legal device whereby a
transfer of the stockholders shares is effected subjectto the
specific provision ofthe voting trustagreem ent.
The execution of a voting trust agreem ent, therefore, m ay create
a dichotom y between the equitable or beneficial ownership ofthe
corporate shares ofa stockholder, on the one hand, and the
legaltitle thereto on the other hand. (Lee vs. CA, Feb. 4, 1992)
Derivative Suit: Requisites (2004)
AA, a minority stockholder, filed a suit against BB, CC,
DD, and EE, the holders of majority shares of MOP
Corporation, for alleged misappropriation of corporate
funds. The complaint averred, inter alia, that MOP
Corporation is the corporation in whose behalf and for
whose benefit the derivative suit is brought. In their
capacity as members of the Board of Directors, the
majority stockholders adopted a resolution authorizing
MOP Corporation to withdraw the suit. Pursuant to said
resolution, the corporate counsel filed a Motion to Dismiss
in the name of the MOP Corporation. Should the motion
be granted or denied? Reason briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. All the requisites for a valid derivative suit exist in this
case. First, AA was exempt from exhausting his remedies
within the corporation, and did not have to make a
demand on the Board of Directors for the latter to sue.
Here, such a demand would be futile, since the directors
who comprise the majority (namely, BB, CC, DD and EE)
are the ones guilty of the wrong complained of.
Second, AA appears to be stockholder at the time the
alleged misappropriation of corporate funds.
Third, the suit is brought on behalf and for the benefit of
MOP Corporation. In this connection, it was held in
Conmart (Phils.) Inc. v. Securities and Exchange Commission, 198 SCRA
73 (1991) that to grant to the corporation concerned the
right of withdrawing or dismissing the suit, at the instance
of the majority stockholders and directors who themselves
are the persons alleged to have
committed the breach of trust against the interests of the
corporation would be to emasculate the right of minority
stockholders to seek redress for the corporation. Filing
such action as a derivative suit even by a lone stockholder
is one of the protections extended by law to minority
stockholders against abuses of the majority.
Derivative Suit: Watered Stock (1993)
A became a stockholder of Prime Real Estate Corporation
(PREC) on July 10, 1991, when he was given one share by
another stockholder to qualify him as a director. A was not
re-elected director in the July 1, 1992 annual meeting but he
continued to be a registered shareholder of PREC.
When he was still a director, A discovered that on Jan 5,
1991, PREC issued free of charge 10,000 shares to X a
lawyer who assisted in a court case involving PREC.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) As a general rule, A cannot bring a derivative suit in the
name of the corporation concerning an act that took place
before he became a stockholder. However, if the act
complained of is a continuing one, A may do so.
2) No. In a derivative suit, the action is instituted/ brought
in the name of a corporation and reliefs are prayed for
therein for the corporation, by a minority stockholder. The
law does not qualify the term minority in terms of the
number of shares owned by a stockholder bringing the
action in behalf of the corporation. (SMC v Khan 176 SCRA
448)
3) No. WATERED SHARES are those sold by the
corporation for less than the par/book value. In the
instant case, it will depend upon the value of services
rendered in relation to the total par value of the shares.
Derivative Suit; Close Corporation; Corporate
Opportunity (2005)
Malyn, Schiera and Jaz are the directors of Patio
Investments, a close corporation formed to run the Patio
Cafe, an al fresco coffee shop in Makati City. In 2000, Patio
Cafe began experiencing financial reverses, consequently,
some of the checks it issued to its beverage distributors and
employees bounced.
In October 2003, Schiera informed Malyn that she found a
location for a second cafe in Taguig City. Malyn objected
because of the dire financial condition of the corporation.
1
)
Can A now bring an action in the name of the
corporation to question the issuance of the shares
to X without receiving any payment?
2
)
Can X question the right of A to sue him in behalf
of the corporation on the ground that A has only
one share in his name?
3
)
Cannot the shares issued to X be considered as
watered stock?
1
)
when justified by definite corporate expansion
projects or programs approved by the BOD; or
2
)
when the corporation is prohibited under any loan
agreement with any financial institution or creditor,
whether local or foreign, from declaring dividends
without its or his consent, and such consent has not
yet been secured; or
3
)
when it can be clearly shown that such retention is
necessary under special circumstances obtaining in
the corporation, such as when there is need for
special reserve for probable contingencies.
a
.
Page 60 of 103 to print, reprint, publish, copy,
distribute, multiply, sell and make photographs,
photo engravings, and pictorial illustrations of the
works;
b
.
to make any translation or other version or extracts
or arrangements or adaptation thereof; to dramatize
if it be a non-dramatic work; to convert it into a
non-dramatic work if it be a drama; to complete or
execute it if it be a model or design;
c
.
to exhibit, perform, represent, produce or
reproduce the work in any manner or by any
method whatever for profit or otherwise; if not
reproduced in copies for sale, to sell any
manuscripts or any record whatsoever thereof;
d
.
to make any other use or disposition of the work
consistent with the laws of the land
Johann.
a. seize and destroy
b. injunction
damages in such amount may have
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 35 of 103
Sometime in April 2004, Malyn learned about Fort Patio
Cafe located in Taguig City and that its development was
undertaken by a new corporation known as Fort Patio,
Inc., where both Schiera and Jaz are directors. Malyn also
found that Schiera and Jaz, on behalf of Patio Investments,
had obtained a loan of P500,000.00 from PBCom Bank, for
the purpose of opening Fort Patio Cafe. This loan was
secured by the assets of Patio Investments and personally
guaranteed by Schiera and Jaz.
Malyn then filed a corporate derivative action before the
Regional Trial Court of Makati City against Schiera and Jaz,
alleging that the two directors had breached their fiduciary
duties by misappropriating money and assets of Patio
Investments in the operation of Fort Patio Cafe. (5%) 1)
Did Schiera and Jaz violate the principle of
corporate opportunity? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. Although Malyn refused the business before,
nevertheless, using the resources and credit standing of the
company, Schiera and Jaz clearly demonstrated that the
business could have been successfully pursued in the name
of the close corporation. More importantly, Schiera and Jaz
are guilty of diverting the resources of the close
corporation to another entity, equivalent to fraud and bad
faith.
2) Was it proper for Malyn to file a derivative suit
with a prayer for injunctive relief? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Although it is a close corporation, nevertheless the
principles of separate juridical personality still apply. The
business of the corporation is still separate and distinct
from the proprietary interests of its stockholders and
directors. Consequently, since the business opportunity and
the resource's used pertain to the close corporation, the
standing to sue and to recover remains with the close
corporation and not with Malyn. Therefore, it is still
necessary to file a derivative suit on behalf of the close
corporation, although the proceedings would be governed
under the Interim Rules of Procedure for Intra-Corporate
Disputes.
3) Assuming that a derivative suit is proper; may the
action continue if the corporation is dissolved during
the pendency of the suit? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, for in spite of the dissolution of any corporation, it
remains a juridical person for purpose of dissolution for
three years from the date of dissolution, precisely one of
the purposes is to allow the winding-up of its affairs,
including the termination of pending suits.
Derivative Suit; Minority Stockholder (2003)
Gina Sevilla, a minority stockholder of Bayan Corporation,
felt that various investments of the companys capital were
ultra vires if not, indeed, made in violation of law. She filed a
derivative suit seeking to
nullify the questioned investments. Would her action
prosper? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, she is already a stockholder at the time the alleged
misappropriation of corporate funds. And that filing such
action as a derivative suit even by a lone stockholder is one
of the protections extended by law to minority
stockholders against abuses of the majority. Nevertheless,
Gina must first exhaust any administrative remedies before
her suit be consider in court.
Distinction: De facto Corporation vs. Corporation by
Estoppel (2004)
Is there a difference between a de facto corporation and a
corporation by estoppel? Explain briefly. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A DE FACTO CORPORATION is one which actually
exists for all practical purposes as a corporation but which
has no legal right to corporate existence as against the
State. It is essential to the existence of a de facto
corporation that there be (1) a valid law under which a
corporation might be incorporated, (2) a bona fide attempt
to organize as a corporation under such law, and
(3) actual use or exercise in good faith of corporate powers
conferred upon it by law.
A CORPORATION BY ESTOPPEL exists when persons
assume to act as a corporation knowing it to be without
authority to do so. In this case, those persons will be liable
as general partners for all debts, liabilities and damages
incurred or arising as a result of their actions.
Distinction: Dividends vs. Profit: Cash Dividend vs.
Stock Dividend (2005)
Distinguish dividend from profit; cash dividend from
stock dividend. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
PROFITS are residual amounts representing return of
capital after deducting all corporate costs and expenses
from revenues. The accumulated profits, from year to year,
represent the corporate retained earnings from which the
dividends can be declared.
CASH DIVIDENDS represent an actual distribution of
accumulated profits to the stockholders as a return on their
investments. Declaration of cash dividends requires only
the approval of the majority of the Board of Directors in a
proper resolution.
STOCK DIVIDENDS are simply transfers of retained
earnings to capital stock, thereby increasing the number of
shares of stocks of each stockholder with no required cash
contribution. A two-thirds vote of the stockholders,
coupled with a majority vote of the Board of Directors, is
needed to declare stock dividends.
Distinction; Private vs. Public Corporation (2004)
Distinguish clearly a private corporation from a public
corporation
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
A PRIVATE CORPORATION is one formed for some
private purpose, benefit or end, while a PUBLIC
CORPORATION is formed for the government of a
portion of the State for the general good or welfare. The
true test is the purpose of the corporation. If the
corporation is created for political or public purpose
connected with the administration of government, then it is
a public corporation. If not, it is a private corporation
although the whole or substantially the whole interest in
the corporation belongs to the State. A public corporation
is created by special legislation or act of Congress. A
private corporation must be organized under the
Corporation Code.
Distinction; Stock vs. Non-Stock Corporation (2004)
Distinguish clearly a stock corporation from a non-stock
corporation.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A stock corporation is one that has capital stock divided
into shares and is authorized to distribute to the holders of
such shares dividends or allotments of the surplus profits
on the basis of the shares held. All other corporations are
non-stock corporations.
Dividends: Declaration of Dividends (2005)
Under what circumstances may a corporation declare
dividends? (2%)'
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No form of dividends can be declared and paid by the
corporation except from unrestricted retained earnings
appearing on its books. Dividends must be paid in amounts
proportional to all stockholders on the basis of outstanding
stock held by them. Cash or property dividends, can be
declared from such unrestricted retained earnings by a
proper resolution of the Board of Directors. Stock
dividends, however, must be declared by a proper
resolution of the Board of Directors from existing
unrestricted retained earnings and ratified by stockholders
representing at least two-thirds (2/8) of the outstanding
capital stock of the corporation, obtained in a meeting duly
called for the purpose. (Sec. 43, Corporation Code)
Dividends: Sources of Dividends; Trust Fund Doctrine
(2005)
From what funds are cash and stock dividends sourced?
Explain why. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
All cash and stock dividends are always paid out of the
unrestricted retained earnings (also called surplus profit) of
the corporation. If the corporation has no unrestricted
retained earnings, the dividends would have to be sourced
from the capital stock. This is illegal. It violates the
"TRUST FUND DOCTRINE" that provides that the
capital stock of the corporation is a trust fund to be kept
intact during the life of the corporation for the benefit of
the creditors of the corporation. (Commissioner of Internal-
Revenue v. Court of Appeal, G.R. No. 108576, January 20, 1999;
Boman Environmental Development Corp. v. Court of Appeals,
G.R. No. 77860, November 22, 1988; and Steinberg v. Velasco, G.R.
No. 30460, March 12,1929)
Page 36 of 103
Dividends; Declaration of Dividends (1990)
At least 2/3 of the stockholders of Solar Corporation,
meeting upon the recommendation of the BOD, declared
a 50% stock dividend during their annual meeting. The
notice of the annual stockholders meeting did not mention
anything about a stock dividend declaration. The matter
was taken up only under the item other business in the
agenda of the meeting. C.K. Senwa, a stockholder, who
received his copy of the notice but did not attend the
meeting, subsequently learned about the 50% stock
dividend declaration. He desires to have the stock dividend
declaration cancelled and set aside, and wishes to retain
your services as a lawyer for the purpose. Will you accept
the case? Discuss with reasons.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
I will not accept the case. Sec 43 of the Corp Code states
that no stock dividend shall be issued without the approval
of the stockholders representing not less than 2/3 of the
outstanding capital stock at a regular or special meeting
duly called for that purpose. Conformably with Sec 50 of
the Corp Code, a written notice of the holding of the
regular meeting sent to the shareholders will suffice. The
notice itself specified the said subject matter.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Yes, I will accept the case. The problem does not indicate
that there is action by the BOD which is also necessary
for the declaration of 50% stock dividend.
Dividends; Declaration of Dividends (1991)
During the annual stockholders meeting, Riza, a
stockholder proposed to the body that a part of the
corporations unreserved earned surplus be capitalized and
stock dividends be distributed to the stockholders, arguing
that as owners of the company, the stockholders, by a
majority vote, can do anything. As chairman of the meeting,
how would you rule on the motion to declare stock
dividends?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
As the chairman of the meeting, I would rule against the
motion considering that a declaration of stock dividends
should initially be taken by the BOD and thereafter to be
concurred in by a 2/3 vote of the stockholders (Sec 43
Corp Code). There is no prohibition, however, against the
stockholders resolving to recommend to the BOD that it
consider a declaration of stock dividends for concurrence
thereafter by the stockholders.
Dividends; Declaration of Dividends (2001)
For the past three years of its commercial operation, X, an
oil company, has been earning tremendously in excess of
100% of the corporations paid-in capital. All of the
stockholders have been claiming that they share in the
profits of the corporation by way of dividends but the
Board of Directors failed to lift its finger. a) Is
Corporation X guilty of violating a law? If in the
affirmative, state the basis (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Corporation X is guilty of violating Section 43 of the Corp
Code. This provision prohibits stock corporations
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
from retaining surplus profits in excess of 100% of their
paid-in capital.
b) Are there instances when a corporation shall not be
held liable for not declaring dividends? (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The instances when a corporation shall not be held liable
for not declaring dividends are:
Dividends; Right; Managing Corporation (1991)
ABC Management Inc. presented to the DEF Mining Co,
the draft of its proposed Management Contract. As an
incentive, ABC included in the terms of compensation that
ABC would be entitled to 10% of any stock dividend
which DEF may declare during the lifetime of the
Management Contract. Would you approve of such
provision? If not, what would you suggest as an
alternative?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
I would not approve a proposed stipulation in the
management contract that the managing corporation, as an
additional compensation to it, should be entitled to 10% of
any stock dividend that may be declared. Stockholders are
the only ones entitled to receive stock dividends (Nielsen &
Co v Lepanto Mining 26 s 569) I would add that the
unsubscribed capital stock of a corporation may only be
issued for cash or property or for services already rendered
constituting a demandable debt (Sec 62 Corp Code). As an
alternative, I would suggest that the managing corporation
should instead be given a net profit participation and, if it
later so desires, to then convert the amount that may be
due thereby to equity or shares of stock at no less than the
par value thereof.
Doctrine of Corporate Opportunity (2005)
Briefly discuss the doctrine of corporate opportunity. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
In brief, the doctrine disqualifies a director, trustee or
officer from appropriating for his personal benefit a
transaction or opportunity that pertains to the corporation,
and which under the duty of loyalty he should first bring to
the corporation for its use or exploitation.
The doctrine of corporate opportunity is an enforcement
of the duty of loyalty of corporate directors and officers.
When a director, trustee or officer attempts to acquire or
Page 37 of 103 acquires, in violation of his duty, an
interest adverse to the corporation in respect of any matter
which has been reposed in him in confidence, he shall be
liable as a trustee for the corporation and must account for
the profits which otherwise would have accrued to the
corporation. Equity imposes liability upon him not to deal
for his own benefit. (Sec. 31, Corporation Code)
Under Sec. 34 of the Corporation Code where a director,
by virtue of his office, acquires for himself a business
opportunity which should belong to the corporation,
thereby obtaining profits to the prejudice of such
corporation, he must account to the latter for all such
profits by refunding the same, unless his act has been
ratified by a vote of the stockholders owning or
representing at least two-thirds (2/8) of the outstanding
capital stock.
Effect: Expiration of Corporate Term (2004)
XYZ Corporation entered into a contract of lease with
ABC, Inc., over a piece of real estate for a term of 20 years,
renewable for another 20 years, provided that XYZ's
corporate term is extended in accordance with law. Four
years after the term of XYZ Corporation expired, but still
within the period allowed by the lease contract for the
extension of the lease period, XYZ Corp. notified ABC,
Inc., that it is exercising the option to extend the lease.
ABC, Inc., objected to the proposed extension, arguing that
since the corporate life of XYZ Corp. had expired, it could
no longer opt to renew the lease. XYZ Corp. countered
that withstanding the lapse of its corporate term it still has
the right to renew the lease because no quo warranto
proceedings for involuntary dissolution of XYZ Corp. has
been instituted by the Office of the Solicitor General. Is the
contention of XYZ Corp. meritorious? Explain briefly.
(5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
XYZ Corporation's contention is not meritorious. Based
on the ruling of the Supreme Court in Philippine National Bank
vs. CFI of Rizal, 209 SCRA (1992). XYZ Corp. was dissolved
ipso facto upon the expiration of its original term. It
ceased to be a body corporate for the purpose of
continuing the business for which it was organized, except
only for purposes connected with its winding up or
liquidation. Extending the lease is not an act to wind up or
liquidate XYZ Corp.'s affairs. It is contrary to the idea of
winding up the affairs of the corporation.
Effects; Merger of Corporations (1999)
Two corporations agreed to merge. They then executed an
agreement specifying the surviving corporation and the
absorbed corporation. Under the agreement of merger
dated November 5, 1998, the surviving corporation
acquired all the rights, properties and liabilities of the
absorbed corporation. 1) What would happen to the
absorbed corporation?
Must the absorbed corporation undertake
dissolution and the winding up procedures? Explain
your answer. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1
)
Can A now bring an action in the name of the
corporation to question the issuance of the shares
to X without receiving any payment?
2
)
Can X question the right of A to sue him in behalf
of the corporation on the ground that A has only
one share in his name?
3
)
Cannot the shares issued to X be considered as
watered stock?
1
)
when justified by definite corporate expansion
projects or programs approved by the BOD; or
2
)
when the corporation is prohibited under any loan
agreement with any financial institution or creditor,
whether local or foreign, from declaring dividends
without its or his consent, and such consent has not
yet been secured; or
3
)
when it can be clearly shown that such retention is
necessary under special circumstances obtaining in
the corporation, such as when there is need for
special reserve for probable contingencies.
a
.
Page 60 of 103 to print, reprint, publish, copy,
distribute, multiply, sell and make photographs,
photo engravings, and pictorial illustrations of the
works;
b
.
to make any translation or other version or extracts
or arrangements or adaptation thereof; to dramatize
if it be a non-dramatic work; to convert it into a
non-dramatic work if it be a drama; to complete or
execute it if it be a model or design;
c
.
to exhibit, perform, represent, produce or
reproduce the work in any manner or by any
method whatever for profit or otherwise; if not
reproduced in copies for sale, to sell any
manuscripts or any record whatsoever thereof;
d
.
to make any other use or disposition of the work
consistent with the laws of the land
Johann.
a. seize and destroy
b. injunction
c.
damages in such amount may have
bee
n
obtained from the use of the invention
i
f
properly transacted which can be more
tha
n
what the infringer (Johann ) received.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
No. There is no need for the absorbed corporation to
undertake dissolution and winding up procedure. As a
result of the merger, the absorbed corporation is
automatically dissolved and its assets and liabilities are
acquired and assumed by the surviving corporation.
2) Pending approval of the merger by the SEC,
may the surviving corporation already institute suits to
collect all receivables due to the absorbed corporation
from its customers? Explain your answer. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The merger does not become effective until and unless
approved by the SEC. Before approval by the SEC of the
merger, the surviving corporation has no legal personality
with respect to receivables due to the absorbed
corporation.
3) A case was filed against a customer to collect on
the promissory note issued by him after the date of the
merger agreement. The customer raised the defense that
while the receivables as of the date of the merger agreement
was transferred to the surviving corporation, those
receivables which were created after the merger agreement
remained to be owned by the absorbed corporation. These
receivables would be distributed to the stockholders
conformably with the dissolution and liquidation procedures
under the New Corporation Code? Discuss the merits of
this argument. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Whether the receivable was incurred by the absorbed
corporation before or after the merger agreement, or
before or after the approval thereof by the SEC, the said
receivable would still belong to the surviving corporation
under Sec 80 of the Corp. Code which does not make any
distinction as to the assets and liabilities of the absorbed
corporation that the surviving corporation would inherit.
Effects; Winding Up Period of a Corporation (1997)
The corporation, once dissolved, thereafter continues to
be a body corporate for three years for purposes of
prosecuting and defending suits by and against it and of
enabling it to settle and close its affairs, culminating in the
final disposition and distribution of its remaining assets. If
the 3 year extended life expires without a trustee or
receiver being designated by the corporation within that
period and by that time (expiry of the 3 year extended
term), the corporate liquidation is not yet over, how, if at
all, can a final settlement of the corporate affairs be made?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The liquidation can continue with the winding up. The
members of the BOD can continue with the winding of
the corporate affairs until final liquidation. They can act as
trustees or receivers for this purpose.
Effects; Winding Up Period of a Corporation (2000)
The SEC approved the amendment of the Articles of
Incorporation of GHQ Corp shortening its corporate life
to only 25 years in accordance with Sec 120 of the Corp
Page 38 of 103 Code. As shortened, the corporation
continued its business operations until May 30, 1997, the
last day of its corporate existence. Prior to said date, there
were a number of pending civil actions, of varying nature
but mostly money claims filed by creditors, none of which
was expected to be completed or resolved within five years
from May 30, 1997.
If the creditors had sought your professional help at that
time about whether or not their cases could be pursued
beyond May 30, 1997, what would have been your advice?
(2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The cases can be pursued even beyond May 30, 1997, the
last day of the corporate existence of GHQ Corp. The
Corporation is not actually dissolved upon the expiration
of its corporate term. There is still the period for
liquidation or winding up.
NOTE: Under Section 122 of the C orporation C ode, a
corporation whose corporate existence is terminated in any
manner continues to be a body corporate for three (3) years
afterits dissolution forpurposes ofprosecuting and defending
suits by and againstitand to enable itto se le and
close its
affairs,
culminating
in the
disposition
and
distribution
of its rem
aining
assets.
Itmay, during
the
three-yearter
m , appointa
trustee ora
receiverwho
m ay
actbeyond
thatperiod.
The termination ofthe life of a corporate entity does notby itself
cause the extinction or dim inution of the rights and liabilities
ofsuch entity. 27 If the three-yearextended life has expired
without a trustee or receiver having been expressly designated
by the corporation, within thatperiod, the board of directors (or
trustees) itself, m ay be permi
ed to so
continue as
"trustees" by
legal im
plication to
com plete
the corporate
liquidation.
(PEPSI-COL
A
PHILIPPINE
S, INC., vs.
THE COURT
OF
APPEALS,
[G.R. No.
145855.
November
24, 2004.])
Foreign Corporation; Doing Business in the
Philippines (1998)
When is a foreign corporation deemed to be doing
business in the Philippines? (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A foreign corporation is deemed to be doing business in
the Philippines if it is continuing the body or substance
of the business or enterprise for which it was organized. It
is the intention of an entity to continue the body of its
business in the country. The grant and extension of 90day
credit terms of a foreign corporation to a domestic
corporation for every purchase shows an intention to
continue transacting with the latter.
Foreign Corporation; Doing Business in the
Philippines; Acts or Activities (2002)
Give at least three (3) examples of the acts or activities that
are specifically identified under our foreign investment laws
as constituting doing business in the Philippines (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Any three (3) of the following acts or activities constitute
doing business in the Philippines under our foreign
investment laws:
1. Soliciting orders
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
2. Opening offices by whatever
name
3. Participating in the management, supervision or
control of any domestic entity
4. Entering into service
contracts
5. Appointing representatives or distributors,
operating under the control of the foreign entity, who is
domiciled in the Philippines or who stays in the country
for a period or periods totaling at least 180 days in any
calendar year.
Foreign Corporation; Doing Business in the
Philippines; Test (2002)
What is the legal test for determining if an unlicensed
foreign corporation is doing business in the Philippines?
(2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The test is whether or not the unlicensed foreign
corporation has performed an act or acts that imply a
continuity of commercial dealings or arrangements, and
contemplate to that extent the performance of acts or
works, or the exercise of some of the functions normally
incident to, and in progressive prosecution of, commercial
gain or of the purpose and object of the business
corporation.
Joint Venture; Corporation (1996)
May a corporation enter into a joint venture?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A corporation may enter into a joint venture. However,
inasmuch as the term joint venture has no precise legal
definition, it may take various forms. It could take the form
of a simple pooling of resources (not involving
incorporation) between two or more corporations for a
specific project, purpose or undertaking, or for a limited
time. It may involve the creation of a more formal
structure and, hence, the formation of a corporation. If the
joint venture would involve the creation of a partnership,
as the term is understood under the Civil Code, then a
corporation cannot be a party to it.
Liabilities; BOD; Corporate Acts (1996)
When may a corporate director, trustee, or officer be held
personally liable with the corporation?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A corporate director, trustee or officer may be held
personally liable with the corporation under the following
circumstances: 1) When he assents to a patently unlawful
act of the
corporation; 2) When he acts in bad faith or with gross
negligence in
directing the affairs of the corporation, or in conflict
with the interest of the corporation resulting in
damages to the corporation, its stockholders or
other persons; 3) When he consents to the issuance of
watered stocks
or who, having knowledge thereof, does not
forthwith file with the corporate secretary his written
objection thereto; 4) When he agrees to hold himself
personally and
solidarily liable with the corporation; or
Page 39 of 103 5) When he is made, by a specific
provision of law, to
personally answer for the corporate action. (Tramat
Mercantile Inc v CA GR 111008, Nov 7, 94 238s14)
Liabilities; Stockholders, Directors, Officers (1997)
A, B, and C are shareholders of XYZ Co. A has an unpaid
subscription of P100th, Bs shares are fully paid up, while
C owns only nominal but fully paid up shares and is a
director and officer. XYZ becomes insolvent, and it is
established that the insolvency is the result of fraudulent
practices within the company. If you were counsel for a
creditor of XYZ, would you advise legal action against A,
B, and C?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) As to Aan action can be brought against A for P100th
which is the amount of unpaid subscription. Since the
corporation is insolvent, the limit of the stockholders
liability to the creditor is only up to the extent of his
unpaid subscription.
b) As to Bthere is no cause of action against B because
he has already fully paid for his subscription. As stated
earlier, the limit of the stockholders liability to the creditor
of the corporation, when the latter becomes insolvent, is
the extent of his subscription.
c) As to Can action can be filed against C, not as
stockholder because he has already paid up the shares, but
in his capacity as director and officer because of the
corporations insolvency being the result of fraudulent
practices within the company. Directors are liable jointly
and severally for damages sustained by the corporation,
stockholders or other persons resulting from gross
negligence or bad faith in directing the affairs of the
corporation. (Sec 31 Corp Code)
Piercing the Corporate Veil (1994)
Mr. Pablo, a rich merchant in his early forties, was a
defendant in a lawsuit which could subject him to
substantial damages. A year before the court rendered
judgment, Pablo sought his lawyers advice on how to plan
his estate to avoid taxes. His lawyer suggested that he should
form a corporation with himself, his wife and his children
(all students and still unemployed) as stockholders and then
transfer all his assets and liabilities to this corporation. Mr
Pablo followed the recommendation of his lawyer. 1 year
later, the court rendered judgment against Pablo and the
plaintiff sought to enforce this judgment. The sheriff,
however, could not locate any property in the name of Pablo
and therefore returned the writ of execution unsatisfied.
What remedy, if any, is available to the plaintiff?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The plaintiff can avail himself of the doctrine of piercing
the veil of corporate fiction which can be invoked when a
corporation is formed or used in avoiding a just obligation.
While it is true that a family corporation may be organized
to pursue an estate tax; planning, which is not per se illegal
or unlawful (Delpher Trades Corp v IAC 157 SCRA 349) the
factual settings, however, indicate the existence of a
lawsuit that could subject Pablo to a
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
substantial amount of damages. It would thus be difficult
for Pablo to convincingly assert that the incorporation of
the family corporation was intended merely as a case of
estate tax planning. (Tan Boon Bee v Jarencio 41337 30June88)
Piercing the Corporate Veil (1996)
E Co sold its assets to M Inc after complying with the
requirements of the Bulk Sales Law. Subsequently, one of
the creditors of E Co tried to collect the amount due it,
but found out that E Co had no more assets left. The
creditor then sued M Inc on the theory that M Inc is a
mere alter ego of E Co. Will the suit prosper? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The suit will not prosper. The sale by E Co of its assets to
M Inc does not result in the transfer of the liabilities of the
latter to, nor in the assumption thereof by, the former. The
facts given do not indicate that such transfer or
assumption took place or was stipulated upon by the
parties in their agreement. Furthermore, the sale by E Co
of its assets is a sale of its property. It does not involve the
sale of the shares of stock of the corporation belonging to
its stockholders. There is therefore no merger or
consolidation that took place. E Co continues to exist and
remains liable to the creditor.
Piercing the Corporate Veil (2001)
Plaintiffs filed a collection action against X Corporation.
Upon execution of the courts decision, X Corporation
was found to be without assets. Thereafter plaintiffs filed
an action against its present and past stockholder Y
Corporation which owned substantially all of the stocks of
X Corporation. The two corporations have the same board
of directors and Y Corporation financed the operations of
X Corporation. May Y Corporation be held liable for the
debts of X Corporation? Why? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, Y Corporation may be held liable for the debts of X
Corporation. The doctrine of piercing the veil of
corporation fiction applies to this case. The two
corporations have the same board of directors and Y
Corporation owned substantially all of the stocks of X
Corporation, which facts justify the conclusion that the
latter is merely an extension of the personality of the
former, and that the former controls the policies of the
latter. Added to this is the fact that Y Corporation controls
the finances of X Corporation which is merely an adjunct,
business conduit or alter ego of Y Corporation (CIR v Norton
& Harrison Co 11 S 714 (1964))
Piercing the Corporate Veil (2004)
How does one pierce the veil of corporate fiction?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The veil of corporate fiction may be pierced by proving in
court that the notion of legal entity is being used to defeat
public convenience, justify wrong, protect fraud, or
defend crime or the entity is just an instrument or alter
ego or adjunct of another entity or person.
Piercing the Corporate Veil (2006)
Page 40 of 103
What is the doctrine of "piercing the veil of corporate
entity?" Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The doctrine of "piercing the veil of corporate entity," is
the doctrine that allows the courts to look behind the
separate juridical personality of a corporation and treat the
corporation as an association of persons and thereby make
the individual actors personally liable for corporate
liabilities. The fiction of corporate identity is disregarded
and the individuals comprising it can be treated identically.
The stockholders can be held directly liable for corporate
obligations, even to the extent of their personal assets
(Concept Builders v. NLRC, Marabe, et al,
G.R. No. 108734, May 29, 1996).
To what circumstances will the doctrine apply? (2.5%)
The doctrine is applicable when the notion of legal entity
is used to 1) Defeat public convenience. 2) Justify
wrong. 3) Protect fraud. 4) Defend crime (PNB v. Andrada
Electric, G.R. No.
142936, April 17, 2002).
5) Shield a violation of the proscription against
forum shopping (First Philippine International Bank v. Court of
Appeals, G.R. No. 137537, January 24, 1996).
6) Work inequities among members of the
corporation internally, involving no rights of the public or
third persons (Secosa v. Heirs ofErwin Suarez Francisco, G.R. No.
156104, June 29, 2004).
7) Evade the lawful obligations of the corporation
like a judgment credit (Sibagat Timber Corp. v. Garcia,
G.R. No. 112546, December 11, 1992). 8) Escape liability arising
from a debt (Arcilla v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 88113, October
23, 1992).
9) Avoid inclusion of corporate assets as part of the
estate of the decedent (Cease v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No.
L-35861, October 18, 1979).
10) To promote or to shield unfair objectives
(Villanueva v. Adre, G.R. No. 80863, April 27, 1989).
Pre-emptive Right (2001)
Suppose that X Corporation has already issued the 1000
originally authorized shares of the corporation so that its
BOD and stockholders wish to increase Xs authorized
capital stock. After complying with the requirements of the
law on increase of capital stock, X issued an additional
1000 shares of the same value. a) Assume that the
stockholder A presently holds 200 out of the 1000 original
shares. Would A have a pre-emptive right to 200 of the
new issue of 1000 shares? Why? (3%)
b) When should stockholder A exercise the pre-emptive
right? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Yes, A would have a pre-emptive right to 200 of the
new issue of 1000 shares. A is a stockholder of record
holding 200 shares in X Corpo. According to the Corp
Code, each stockholder has the pre-emptive right to all
issues of shares made by the corporation in proportion to
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
the number of shares he holds on record in the
corporation.
b) Pre-emptive right must be exercised in accordance with
the Articles of Incorporation or the By-Laws. When the
Articles of Incorporation and the By-Laws are silent, the
BOD may fix a reasonable time within which the
stockholders may exercise the right.
Pre-Emptive Right vs. Appraisal Right (1999)
ABC Corporation has an authorized capital stock of P1M
divided into 50,000 common shares and 50,000 preferred
shares. At its inception, the Corporation offered for
subscription all the common shares. However, only 40,000
shares were subscribed. Recently, the directors thought of
raising additional capital and decided to offer to the public
all the authorized shares of the Corporation at their market
value. a) Would Mr. X, a stockholder holding 4,000 shares,
have pre-emptive rights to the remaining 10,000 shares?
(2%) b) Would Mr. X have pre-emptive rights to the
50,000 preferred shares? (2%)
c) Assuming that the existing stockholders are
entitled to pre-emptive rights, at what price will the shares
be offered? (2%)
d) Assuming a stockholder disagrees with the
issuance of new shares and the pricing for the shares, may
the stockholder invoke his appraisal rights and demand
payment for his shareholdings? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a. Yes. Mr. X, a stockholder holding 4,000 shares, has
pre-emptive right to the remaining 10,000 shares. All
stockholders of a stock corporation shall enjoy preemptive
right to subscribe to all issues or disposition of shares of
any class, in proportion to their respective shareholdings.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER.
a. No, Mr X does not have pre-emptive right over the
remaining 10,000 shares because these shares have already
been offered at incorporation and he chose not to
subscribe to them. He, therefore, has waived his right
thereto and the corporation may offer them to anyone.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
b. Yes. Mr. X would have pre-emptive rights to the 50,000
preferred shares. All stockholders of a stock corporation
shall enjoy pre-emptive right to subscribe to all issues or
disposition of shares of any class, in proportion to their
respective shareholdings.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
b. Yes, Mr. X has preemptive right over the 50,000
preferred shares because they were not offered before by
the corporation for subscription.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
c. The shares will be offered to existing stockholders, who
are entitled to preemptive right, at a price fixed by the
BOD, which shall not be less than the par value of such
shares.
Page 41 of 103
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
d. No, the stockholder may not exercise appraisal right
because the matter that he dissented from is not one of
those where right of appraisal is available under the
corporation code.
SEC; Jurisdiction; Transferred Jurisdiction (1996)
What is the original and exclusive jurisdiction of the SEC?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The SEC has original and exclusive jurisdiction over cases
involving: a) Devices or schemes amounting to fraud and
misrepresentation; b) Controversies arising out of
intra-corporate or partnership relations; c) Controversies in
the election or appointment of directors, officers, etc; d)
Petitions to be declared in a state of suspension of
payments (Sec 5 PD 902-A)
TAKE NOTE: The RTC has jurisdiction over the cases
which involves intra-corporate controversy. As of 2006, the
applicable rule is that there is a TRANSFERRED
JURISDICTION under Sec. 5.2 of the SRC, the
Commissions jurisdiction over all cases enumerated under
PD 902-A sec. 5 has been transferred to the Courts of
general jurisdiction or the appropriate Regional Trial Court.
Stockholder; Delinquent; Unpaid Subscription (1997)
The BOD of a corporation, by a vote of ten in favor of one
against, declared due and payable all unpaid subscription to
the capital stock. The lone dissenting director failed to pay
on due date, i.e., 19 Sept 1997, his unpaid subscription.
Other than the shares wherein he was unable to complete
payment, he did not own any share in the corporation. On
23 Sept 1997, he was informed by the BOD that, unless
due payment is meanwhile received, he: a) could no longer
serve as a director of the
corporation forthwith:
b) would not be entitled to the cash and stock
dividends which were declared and payable on 24 Sep
1997; and
c) could not vote in the stockholders meeting
scheduled to take place on 26 Sept 1997.
Was the action of the BOD on each of the foregoing
matters valid?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) No. The period of 30 days within which the stockholder
can pay the unpaid subscription had not yet expired.
b) No. The delinquency did not deprive the stockholder
of his right to receive dividends declared. However, the
cash dividend declared may be applied by the corporation
to the unpaid subscription. (Sec 71 Corp Code)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
c) No. The period of 30 days within which the stockholder
can pay the unpaid subscription had not yet expired.
Stockholders: Preemptive Right (2004)
The Board of Directors of ABC, Inc., a domestic
corporation, passed a resolution authorizing additional
issuance of shares of stocks without notice nor approval of
the stockholders. DX, a stockholder, objected to the
issuance, contending that it violated his right of pre-
emption to the unissued shares. Is his contention tenable?
Explain briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. DX's contention is tenable. Under Section 39 of the
Corporation Code, all stockholders of ABC, Inc. enjoy
preemptive right to subscribe to all issues of shares of any
class, including the reissuance of treasury shares in
proportion to their respective shareholdings.
Stockholders; Appraisal Right (2003)
In what instances may the right of appraisal be availed of
under the Corporation Code?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
SECTION 81. Instances of Appraisal Right. Any
stockholder of a corporation shall have the right to dissent
and demand payment of the fair value of his shares in the
following instances:
1 In case any amendment to the articles of incorporation
has the effect of changing or restricting the rights of any
stockholders or class of shares, or of authorizing preferences in
any respect superior to those of outstanding shares of any class, or
of extending or shortening the term of corporate existence;
2 In case of sale, lease, exchange, transfer, mortgage,
pledge or other disposition of all or substantially all of the
corporate property and assets as provided in the Code; and
3 In case of merger or consolidation. (n)
Stockholders; Removal of Officers & BOD (2001)
In 1999, Corporation A passed a board resolution
removing X from his position as manager of said
corporation. The by-laws of A corporation provides that
the officers are the president, vice-president, treasurer and
secretary. Upon complaint filed with the SEC, it held that a
manager could be removed by mere resolution of the board
of directors. On motion for reconsideration, X alleged that
he could only be removed by the affirmative vote of the
stockholders representing 2/3 of the outstanding capital
stock. Is Xs contention legally tenable. Why? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. Stockholders approval is necessary only for the
removal of the members of the BOD. For the removal of
a corporate officer or employee, the vote of the BOD is
sufficient for the purpose.
Stockholders; Removal; Minority Director (1991)
Assuming that the minority block of the XYZ Corporation
is able to elect only 1 director and therefore,
Page 42 of 103
the majority stockholders can always muster a 2/3 vote,
would you allow the majority stockholders to remove the
one director representing the minority?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. I will not allow the majority stockholders to remove
the director. While the stockholders may, by a 2/3 vote,
remove a director, the law also provides, however, that his
right may not, without just cause, be exercised so as to
deprive the minority of representation in the BOD (Sec 28
Corp code; Govt vs Agoncillo 50p348)
Stockholders; Rights (1996)
What are the rights of a stockholder?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The rights of a stockholder are as follows: 1) The right to
vote, including the right to appoint a proxy; 2) The right
to share in the profits of the corporation, including the
right to declare stock dividends; 3) The right to a
proportionate share of the assets of
the corporation upon liquidation; 4) The right of
appraisal; 5) The pre-emptive right to shares; 6) The right
to inspect corporate books and records; 7) The right to
elect directors; 8) Such other rights as may contractually
be granted to
the stockholders by the corporation or by special law.
Stockholders; Voting Power of Stockholders (1990)
Mercy subscribed to 1,000 shares of stock of Rosario
Corporation. She paid 25% of said subscription. During
the stockholders meeting, can Mercy vote all her
subscribed shares? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, Mercy can vote all her subscribed shares. Section 72 of
the Corporation Code states that holders of subscribed
shares not fully paid which are not delinquent shall have all
the rights of a stockholder.
Stocks; Increase of Capital Stock (2001)
Suppose X Corporation has an authorized capital stock
of P1M divided into 100,000 shares of stock with par value
of P10 each. a) Give two ways whereby said authorized
capital stock may be increased to about P1.5M. (3%) b)
Give three practical reasons for a corporation to increase
its capital stock (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Two ways of increasing the Authorized Capital Stock of
X corporation to P1.5M are:
1) Increase the number of shares from 100,000
to 150,000 shares with the same par value of P10.00
each.
2) Increase par value of 100,000 shares to
P15.00 each.
b) Three practical reasons for a corporation to increase its
capital stock are: 1) to generate more working capital;
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
2) to have more shares with which to pay for the
acquisition of more assets like acquisition of
company car, stocks, house, machinery or
business; and
3) to have extra share with which to cover or meet
the requirement for declaration of stock
dividend.
Stocks; Sale, Transfer of Certificates of Stock (1996)
Arnold has in his name 1,000 shares of the capital stock of
ABC Co as evidenced by a stock certificate. Arnold
delivered the stock certificate to Steven who now claims to
be the real owner of the shares, having paid for Arnolds
subscription. ABC refused to recognize and register
Stevens ownership. Is the refusal justified? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
ABCs refusal to recognize and register Stevens ownership
is justified. The facts indicate that the stock certificate for
the 1,000 shares in question is in the name of Arnold.
Although the certificate was delivered by Arnold to Steven,
the facts do not indicate that the certificate was duly
endorsed by Arnold at the time it was delivered to Steven
or that the procedure for the effective transfer of shares of
stock set out in the by-laws of ABC Co, if any, was
observed. Since the certificate was not endorsed in favor of
Steven (or anybody else for that matter), the only
conclusion could be no other than that the shares in
question still belong to Arnold. (Razon v IAC GR 74306 Mar
16,92 207s234)
Stocks; Sale, Transfer of Certificates of Stock (2001)
A is the registered owner of Stock Certificate No. 000011.
He entrusted the possession of said certificate to his best
friend B who borrowed the said endorsed certificate to
support Bs application for passport (or for a purpose
other than transfer). But B sold the certificate to X, a bona
fide purchaser who relied on the endorsed certificates and
believed him to be the owner thereof. a) Can A claim the
shares of stock from X? Explain (3%) b) Would your
answer be the same if A lost the stock certificate in
question or if it was stolen from him? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) No. Assuming that the shares were already transferred
to B, A cannot claim the shares of stock from X. The
certificate of stock covering said shares have been duly
endorsed by A and entrusted by him to B. By his said acts,
A is now estopped from claiming said shares from X, a
bona fide purchaser who relied on the endorsement by A
of the certificate of stock.
b) Yes. In the case where the certificate of stock was lost
or stole from A, A has a right to claim the certificate of
stock from the thief who has no right or title to the same.
One who has lost any movable or has been unlawfully
deprived thereof, may recover it from the person in
possession of the same. (Art 559 NCC)
Stocks; Sale, Transfer of Certificates of Stock (2004)
Four months before his death, PX assigned 100 shares of
stock registered in his name in favor of his wife and his
Page 43 of 103 children. They then brought the deed of
assignment to the proper corporate officers for registration
with the request for the transfer in the corporation's stock
and transfer books of the assigned shares, the cancellation
of the stock certificates in PX's name, and the issuance of
new stock certificates in the names of his wife and his
children as the new owners. The officers of the
Corporation denied the request on the ground that another
heir is contesting the validity of the deed of assignment.
May the Corporation be compelled by mandamus to
register the shares of stock in the names of the assignees?
Explain briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. The corporation may be compelled by mandamus to
register the shares of stock in the name of the assignee. The
only legal limitation imposed by Section 63 of the
Corporation Code is when the Corporation holds any
unpaid claim against the shares intended to be transferred.
The alleged claim of another heir of PX is not sufficient to
deny the issuance of new certificates of stock to his wife
and children. It would be otherwise if the transferee's title
to the shares has no prima facie validity or is uncertain.
Trust Fund Doctrine (1992)
A Corporation executed a promissory note binding itself to
pay its President/Director, who had tendered his
resignation, a certain sum in payment of the latters shares
and interests in the company. The corporation defaulted in
paying the full amount so that said former President filed
suit for collection of the balance before the SEC. a) Under
what conditions is a stock corporation empowered to
acquire its own shares? b) Is the arrangement between the
corporation and its President covered by the trust fund
doctrine? Explain your answers briefly.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) A stock corporation may only acquire its own shares of
stock if the trust fund doctrine is not impaired. This is to
say, for instance, that it may purchase its own shares of
stock by utilizing merely its surplus profits over and above
the subscribed capital of the corporation.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
a) (an answer enumerating the instances or cases under the
Corporation Code where the Corp allows the acquisition of
shares such as in the stockholders exercise of appraisal
right, failure of bids in the sale of delinquent shares, etc.)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
b) The arrangement between the corporation and its
President to the extent that it calls for the payment of the
latters shares is covered by the trust fund doctrine. The
only exceptions from the trust fund doctrine are the
redemption of redeemable shares and, in the case of close
corporation, when there should be a deadlock and the
SEC orders the payment of the appraised value of a
stockholders share.
Trust Fund Doctrine; Intra-Corporate Controversy (1991)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
On December 6, 1988, A, an incorporator and the General
Manager of the Paje Multi Farms Co, resigned as GM and
sold to the corporation his shares of stocks in the
corporation for P300th, the book value thereof, payable as
follows: a) P100th as down payment; b) P100th on or
before 31 July1989; and c) the remaining balance of P100th
on or before 30 Sep 1989. A promissory note, with an
acceleration clause, was executed by the corporation for the
unpaid balance.
The corporation failed to pay the first installment on due
date. A then sued Paje on the promissory note in the RTC.
a) Does the court have jurisdiction over the case? b)
Would your answer be the same if A instead sold his
shares to his friend Mabel and the latter filed a case with
the RTC against the corporation to compel it to register
the sale and to issue new certificates of stock in her name?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) The RTC has jurisdiction over the case. The SC said
that a corporation may only buy its own shares of stock if
it has enough surplus profits therefore.
b) My answer would be the same. An action to compel a
corporation to register a sale and to issue new certificates
of stock is itself an intra-corporate matter that exclusively
lies with the RTC.
TAKE NOTE: The RTC has jurisdiction over the cases
which involves intra-corporate controversy. As of 2006, the
applicable rule is that there is a TRANSFERRED
JURISDICTION under Sec. 5.2 of the SRC, the
Commissions jurisdiction over all cases enumerated under
PD 902-A sec. 5 has been transferred to the Courts of
general jurisdiction or the appropriate Regional Trial Court.
Credit Transactions
Chattel Mortgage vs. After-Incurred Obligations (1991)
To secure the payment of an earlier loan of P20,000 as well
as subsequent loans which her friend Noreen, would
extend to her, Karen executed in favor of Noreen a chattel
mortgage over her (Karen) car. Is the mortgage valid?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A chattel mortgage cannot effectively secure after-incurred
obligations. While a stipulation to include after-incurred
obligations in a chattel mortgage is itself not invalid, the
obligation cannot, however, be deemed automatically
secured by that mortgage until after a new chattel mortgage
or an addendum to the original chattel mortgage is executed
to cover the obligation after it has been actually incurred.
Accordingly, unless such supplements are made, the chattel
mortgage in the problem given would be deemed to secure
only the loan of P20,000 (Sec 5 Act 1505; Belgian Catholic
Missionaries v Magallanes Press 49p647)
Page 44 of 103
Chattel Mortgage vs. After-Incurred Obligations (1999)
On December 1, 1996, Borrower executed a chattel
mortgage in favor of the Bank to secure a loan of P3M.
In due time the loan was paid. On December 1, 1997,
Borrower obtained another loan for P2M which the Bank
granted under the same security as that which secured the
first loan.
For the second loan, Borrower merely delivered a
promissory note; no new chattel mortgage agreement was
executed as the parties relied on a provision in the 1996
chattel mortgage agreement which included future debts
as among the obligations secured by the mortgage. The
provision reads:
In case the Mortgagor executes subsequent promissory
note or notes either as a renewal, as an extension, or as a
new loan, this mortgage shall also stand as security for the
payment of said promissory note or notes without
necessity of executing a new contract and this mortgage
shall have the same force and effect as if the said
promissory note or notes were existing on date hereof.
As Borrower failed to pay the second loan, the Bank
proceeded to foreclose the Chattel Mortgage.Borrower
sued the Bank claiming that the mortgage was no longer in
force. Borrower claimed that a fresh chattel mortgage
should have been executed when the second loan was
granted. a) Decide the case and ratiocinate. (4%) b)
Suppose the chattel mortgage was not registered,
would its validity and effectiveness be impaired?
Explain. (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The foreclosure of the chattel mortgage regarding
the second loan is not valid. A chattel mortgage cannot
validly secure after incurred obligations. The affidavit of
good faith required under the chattel mortgage law
expressly provides that the foregoing mortgage is made
for securing the obligation specified in the conditions
hereof, and for no other purpose. The after-incurred
obligation not being specified in the affidavit, is not secured
by mortgage.
Yes. The chattel mortgage is not valid as against
any person, except the mortgagor, his executors and
administrators.
Chattel Mortgage; Foreclosure (1997)
Ritz bought a new car on installments which provided for
an acceleration clause in the event of default. To secure
payment of the unpaid installments, as and when due, he
constituted two chattel mortgages, i.e., one over his very
old car and the other covering the new car that he had just
bought as aforesaid, on installments. After Ritz defaulted
on three installments, the seller-mortgagee foreclosed on
the old car. The proceeds of the foreclosure were not
enough to satisfy the due obligation; hence, he similarly
sought to foreclose on the new car.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Would the seller-mortgagee be legally justified in
foreclosing on this second chattel mortgage?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The two mortgages were executed to secure the
payment of the unpaid installments for the purchase of a
new car. When the mortgage on the old car was foreclosed,
the seller-mortgagee is deemed to have renounced all other
rights. A foreclosure of additional property, that is, the new
car covered by the second mortgage would be a nullity.
Chattel Mortgage; Ownership of Thing Mortgaged (1990)
Zonee, who lives in Bulacan, bought a 1988 model Toyota
Corolla sedan on July 1, 1989 from Anadelaida, who lives
in Quezon City, for P300th, paying P150th as
downpayment and promising to pay the balance in 3 equal
quarterly installments beginning October 1, 1989.
Anadelaida executed a deed of sale of the vehicle in favor
of Zonee and, to secure the unpaid balance of the
purchase price, had Zonee execute a deed of chattel
mortgage on the vehicle in Anadelaidas favor.
Ten days after the execution of the abovementioned
documents, Zonee had the car transferred and registered
in her name. Contemporaneously, Anadelaida had the
chattel mortgage on the car registered in the Chattel
Mortgage Registry of the Office of the Register of Deeds
of Quezon City.
In Sep 1989, Zonee sold the sedan to Jimbo without telling
the latter that the car was mortgaged to Anadelaida. When
Zonee failed to pay the first installment on October 1,
1989, Anadelaida went to see Zonee and discovered that
the latter had sold the car to Jimbo. a) Jimbo refused to
give up the car on the ground that the chattel mortgage
executed by Zonee in favor of Anadelaida is not valid
because it was executed before the car was registered in
Zonees name, i.e., before Zonee became the registered
owner of the car. Is the said argument meritorious? Explain
your answer.
b) Jimbo also argued that even if the chattel mortgage is
valid, it cannot affect him because it was not properly
registered with the government offices where it should be
registered. What government office is Jimbo referring to?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Jimbos argument is not meritorious. Zonee became the
owner of the property upon delivery; registration is not
essential to vest that ownership in the buyer. The
execution of the chattel mortgage by the buyer in favor of
the seller, in fact, can demonstrate the vesting of such
ownership to the mortgagor.
b) Jimbo was referring to the Register of Deeds of Bulacan
where Zonee was a resident. The Chattel Mortgage Law
requires the registration to be made in the Office of the
Register of Deeds of the province where the mortgagor
resides and also in which the property is
Page 45 of 103
situated as well as the LTO where the vehicle is registered.
(Sec 4 Chattel Mortgage Law)
Credit Transactions (1999)
Various buyers of lots in a subdivision brought actions to
compel either or both the developer and the bank to lease
and deliver free and clear the titles to their respective lots.
The problem arose because notwithstanding prior sales
mostly on installments made by the developer to buyers,
developer had mortgaged the whole subdivision to a
commercial bank. The mortgage was duly executed and
registered with the appropriate governmental agencies.
However, as the lot buyers were completely unaware of the
mortgage lien of the bank, they religiously paid the
installments due under their sale contracts.
As the developer failed to pay its loan, the mortgage was
foreclosed and the whole subdivision was acquired by the
bank as the highest bidder. a) May the bank dispossess
prior purchasers of
individual lots or, alternatively, require them to pay
again for the paid lots? Discuss (3%)
b) What are the rights of the bank vis--vis those
buyers with remaining unpaid installments? Discuss. (3%)
Recommendation: Since the subject matter of these two
(2) questions is not included within the scope of the Bar
Questions in Mercantile Law, as it is within Civil Law, it is
suggested that whatever answer is given by the examinee,
or the lack of answer should be given full credit. If the
examinee gives a good answer, he should be given
additional credit.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The bank may not dispossess the prior
purchasers of the individual lots, much less require them
to pay for the said lots. The bank has to respect the rights
of the prior purchasers of the individual lots. The
purchasers have the option to pay the installments of the
mortgagee.
The bank has to respect the rights of the buyers
with remaining unpaid installments. The purchaser has the
option to pay the installments to the mortgagee who
should apply the payments to the mortgage indebtedness.
Mortgage (1999)
Debtor purchased a parcel of land from a realty company
payable in five yearly installments. Under the contract of
sale, title to the lot would be transferred upon full payment
of the purchase price.
But even before full payment, debtor constructed a house
on the lot. Sometime thereafter, debtor mortgaged the
house to secure his obligation arising from the issuance of
a bond needed in the conduct of his business. The
mortgage was duly registered with the proper chattel
mortgage registry.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Five years later after completing payment of the purchase
price, debtor obtained title to the lot. And even as the
chattel mortgage on the house was still subsisting, debtor
mortgaged to a bank the lot and improvement thereon to
secure a loan. This real estate mortgage was duly registered
and annotated at the back of the title.
Due to business reverses, debtor failed to pay his creditors.
The chattel mortgage was foreclosed when the debtor
failed to reimburse the surety company for payments made
on the bond. In the foreclosure sale, the surety company
was awarded the house as the highest bidder.
Only after the foreclosure sale did the surety company
learn of the real estate mortgage in favor of the lending
investor on the lot and the improvement thereon.
Immediately, it filed a complaint praying for the exclusion
of the house from the real estate mortgage. It was
submitted that as the chattel mortgage was executed and
registered ahead, it was superior to the real estate mortgage.
On the suggestion that a chattel mortgage on a house- a
real property- was a nullity, the surety company countered
that when the chattel mortgage was executed, debtor was
not yet the owner of the lot on which the house was built.
Accordingly, the house was a personal property and a
proper subject of a chattel mortgage.
Discuss the validity of the position taken by the surety
company. (3%)
Who has a better claim to the house, the surety
company or the lending investor? Explain (3%)
Would the position of the surety company be bolstered
by the fact that it acquired title in a foreclosure sale conducted by
the Provincial Sheriff. Explain (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) The house is always a real property even though it was
constructed on a land not belonging to the builder.
However, the parties may treat it as a personal property
and constitute a chattel mortgage thereon. Such mortgage
shall be valid and binding but only on the parties. It will
not bind or affect third parties.
b) The lending investor has a better claim to the house.
The real estate mortgage covering the house and lot was
duly registered and binds the parties and third persons. On
the other hand, the chattel mortgage on the house
securing the credit of the surety company did not affect
the rights of third parties such as the lending investor
despite registration of the chattel mortgage.
c) No. The chattel mortgage over the house which was
foreclosed did not affect the rights of third parties like the
lending investor. Since the third parties are not bound by
the chattel mortgage, they are not also bound by any
enforcement of its provisions. The foreclosure of such
chattel mortgage did not bolster or add anything to the
position of the surety company.
Mortgage vs. Levy (2003)
Page 46 of 103 To pay for her loan obtained from Stela,
Liza constituted in Stelas favor a chattel mortgage over an
electric generator. Cecil, a creditor of Liza, levied on
attachment the generator. Stela filed a third party claim.
Cecil opposed the claim. Rule on their conflicting claims.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Mortgage; Extrajudicial Foreclose (2006)
A real estate mortgage may be foreclosed judicially or
extrajudicially. In what instance may a mortgagee
extrajudicially foreclose a real estate mortgage? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
When a sale is made under a special power inserted or
attached to any real-estate mortgage, thereafter given as
security for the payment of money or the fulfillment of any
other obligation, then the mortgagee may extrajudicially
foreclose the real estate mortgage (Sec. 1, Act No. 3135, as
amended).
Mortgage; Foreclosure (2003)
May the sale at public auction by a bank of a property
mortgaged to it be nullified because the price was
extremely low? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Mortgage; Foreclosure (2003)
Because of failure of Janette and Jeanne to pay their loan
to X Bank, the latter foreclosed on the mortgage
constituted on their property which was put up by them as
security for the payment of the loan. The price paid for the
property at the foreclosure sale was not enough to liquidate
the obligation. The bank sued for deficiency. In their
answer, Janette and Jeanne did not deny the existence of
the loan nor the fact of their default. They, however,
interposed the defenses that the price at the auction was
extremely low and that their loan, despite the loan
documents, was a long-term loan which had not yet
matured. If you were the judge, how would you rule on the
case? Why? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Mortgage; Foreclosure of Improvements (1999)
Borrower obtained a loan against the security of a
mortgage on a parcel of land. While the mortgage was
subsisting, borrower leased for fifty years the mortgaged
property to Land Development Company (LDC). The
mortgagee was duly advised of the lease. Thereafter, LDC
constructed on the mortgaged property an office
condominium.
Borrower defaulted on his loan and mortgagee foreclosed
the mortgage. At the foreclosure sale, the mortgagee was
awarded the property as the highest bidder. The
corresponding Certificate of Sale was executed and after
the lapse of one year, title was consolidated in the name of
mortgagee.
Mortgagee then applied with the RTC for the issuance of a
writ of possession not only over the land but also the
condominium building. The mortgagee contended that the
mortgage included all accessions, improvements and
accessories found on the mortgaged property.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 47 of 103
LDC countered that it had built on the mortgaged
property with the prior knowledge of mortgagee which
had received formal notice of the lease. a) How would you
resolve the dispute between the
mortgagee and LDC? (3%) b) Is the mortgagee entitled to
the lease rentals due from LDC under the lease
agreement? (3%)
Recommendation: Since the subject matter of these two
(2) questions is not included within the scope of the Bar
Questions in Mercantile Law, as it is within Civil Law, it is
suggested that whatever answer is given by the examinee, or the
lack of answer should be given full credit. If the examinee gives a
good answer, he should be given additional credit.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a. The mortgagee has a better right than LDC. The
mortgage extends to the improvements introduced on the
land, with the declarations, amplifications, and limitations
established by law, whether the estate remains in the
possession of the mortgagor or passes into the hands of a
third person (Art 2127 NCC). The notice given by LDC to
the mortgagee was not enough to remove the building
from coverage of the mortgage considering that the
building was built after the mortgage was constituted and
the notice was only as regards the lease and not as to the
construction of the building. Since the mortgagee was
informed of the lease and did not object to it, the
mortgagee became bound by the terms of the lease when it
acquired the property as the highest bidder. Hence, the
mortgagee steps into the shoes of the mortgagor and
acquires the rights of the lessor under Art 1768 of the
NCC. This provision gives the lessor the right to
appropriate the condominium building but after paying the
lessee half of the value of the building at that time. Should
the lessor refuse to reimburse said amount, the lessee may
remove the improvement even though the land will suffer
damage thereby.
1st Alternative Answer:
a. The mortgagee has a better right to the building. Under
Art 2127 of the NCC, the mortgage extends to all
improvements on the mortgaged property regardless of
who and when the improvements were introduced. LDC
cannot complain otherwise, because it knew that the
property it was leasing was mortgaged when it built the
condominium.
2nd alternative Answer:
a. Assuming that the office condominium was duly
constituted under the Condominium Law, before LDC
could validly constitute the same as a condominium, it
should cause to be recorded in the register of deeds of the
province or city where the land is situated an enabling or
master deed showing, among others, a certificate of the
registered owner and of all registered holders of any lien or
encumbrance on the property that they consent to the
registration of the deed. (Sec 4. RA 4726). If the mortgagee
gave its consent thereto, then LDC should prevail. If no
consent was given, the condominium was included in the
mortgage.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
b. The lease rentals belong to the mortgagor. However,
the mortgage extends to rentals not yet received when the
obligation becomes due and the mortgagee may ran after
the said rentals for the payment of the mortgage debt.
Mortgage; Foreclosure; Effect of mere taking by
creditor-mortgagor of property (1992)
X & Co obtained a loan from a local bank in the amount
of P500th, mortgaging as security therefore its real
property. Subsequently, the company applied with the
same bank for a Letter of Credit (LC) for $200th in favor
of a foreign bank to cover the importation of machinery.
To guarantee payment of the obligation under the LC, the
company and its President and Treasurer executed a surety
agreement in the local banks favor.
The machinery arrived and was released to the company
under a trust receipt agreement. As the company defaulted
in the payment of its obligations, the bank took possession
of the imported machinery. At the same time, it sought to
foreclose the mortgaged property and to hold the company
as well as its President and Treasurer, liable under the
Surety Agreement.
Did the taking of possession of the machinery by the bank
result in the 1) full payment of the obligations of the
company and its officers, and 2) foreclosure of the
mortgage?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) The taking of possession of the machinery by the bank
did not result in full payment of the obligations owing
from the company and its officers. The taking of such
possession must be considered merely as a measure in
order to protect or further safeguard the banks security
interest. Dacion en pago can only be considered as having
taken place when a creditor accepts and appropriates the
ownership of the goods in payment of a due obligation.
(PNB v Pineda 197 s 1)
2) The mere taking of possession of mortgaged assets
does not amount to foreclosure. Foreclosure requires a
sale at public auction. The foreclosure, therefore, has not
as yet been effected.
Mortgage; Redemption Period; Foreclosed Property
(2002)
Primetime Corporation (the Borrower) obtained a P10
Million, five-year term loan from Universal Bank (the
Bank) in 1996. As security for the loan and as required by
the Bank, the Borrower gave the following collateral
security in favor of the Bank: 1) a real estate mortgage over
the land and building
owned by the Borrower and located in Quezon City; 2)
the joint and several promissory note of Pr. Primo
Timbol, the President of the Borrower; and 3) a real estate
mortgage over the residential house and
lot owned by Mr. Timbol, also located in Quezon
City.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Because of business reverses, neither the Borrower nor Mr.
Timbol was able to pay the loan. In June 2001, the Bank
extrajudicially foreclosed the two real estate mortgages,
with the Bank as the only bidder in the foreclosure sale. On
September 16, 2001, the certificates of sale of the two
properties in favor of the Bank were registered with the
Register of Deeds of Quezon City.
Ten months later, both the Borrower and Mr. Timbol were
able to raise sufficient funds to redeem their respective
properties from the Bank, but the Bank refused to permit
redemption on the ground that the period for redemption
had already expired, so that the Bank now has absolute
ownership of both properties. The Borrower and Mr.
Timbol came to you today, September 15, 2002, to find out
if the position of the Bank is correct. What would be your
answer? State your reasons (5%).
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1 With respect to the real estate mortgage over the land
and building owned by the Borrower, Primetime Corporation, a
juridical body, the period of redemption is only three (3) months,
which period already expired.
2 As to the real estate mortgage over the residential house
and lot owned by Mr. Timbol, the period of redemption is one (1)
year from the date of registration of the certificate of sale, which
period has not yet expired in this case.
Mortgage; Remedies (2003)
Carmakers, Inc., sold a motor vehicle on installment basis
to Chari Paredes. The transaction was reflected on a
promissory note executed by Chari in favor of Carmakers.
The note was secured by a mortgage over the car.
Contemporaneous with the execution of the note and the
mortgage deed, Carmakers, Inc., assigned the instruments
sans recourse to Adelantado Finance Corporation. Chari
defaulted in her obligations. Could Adelantado Finance
corporation take action against both Carmakers Inc., and
Chari? Why? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Preference of Credits (2002)
As of June 1, 2002, Edzo Systems Corporation (Edzo)
was indebted to the following creditors:
(1) Ace Equipment Supplies for various personal
computers and accessories sold to Edzo on credit
amounting to P300,000.
(2) Handyman Garage for mechanical repairs (parts and
service) performed on Edzos company car amounting to
P10,000.
(3) Joselyn Reyes former employee of Edzo who
sued Edzo for unlawful termination of employment and
was able to obtain a final judgment against Edzo for
P100,000.
(4) Bureau of Internal Revenue for unpaid
value-added taxes amounting to P30,000.
Page 48 of 103
(5) Integrity Bank which granted Edzo a loan in 2001 in
the amount of P500,000. The loan was not secured by any
asset of Edzo, but it was guaranteed unconditionally and
solidarily by Edzos President and controlling stockholder,
Eduardo Z. Ong, as accommodation surety.
The loan due to Integrity Bank fell due on June 15, 2002.
Despite pleas for extension of payment by Edzo, the bank
demanded immediate payment. Because the bank
threatened to proceed against the surety, Eduardo Z. Ong,
Edzo decided to pay up all its obligations to Integrity
Bank. On June 20, 2002, Edzo paid to Integrity Bank the
full principal amount of P500,000, plus accrued interests
amounting to P55,000. As a result, Edzo had hardly any
cash left for operations and decided to close its business.
After paying the unpaid salaries of its employees, Edzo
filed a petition for insolvency on July 1, 2002.
How would you, as judge in the insolvency proceedings,
rank the respective credits or claims of the five (5)
creditors mentioned above in terms of preference or
priority against each other? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The claim of Handyman Garage for P10,000 has a specific
lien on the car repaired.
The remaining four (4) claims have preference or priority
against each other in the following order:
(1) No. 4 claim of the BIR for unpaid value added
taxes
(2) No. 3 claim of Joselyn Reyes for Unlawful
termination
(3) No. 1 claim of Ace equipment Supplies as an
unpaid seller; and
(4) No. 5 claim of Integrity
Bank.
Promissory Note: Liability (2001)
X, Y and Z signed a promissory note in favor of A stating:
We promise to pay A on December 31, 2001 the sum of
P5,000.00 When the note fell due, A sued X and Y who
put up the defense that A should have impleaded
Z. Is the defense valid? Why? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The defense is not valid. The liability of X, Y, and Z under
the promissory note is joint. Such being the case, Z is not
an indispensable party. The fact that A did not implead Z
will not prevent A from collecting the proportionate share
of X and Y in the payment of the loan.
(Observation: Even if the liability of X, Y, and Z is
solidary, the defense would still not be valid)
Remedies; Available to Mortgagee-Creditor (1996)
Finding a 24-month payment plan attractive, Anjo
purchased a Tamaraw FX from Toyota QC. He paid a
down-payment of P100th and obtained financing for the
balance from IOU Co. He executed a chattel mortgage
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
over the vehicle in favor of IOU. When Anjo defaulted,
IOU foreclosed the chattel mortgage, and sought to
recover the deficiency. May IOU still recover the
deficiency? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
IOU may no longer recover the deficiency. Under Art
1484 of the NCC, in a contract of sale of personal property
the price of which is payable in installments, the vendor
may, among several options, foreclose the chattel mortgage
on the thing sold, if one has been constituted, should the
vendees failure to pay cover two or more installments. In
such case, however, the vendor shall have no further
action against the purchaser to recover any unpaid balance
of the price and any agreement to the contrary is void.
While the given facts did not explicitly state that Anjos
failure to pay covered 2 or more installments, this may
safely be presumed because the right of IOU Co to
foreclose the chattel mortgage under the circumstances is
premised on Anjos failure to pay 2 or more installments.
The foreclosure would not have been valid if it were not
so. (The given facts did not also state explicitly whether
Anjos default was a payment default or a default arising
from a breach of a negative pledge or breach of a warranty.
In such case, however, IOU Company would not have
been able to foreclose the chattel mortgage validly as such
foreclosure, under the circumstances contemplated by the
law, could only be effected for a payment default covering
two or more installments) (Luis Ridad v Filipinas Investment
and Finance Co GR L-39806 Jan27,83 120s246)
Remedies; Available to Mortgagee-Creditor (2001)
Debtor A issued a promissory note in the amount of
P10M in favor of commercial bank Y secured by mortgage
of his properties worth P30M. When A failed to pay his
indebtedness, despite demands made by bank Y, the latter
instituted a collection suit to enforce payment of the P10M
account. Subsequently, bank Y also filed foreclosure
proceedings against A for security given for the account. If
you were the judge, how would you resolve the two cases?
(5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The case for collection will be allowed to proceed. But the
foreclosure proceedings have to be dismissed. In instituting
foreclosure proceedings, after filing a collection case
involving the same account or transaction, bank Y is guilty
of splitting a cause of action. The loan of P10M is the
principal obligation while the mortgage securing the same is
merely an accessory to said loan obligation. The collection
of the loan and the foreclosure of the mortgage securing
said loan constitute one and the same cause of action. The
filing of the collection case bars the subsequent filing of the
foreclosure proceedings.
Remedies; Secured Debt (1991)
To secure the payment of his loan of P200th, A executed
in favor of the Angeles Banking Co in 1 document, a real
estate mortgage over 3 lots registered in his name and a
chattel mortgage over his 3 cars and 1 Isuzu cargo truck.
Page 49 of 103 Upon his failure to pay the loan on due
date, the bank foreclosed the mortgage on the 3 lots, which
were subsequently sold for only P99th at the foreclosure
sale. Thereafter, the bank filed an ordinary action for the
collection of the deficiency. A contended that the mortgage
contract he executed was indivisible and consequently, the
bank had no legal right to foreclose only the real estate
mortgage and leave out the chattel mortgage, and then sue
him for a supposed deficiency judgment. If you were the
Judge, would you sustain the contention of A?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
If I were the Judge, I would dismiss the action as being
premature since the proper remedy would be to complete
the foreclosure of the mortgages and only thereafter can
there by an action for collection of any deficiency. In Caltex
v IAC (GR 74730, 25 Aug 89), the remedies on a secured debt,
said the court, are either an action to collect or to foreclose
a contract of real security. These remedies are alternative
remedies, although an action for any deficiency is not
precluded, subject to certain exceptions such as those
stated in Art 1484 of the Civil Code, by a foreclosure on
the mortgages. While the factual settings in the case of Suria
v IAC (30 June 87) are not similar to the facts given in the
problem, the SC implied that foreclosure as a remedy in
secured obligations must first be availed of by a creditor in
preference to other remedies that might also be invoked by
him.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
The indivisibility of a contract of real security, such as a
real estate mortgage or a chattel mortgage, only means that
a division or a partial payment of a secured obligation does
not warrant a corresponding division or proportionate
reduction of the security given. A creditor in such secured
debts may pursue the remedy of foreclosure, in part or in
full, or file an ordinary action for collection on any amount
due. A favorable judgment can warrant an issuance of a
writ of execution on any property, not exempt from
execution, belonging to the judgment debtor. There should
be no legal obstacle for a creditor to waive, in full or in
part, his right to foreclosure on contracts of real security.
Insurance Law
Beneficiary: Effects: Irrevocable Beneficiary (2005)
What are the effects of an irrevocable designation of a
beneficiary under the Insurance Code? Explain. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The irrevocable designation gives the beneficiary a vested
right over Life Insurance. The Insured cannot act to divest
the irrevocable beneficiary, in whole or in part, without
the beneficiary's consent. To be specific:
(1) The beneficiary designated in a life insurance
contract cannot be changed without the consent of the
beneficiary because he has a vested interest in the policy
(Philamlife v. Pineda, G.R. No. 54216, July 19,
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
1989, citing Gcrcio v. Sun Life, G.R. No. 23703, September 28,
1925; and Go v. Redfern, G.R. No. 47705, April 25, 1841);
(2) Neither can the Insured take the cash surrender
value, assign or even borrow on said policy without the
beneficiary's consent (Nario v. Philamlife, G.R. No. 22796, June
26, 1967);
(3) The Insured cannot add another beneficiary
because that would reduce the amount which the first
beneficiary may recover and therefore adversely affect his
vested right (Go v. Redfem, G.R. No. 47705, April 25, 1941);
(4) Unless the policy allows, the Insured cannot even
designate another beneficiary should the original
beneficiary predecease him. His estate acquires the
beneficiary's vested right upon his death; and
(5) The Insured cannot allow his creditors to attach
or execute on the policy. (Philamlife v. Pineda, G.R. No. 54216,
July 19, 1989)
Beneficiary: Rights; Irrevocable Beneficiary (2005)
Jacob obtained a life insurance policy for P1 Million
designating irrevocably Diwata, a friend, as his beneficiary.
Jacob, however, changed his mind and wants Yob and Jojo,
his other friends, to be included as beneficiaries considering
that the proceeds of the policy are sufficient for the three
friends. Can Jacob still add Yob and Jojo as his
beneficiaries? Explain. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, Jacob can no longer add Yob and Jojo as his
beneficiaries in addition to Diwata. As the irrevocable
beneficiary, Diwata has acquired a-vested right over Jacob's
life insurance policy. Any additional beneficiaries will
reduce the amount which Diwata, as the first beneficiary,
may recover, which will adversely affect her vested right.
(Go v. Redfern, G.R. No. 47705, April 25, 1941)
Beneficiary; Life Insurance; Prohibited Beneficiaries
(1998)
Juan de la Cruz was issued Policy No. 8888 of the Midland
Life Insurance Co on a whole life plan for P20,000 on
August 19, 1989. Juan is married to Cynthia with whom he
has three legitimate children. He, however, designated
Purita, his common-law wife, as the revocable beneficiary.
Juan referred to Purita in his application and policy as the
legal wife. 3 years later, Juan died. Purita filed her claim for
the proceeds of the policy as the designated beneficiary
therein. The widow, Cynthia, also filed a claim as the legal
wife. To whom should the proceeds of the insurance policy
be awarded? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The proceeds of the insurance policy shall be awarded to
the ESTATE of Juan de la Cruz. Purita, the common-
law-wife, is disqualified as the beneficiary of the deceased
because of illicit relation between the deceased and Purita,
the designated beneficiary. Due to such illicit
Page 50 of 103 relation, Purita cannot be a donee of the
deceased. Hence, she cannot also be his beneficiary.
Concealment; Material Concealment (2001)
A applied for a non-medical life insurance. The insured
did not inform the insurer that one week prior to his
application for insurance, he was examined and confined
at St. Lukes Hospital where he was diagnosed for lung
cancer. The insured soon thereafter died in a plane crash.
Is the insurer liable considering that the fact concealed had
no bearing with the cause of death of the insured? Why?
(5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The concealed fact is material to the approval and
issuance of the insurance policy. It is well settled that the
insured need not die of the disease he failed to disclose to
the insurer. It is sufficient that his nondisclosure misled
the insurer in forming his estimate of the risks of the
proposed insurance policy or in making inquiries.
Concealment; Material Concealment: Incontestability
Clause (1994)
On September 23, 1990, Tan took a life insurance policy
from Philam. The policy was issued on November 6, 1990.
He died on April 26, 1992 of hepatoma. The insurance
company denied the beneficiaries claim and rescinded the
policy by reason of alleged misrepresentation and
concealment of material facts made by Tan in his
application. It returned the premiums paid.
The beneficiaries contend that the company had no right
to rescind the contract as rescission must be done during
the lifetime of the insured within two years and prior to
the commencement of the action. Is the contention of the
beneficiaries tenable?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The incontestability clause does not apply. The
insured dies within less than two years from the issuance
of the policy on September 23, 1990. The insured died on
April 26, 1992, or less than 2 years from September 23,
1990.
The right of the insurer to rescind is only lost if the
beneficiary has commenced an action on the policy. There
is no such action in this case. (Tan v CA 174 s 143)
Concealment; Material Concealment: Incontestability
Clause (1996)
Juan procured a non-medical life insurance from Good
Life Insurance. He designated his wife, Petra, as the
beneficiary. Earlier, in his application in response to the
question as to whether or not he had ever been
hospitalized, he answered in the negative. He forgot to
mention his confinement at the Kidney Hospital.
After Juan died in a plane crash, Petra filed a claim with
Good Life. Discovering Juans previous hospitalization,
Good Life rejected Petras claim on the ground of
concealment and misrepresentation. Petra sued Good Life,
invoking good faith on part of Juan.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Will Petras suit prosper? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, Petras suit will not prosper (assuming that the policy
of life insurance has been in force for a period of less than
2 years from the date of its issue). The matters which Juan
failed to disclose was material and relevant to the approval
and issuance of the insurance policy. They would have
affected Good Lifes action on his application, either by
approving it with the corresponding adjustment for a higher
premium or rejecting the same. Moreover, a disclosure may
have warranted a medical examination of Juan by Good
Life in order for it to reasonably assess the risk involved in
accepting the application. In any case, good faith is no
defense in concealment. The waiver of a medical
examination in the non-medical life insurance from Good
Life makes it even more necessary that Juan supply
complete information about his previous hospitalization for
such information constitutes an important factor which
Good Life takes into consideration in deciding whether to
issue the policy or not. (See Sunlife Assurance Co of Canada v CA
GR 105135, June 22, 1995 245 s 268)
If the policy of life insurance has been in force for a
period of 2 years or more from the date of its issue (on
which point the given facts are vague) then Good Life can
no longer prove that the policy is void ab initio or is
rescindible by reason of the fraudulent concealment or
misrepresentation of Juan ( Sec 48 Ins Code)
Concealment; Material Concealment: Incontestability
Clause (1997)
The assured answers No to the question in the
application for a life policy: Are you suffering from any
form of heart illness? In fact, the assured has been a heart
patient for many years. On 7 Sep 1991, the assured is killed
in a plane crash. The insurance company denies the claim
for insurance proceeds and returns the premiums paid. Is
the decision of the insurance company justified?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Assuming that the incontestability clause does not apply
because the policy has not been in force for 2 years, from
the date of issue, during the lifetime of the insured, the
decision of the insurance company not to pay is justified.
There was fraudulent concealment. It is not material that
the insured died of a different cause than the fact
concealed. The fact concealed, that is heart ailment, is
material to the determination by the insurance company
whether or not to accept the application for insurance and
to require the medical examination of the insured.
However, if the incontestability clause which applies to the
insurance policy covering the life of the insured had been
in force for 2 years from issuance thereof, the insurance
company would not be justified in denying the claim for
proceeds of the insurance and in returning the premium
paid. In that case, the insurer cannot prove the policy void
ab initio or rescindible by reason of fraudulent
concealment or misrepresentation of the insured.
Page 51 of 103
Concealment; Material Concealment; Incontestability
Clause (1991)
Atty Roberto took out a life insurance policy from the
Dana Ins Co (DIC) on 1 Sep 1989. On 31 Aug 1990,
Roberto died. DIC refused to pay his beneficiaries because
it discovered that Robert had misrepresented certain
material facts in his application. The beneficiaries sued on
the basis that DIC can contest the validity of the insurance
policy only within 2 years from the date of issue and during
the lifetime of the insured. Decide the case.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
I would rule in favor of the insurance company. The
incontestability clause, applies only if the policy had been
in effect for at least 2 years. The 2 year period is counted
from the time the insurance becomes effective until the
death of the insured and not thereafter (Tan v CA GR 48044
29Jun1989)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
I would rule in favor of the insurance company. Although
an insurer may not rescind the contract on ground of
misrepresentation after an action is commenced for
recovery under the policy, the insurer is not precluded from
invoking the ground of misrepresentation as a defense in the
action for recovery. This is alright since the bar problem is
not covered yet by the incontestability clause.
Concealment; Material Concealment; Incontestability
Clause (1998)
Renato was issued a life insurance policy on January 2,
1990. He concealed the fact that 3 years prior to the
issuance of his life insurance policy, he had been seeing a
doctor about his heart ailment.
On March 1, 1992, Renato died of heart failure. May the
heirs file a claim on the proceeds of the life insurance
policy of Renato? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. The life insurance policy in question was issued on
January 9, 1990. More than 2 years had elapsed when
Renato, the insured, died on March 1, 1992. The
incontestability clause applies.
INCONTESTABILITY CLAUSE
The insurer has two years from the date of issuance of the
insurance contract or of its last reinstatement within which
to contest the policy, whether or not, the insured still lives
within such period. After two years, the defenses of
concealment or misrepresentation, no matter how patent
or well founded, no longer lie.
Insurable Interest: Bank Deposit (2000)
BD has a bank deposit of half a million pesos. Since the
limit of the insurance coverage of the Philippine Deposit
Insurance Corp (PDIC) (RA 3591) is only one tenth of
BDs deposit, he would like some protection for the excess
by taking out an insurance against all risks or contingencies
of loss arising from any unsound or unsafe banking
practices including unforeseen adverse effects of
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
the continuing crisis involving the banking and financial
sector in the Asian region. Does BD have an insurable
interest within the meaning of the Insurance Code of the
Philippines (PD1460)? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. BD has insurable interest in his bank deposit. In case
of loss of said deposit, more particularly to the extent of
the amount in excess of the limit covered by the PDIC
Act, PBD will be damnified. He will suffer pecuniary loss
of P300,000.00, that is, his bank deposit of half a million
pesos minus P200,000.00 which is the maximum amount
recoverable from the PDIC.
Insurable Interest: Public Enemy (2000)
May a member of the MILF or its breakaway group, the
Abu Sayyaf, be insured with a company licensed to do
business under the Insurance Code of the Phils (PD
1460)? Explain. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A member of the MILF or the Abu Sayyaf may be insured
with a company licensed to do business under the
Insurance Code of the Phils. What is prohibited to be
insured is a public enemy. A public enemy is a citizen or
national of a country with which the Philippines is at war.
Such member of the MILF or the Abu Sayyaf is not a
citizen or national of another country, but of the
Philippines.
Insurable Interest: Separate Insurable Interest (1999)
A businessman in the grocery business obtained from First
Insurance an insurance policy for P5M to fully cover his
stocks-in-trade from the risk of fire.
Three months thereafter, a fire of accidental origin broke
out and completely destroyed the grocery including his
stocks-in-trade. This prompted the businessman to file
with First Insurance a claim for five million pesos
representing the full value of his goods.
First Insurance denied the claim because it discovered that
at the time of the loss, the stocks-in-trade were mortgaged
to a creditor who likewise obtained from Second Insurance
Company fire insurance coverage for the stocks at their full
value of P5M. a) May the businessman and the creditor
obtain
separate insurance coverages over the same stocks-
in-trade? Explain (3%) b) First Insurance refused to pay
claiming that double
insurance is contrary to law. Is this contention
tenable? (3%) c) Suppose you are the Judge, how much
would you
allow the businessman and the creditor to recover
from their respective insurers. Explain (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Yes. The businessman, as owner, and the creditor, as
mortgagee, have separate insurable interests in the same
stocks-in-trade. Each may insure such interest to protect
his own separate interest. b) The contention of First
Insurance that double insurance is contrary to law is
untenable. There is no law providing that double insurance
is illegal per se.
Page 52 of 103 Moreover, in the problem at hand, there
is no double insurance because the insured with the First
Insurance is different from the insured with the Second
Insurance Company. The same is true with respect to the
interests insured in the two policies.
c) As Judge, I would allow the businessman to recover his
total loss of P5M representing the full value of his goods
which were lost through fire. As to the creditor, I would
allow him to recover the amount to the extent of or
equivalent to the value of the credit he extended to the
businessman for the stocks-in-trade which were mortgaged
by the businessman.
Insurable Interest; Equitable Interest (1991)
A piece of machinery was shipped to Mr Pablo on the
basis of C&F Manila. Pablo insured said machinery with
the Talaga Merchants Ins Co (Tamic) for loss or damage
during the voyage. The vessel sank en route to Manila.
Pablo then filed a claim with Tamic which was denied for
the reason that prior to deliver, Pablo had no insurable
interest. Decide the case.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Pablo had an existing insurable interest on the piece of
machinery he bought. The purchase of goods under a
perfected contract of sale already vests equitable interest
on the property in favor of the buyer even while it is
pending delivery (Filipino Merchants Ins Co v CA GR 85144
28Nov1989)
Insurable Interest; Life vs. Property Insurance (1997)
a) A obtains a fire insurance on his house and as a
generous gesture names his neighbor as the
beneficiary. If As house is destroyed by fire, can B
successfully claim against the policy? b) A obtains
insurance over his life and names his
neighbor B the beneficiary because of As secret love
for B. If A dies, can B successfully claim against the
policy?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) No. In property insurance, the beneficiary must have
insurable interest in the property insured. (Sec 18 Ins
Code). B does not have insurable interest in the house
insured.
b) Yes. In life insurance, it is not required that the
beneficiary must have insurable interest in the life of the
insured. It was the insured himself who took the policy on
his own life.
Insurable Interest; Life vs. Property Insurance (2000)
IS, an elderly bachelor with no known relatives, obtained
life insurance coverage for P250,000.00 from Starbrite
Insurance Corporation, an entity licensed to engage in the
insurable business under the Insurance Code of the
Philippines (PD1460). He also insured his residential house
for twice that amount within the same corporation. He
immediately assigned all his rights to the insurance proceeds
to BX, a friend-companion living with him. Three years
later, IS died in a fire that gutted his insured house two days
after he had sold it. There is
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
no evidence of suicide or arson or involvement of BX in
these events. BX demanded payment of the insurance
proceeds from the two policies, the premiums for which
IS had been faithfully paying during all the time he was
alive. Starbrite refused payment, contending that BX had
no insurable interest and therefore was not entitled to
receive the proceeds from ISs insurance coverage on his
life and also on his property. Is Starbrites contention
valid? Explain? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Starbrite is correct with respect to the insurance coverage
on the property of IS. The beneficiary in the property
insurance policy or the assignee thereof must have
insurable interest in the property insured. BX, a mere
friend-companion of IS, has no insurable interest in the
residential house of IS. BX is not entitled to receive the
proceeds from ISs insurance on his property.
As to the insurance coverage on the life of IS, BX is
entitled to receive the proceeds. There is no requirement
that BX should have insurable interest in the life of IS. It
was IS himself who took the insurance on his own life.
Insurable Interest; Life vs. Property Insurance (2002)
Distinguish insurable interest in property insurance from
insurable interest in life insurance. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) In property insurance, the expectation of benefit
must have a legal basis. In life insurance, the expectation of
benefit to be derived from the continued existence of a life
need not have any legal basis.
b) In property insurance, the actual value of the
interest therein is the limit of the insurance that can validly
be placed thereon. In life insurance, there is no limit to the
amount of insurance that may be taken upon life.
c) In property insurance, an interest insured must
exist when the insurance takes effect and when the loss
occurs but need not exist in the meantime. In life
insurance, it is enough that insurable interest exists at the
time when the contract is made but it need not exist at the
time of loss.
Insurable Interest; Property Insurance (1994)
In a civil suit, the Court ordered Benjie to pay Nat
P500,000.00. To execute the judgment, the sheriff levied
upon Benjies registered property (a parcel of land and the
building thereon),and sold the same at public auction to
Nat, the highest bidder. The latter, on March 18, 1992,
registered with the Register of Deeds the certificate of sale
issued to him by the sheriff. Meanwhile, on January 27,
1993, Benjie insured with Garapal Insurance for
P1,000,000.00 the same building that was sold at public
auction to Nat. Benjie failed to redeem the property by
March 18, 1993.
Page 53 of 103 On March 19, 1993, a fire razed the
building to the ground. Garapal Insurance refused to make
good its obligation to Benjie under the insurance contract.
1) Is Garapal Insurance legally justified in refusing payment
to Benjie? 2) Is Nat entitled to collect on the insurance
policy?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1)Yes. At the time of the loss, Benjie was no longer the
owner of the property insured as he failed to redeem the
property. The law requires in property insurance that a
person can recover the proceeds of the policy if he has
insurable interest at the time of the issuance of the policy
and also at the time when the loss occurs. At the time of
fire, Benjie no longer had insurable interest in the property
insured.
2) No. While at the time of the loss he had insurable
interest in the building, as he was the owner thereof, Nat
did not have any interest in the policy. There was no
automatic transfer clause in the policy that would give him
such interest in the policy.
Insurable Interest; Property Insurance (2001)
JQ, owner of a condominium unit, insured the same
against fire with the XYZ Insurance Co., and made the
loss payable to his brother, MLQ. In case of loss by fire of
the said condominium unit, who may recover on the fire
insurance policy? State the reason(s) for your answer. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
JQ can recover on the fire insurance policy for the loss of
said condominium unit. He has the insurable interest as
owner-insured. As beneficiary in the fire insurance policy,
MLQ cannot recover on the fire insurance policy. For the
beneficiary to recover on the fire or property insurance
policy, it is required that he must have insurable interest in
the property insured. In this case, MLQ does not have
insurable interest in the condominium unit.
Insurance; Cash & Carry Basis (2003)
What is meant by cash and carry in the business of
insurance?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Insurance; Co-Insurance vs. Re-Insurance (1994)
Distinguish co-insurance from re-insurance.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
CO-INSURANCE is the percentage in the value of the
insured property which the insured himself assumes or
undertakes to act as insurer to the extent of the deficiency
in the insurance of the insured property. In case of loss or
damage, the insurer will be liable only for such proportion
of the loss or damage as the amount of insurance bears to
the designated percentage of the full value of the property
insured.
REINSURANCE is where the insurer procures a third
party, called the reinsurer, to insure him against liability by
reason of such original insurance. Basically, a
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
reinsurance is an insurance against liability which the
original insurer may incur in favor of the original insured.
Insurance; Double Insurance (2005)
When does double insurance exist? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Under Section 93 of the Insurance Code, there is double
insurance when there is over-insurance with two or more
companies, covering the same property, the same insurable
interest and the same risk. Double insurance exists where
the same person is insured by several insurers separately in
respect of the same subject matter and interests. (Geagonia v.
Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 114427, February 6, 1995)
Insurance; Double Insurance; effect (1993)
Julie and Alma formed a business partnership. Under the
business name Pino Shop, the partnership engaged in a sale
of construction materials. Julie insured the stocks in trade
of Pino Shop with WGC Insurance Co for P350th.
Subsequently, she again got an insurance contract with RSI
for P1m and then from EIC for P200th. A fire of
unknown origin gutted the store of the partnership. Julie
filed her claims with the three insurance companies.
However, her claims were denied separately for breach of
policy condition which required the insured to give notice
of any insurance effected covering the stocks in trade. Julie
went to court and contended that she should not be
blamed for the omission, alleging that the insurance agents
for WGC, RSI and EIC knew of the existence of the
additional insurance coverages and that she was not
informed about the requirement that such other or
additional insurance should be stated in the policy. Is the
contention of Julie tenable? Explain. May she recover on
her fire insurance policies? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) No. An insured is required to disclose the other
insurances covering the subject matter of the insurance
being applied for. (New Life Ent v CA 207 s 669)
2) No, because she is guilty of violation of a warranty/
condition.
Insurance; Effects; Payment of Premiums by Installment
(2006)
The Peninsula Insurance Company offered to insure
Francis' brand new car against all risks in the sum of PI
Million for 1 year. The policy was issued with the premium
fixed at 160,000.00 payable in 6 months. Francis only paid
the first two months installments. Despite demands, he
failed to pay the subsequent installments. Five months after
the issuance of the policy, the vehicle was carnapped.
Francis filed with the insurance company a claim for its
value. However, the company denied his claim on the
ground that he failed to pay the premium resulting in the
cancellation of the policy. Can Francis recover from the
Peninsula Insurance Company? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Page 54 of 103 Yes, when insured and insurer have
agreed to the payment of premium by installments and
partial payment has been made at the time of loss, then the
insurer becomes liable. When the car loss happened on the
5th month, the six months agreed period of payment had
not yet elapsed (UCPB General Insurance v. Masagana Telamart,
G.R. No. 137172, April 4, 2001). Francis can recover from
Peninsula Insurance Company, but the latter has the right
to deduct the amount of unpaid premium from the
insurance proceeds.
Insurance; Life Insurance; Assignment of Policy (1991)
The policy of insurance upon his life, with a face value of
P100th was assigned by Jose, a married man with 2
legitimate children, to his nephew Y as security for a loan
of P50th. He did not give the insurer any written notice of
such assignment despite the explicit provision to that
effect in the policy. Jose died. Upon the claim on the
policy by the assignee, the insurer refused to pay on the
ground that it was not notified of the assignment. Upon
the other hand, the heirs of Jose contended that Y is not
entitled to any amount under the policy because the
assignment without due notice to the insurer was void.
Resolve the issues.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A life insurance is assignable. A provision, however, in the
policy stating that written notice of such an assignment
should be given to the insurer is valid (Secs 181-182 Ins
Code). The failure of the notice of assignment would thus
preclude the assignee from claiming rights under the policy.
The failure of notice did not, however, avoid the policy;
hence, upon the death of Jose, the proceeds would, in the
absence of a designated beneficiary, go to the estate of the
insured. The estate, in turn, would be liable for the loan of
P50,000 owing in favor of Y.
Insurance; Perfection of Insurance Contracts (2003)
Josie Gatbonton obtained from Warranty Insurance
Corporation a comprehensive motor vehicle insurance to
cover her brand new automobile. She paid, and the insurer
accepted payment in check. Before the check could be
encashed, Josie was involved in a motor vehicle accident
where her car became a total wreck. She sought payment
from the insurer. Could the insurer be made liable under
the insurance coverage? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
(per Dondee) Yes, because there was a perfected contract
of insurance the moment there is a meeting of the minds
with respect to the object and the cause of payment. The
payment of check is a valid payment unless upon
encashment the check bounced.
Insurance; Property Insurance; Prescription of Claims
(1996)
Robin insured his building against fire with EFG
Assurance. The insurance policy contained the usual
stipulation that any action or suit must be filed within one
year after the rejection of the claim.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
After his building burned down, Robin filed his claim for
fire loss with EFG. On Feb 28, 1994, EFG denied Robins
claim. On April 3, 1994, Robin sought reconsideration of
the denial, but EFG reiterated its position. On March 20,
1995, Robin commenced judicial action against EFG.
Should Robins action be given due course? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, Robins action should not be given due course. Is
filing of the request for reconsideration did not suspend
the running of the prescriptive period of one year
stipulated in the insurance policy. Thus, when robin
commenced judicial action against EFG Assurance on
March 20, 1995, his ability to do so had already prescribed.
The one-year period is counted from Feb 28, 1994 when
EFG denied Robins claim, not from the date (presumably
after April 3, 1994) when EFG reiterated its position
denying Robins claim. The reason for this rule is to insure
that claims against insurance companies are promptly
settled and that insurance suits are brought by the insured
while the evidence as to the origin and cause of the
destruction has not yet disappeared. (See Sun Ins Office Ltd v
CA gr 89741, Mar 13 91 195s193)
Insurance; Return of Premiums (2000)
Name at least three instances when an insured is entitled
to a return of the premium paid.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Three instances when an insured is entitled to a return of
premium paid are:
1 To the WHOLE PREMIUM, if no part of his interest
in the thing insured be exposed to any of the perils insured
against.
2 Where the insurance is made for a definite period of
time and the insured surrenders his policy, to such portion of the
premium as corresponds with the unexpired time at a pro rata
rate, unless a short period rate has been agreed upon and appears
on the face of the policy, after deducting from the whole
premium any claim for loss or damage under the policy which
has previously accrued.
3 When the contract is voidable on account of the fraud
or misrepresentation of the insurer or of his agent or on account
of facts the existence of which the insured was ignorant without
his fault; or when, by any default of the insured other than actual
fraud, the insurer never incurred any liability under the policy.
ALTERNATIVE INSTANCE:
In case of an over insurance by several insurers, the
insured is entitled to a ratable return of the premium,
proportioned to the amount by which the aggregate sum
insured in all the policies exceeds the insurable value of the
thing at risk.
Insured; Accident Policy (2004)
CNI insure SAM under a homeowner's policy against
claims for accidental injuries by neighbors. SAM's minor
Page 55 of 103 son, BOY, injured 3 children of POS, a
neighbor, who sued SAM for damages. SAM's lawyer was
ATT, who was paid for his services by the insurer for
reporting periodically on the case to CNI. In one report,
ATT disclosed to CNI that after his investigations, he
found the injuries to the 3 children not accidental but
intentional.
SAM lost the case in court, and POS was awarded one
million pesos in damages which he sought to collect from
the insurer. But CNI used ATTs report to deny the claim
on the ground that the injuries to POS's 3 children were
intentional, hence excluded from the policy's coverage.
POS countered that CNI was estopped from using ATTs
report because it was unethical for ATT to provide
prejudicial information against his client to the insurer,
CNI. Who should prevail: the claimant, POS; or the
insurer, CNI? Decide with reasons briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
CNI is not estopped from using ATT's report, because
CNI, in the first place, commissioned it and paid ATT for
it. On the other hand, ATT has no conflict of interest
because SAM and CNI are on the same side their
interests being congruent with each other, namely, to
oppose POS's claim. It cannot be said that ATT has used
the information to the disadvantage or prejudice of SAM.
However, in Finman General Assurance Corp. v. Court of Appeals, 213
SCRA 493 (1992), it was explained that there is no "accident"
in the context of an accident policy, if it is the natural result
of the insured's voluntary act, unaccompanied by anything
unforeseen except the injury. There is no accident when a
deliberate act is performed, unless some additional and
unforeseen happening occurs that brings about the injury.
This element of deliberateness is not clearly shown from the
facts of the case, especially considering the fact that BOY is
a minor, and the injured parties are also children.
Accordingly, it is possible that CNI may not prosper. ATT's
report is not conclusive on POS or the court.
Insured; Accident vs. Suicide (1990)
Luis was the holder of an accident insurance policy
effective Nov 1, 1988 to Oct 31, 1989. At a boxing contest
held on Jan 1, 1989 and sponsored by his employer, he
slipped and was hit on the fact by his opponent so he fell
and his head hit one of the posts of the boxing ring. He
was rendered unconscious and was dead on arrival at the
hospital due to intra-cranial hemorrhage.
Can his father who is a beneficiary under said insurance
policy successfully claim indemnity from the insurance
company? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, the father who is a beneficiary under the accidental
insurance can successfully claim indemnity for the death
of the insured. Clearly, the proximate cause of death was
the boxing contest. Death sustained in a boxing contest is
an accident. (De la Cruz v Capital Ins & Surety Co 17s559)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 56 of 103
Insured; Accident vs. Suicide (1993)
S Insurance Co issued a personal accident policy to Bob
Tan with a face value of P500th. In the evening of Sep 5,
1992, after his birthday party, Tan was in a happy mood
but not drunk. He was playing with his hand gun, from
which he previously removed the magazine. As his
secretary was watching television, he stood in front of her
and pointed the gun at her. She pushed it aside and said
that it may be loaded. He assured her that it was not and
then pointed it at his temple. The next moment, there was
an explosion and Tan slumped to the floor lifeless.
The wife of the deceased sought payment on the policy
but her claim was rejected. The insurance company agreed
that there was no suicide. However, it was the submission
of the insurance company that there was no accident. In
support thereof, it contended a) that there was no accident
when a deliberate act was performed unless some
additional, unexpected, independent and unforeseen
happening occur which produces or brings about the
injury or death; and b) that the insured willfully exposed
himself to needless peril and thus removed himself from
the coverage of the insurance policy. Are the two
contentions of the insurance company tenable? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. These two contentions are not tenable. The insurer is
liable for injury or death even due to the insureds gross
negligence. The fact that the insured removed the
magazine from the hand gun means that the insured did
not willfully expose himself to needless peril. At most, the
insured is only guilty of negligence (Sun Ins v CA 211 s 554)
Insured; Accident vs. Suicide (1995)
Sun-Moon Insurance issued a Personal Accident Policy to
Henry Dy with a face value of P500th. A provision in the
policy states that the company shall not be liable in respect
of bodily injury consequent upon the insured person
attempting to commit suicide or willfully exposing himself
to needless peril except in an attempt to save human life.
Six months later Henry Dy died of a bullet wound in his
head. Investigation showed that one evening Henry was in
a happy mood although he was not drunk. He was playing
with his handgun from which he had previously removed
its magazine. He pointed the gun at his sister who got
scared. He assured her it was not loaded. He then pointed
the gun at his temple and pulled the trigger. The gun fired
and Henry slumped on the floor.
Henrys wife Beverly, as the designated beneficiary,
sought to collect under the policy. Sun-Moon Insurance
rejected her claim on the ground that the death of Henry
was not accidental. Beverly sued the insurer. Decide and
Discuss fully.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Beverly can recover the proceeds of the policy from the insurer. The death of
the insured was not due to suicide
or willful exposure to needless peril which are excepted risks. The insureds
act was purely an act of negligence which is covered by the policy and for
which the insured got the insurance for his protection. In fact, he removed the
magazine from the gun and when he pointed the gun to his temple he did so
because he thought that it was safe for him to do so. He did so to assure his
sister that the gun was harmless. There is none in the policy that would relieve
the insurer of liability for the death of the insured since the death was an
accident.
Insurer: Effects: Several Insurers (2005)
What is the nature of the liability of the several insurers in
double insurance? Explain. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The nature of the liability of the several insurers in double
insurance is that each insurer is bound to the contribute
ratably to the loss in proportion to the amount for which he
is liable under his contract as provided for by Sec 94 of ICP
par. The ratable contribution of each of each insurer will be
determined based on the following formula: AMOUNT OF
POLICY divided by TOTAL INSURANCE TAKEN
multiplied by LOSS = LIABILITY OF THE INSURER.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Each insurer is bound, as between himself and other
insurers, to contribute ratably to the loss in proportion to
the amount for which he is liable under his contract. (Sec.
94, Insurance Code)
Insurer; 3rd Party Liability (1996)
While driving his car along EDSA, Cesar sideswiped
Roberto, causing injuries to the latter, Roberto sued Cesar
and the third party liability insurer for damages and/or
insurance proceeds. The insurance company moved to
dismiss the complaint, contending that the liability of Cesar
has not yet been determined with finality. a) Is the
contention of the insurer correct? Explain. b) May the
insurer be held liable with Cesar?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, the contention of the insurer is not correct. There is no
need to wait for the decision of the court determining
Cesars liability with finality before the third party liability
insurer could be sued. The occurrence of the injury to
Roberto immediately gave rise to the liability of the insurer
under its policy. In other words, where an insurance policy
insures directly against liability, the insurers liability accrues
immediately upon the occurrence of the injury or event
upon which the liability depends (Sherman Shafer v Judge RTC
Olongapo City Branch 75 GR l-78848, Nov 14 88 167s386)
The insurer cannot be held solidarily liable with Cesar. The
liability of the insurer is based on contract while that of
Cesar is based on tort. If the insurer were solidarily liable
with Cesar, it could be made to pay more than the amount
stated in the policy. This would, however, be contrary to
the principles underlying insurance contracts. On the
other hand, if the insurer were solidarily liable with Cesar
and it is made to pay only up to the amount
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
stated in the insurance policy, the principles underlying
solidary obligations would be violated. (Malayan Ins Co v CA
GR L-36413 Sep 26, 88 165s536; Figuracion vda de Maglana v
Consolacion GR 60506 Aug 6, 92 212s268)
Insurer; 3rd Party Liability (2000)
X was riding a suburban utility vehicle (SUV) covered by a
comprehensive motor vehicle liability insurance (CMVLI)
underwritten by FastPay Insurance Company when it
collided with a speeding bus owned by RM Travel Inc. The
collision resulted in serious injuries to X; Y, a passenger of
the bus; and Z, a pedestrian waiting for a ride at the scene
of the collision. The police report established that the bus
was the offending vehicle. The bus had CMVLI policy
issued by Dragon Ins Co. X, Y, and Z jointly sued RM
Travel and Dragon Ins for indemnity under the Insurance
Code of the Phils (PD1460). The lower court applied the
no fault indemnity policy of the statute, dismissed the
suit against RM Travel, and ordered Dragon Ins to pay
indemnity to all three plaintiffs. Do you agree with the
courts judgment? Explain (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The cause of action of Y is based on the contract of
carriage, while that of X and Z is based on torts. The court
should not have dismissed the suit against RM Travel. The
court should have ordered Dragon Ins to pay each of X, Y
, and Z to the extent of the insurance coverage, but
whatever amount is agreed upon in the policy should be
answered first by RM Travel and the succeeding amount
should be paid by Dragon Insurance up to the amount of
the insurance coverage. The excess of the claims of X, Y,
and Z, over and above such insurance coverage, if any,
should be answered or paid by RM Travel.
Insurer; 3rd Party Liability; No Fault Indemnity (1994)
What is your understanding of a no fault indemnity
clause found in an insurance policy?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Under the NO FAULT INDEMNITY clause, any claim
for death or injury of any passenger or third party shall be
paid without the necessity of proving fault or negligence of
any kind. The indemnity in respect of any one person shall
not exceed P5,000.00, provided they are under oath, the
following proofs shall be sufficient:
1. police report of the accident;
and
2. death certificate and evidence sufficient to
establish the proper payee; or
3. medical report and evidence of medical or
hospital disbursement in respect of which refund is
claimed.
4. Claim may be made against one motor vehicle
only.
Insurer; 3rd Party Liability; Quitclaim (1994)
Rauls truck bumped the car owned by Luz. The car was
insured by Cala Insurance. For the damage caused, Cala
paid Luz P5,000.00 in amicable settlement. Luz executed a
release of claim, subrogating Cala to all her rights against
Raul. When Cala demanded reimbursement from Raul, the
latter refused saying that he had already paid
Page 57 of 103 Luz P4,500 for the damage to the car as
evidenced by a release of claim executed by Luz
discharging Raul.
So Cala demanded reimbursement from Luz, who refused
to pay, saying that the total damage to the car was
P9,500.00 Since Cala paid P5,000 only, Luz contends that
she was entitled to go after Raul to claim the additional
P4,500.00 1) Is Cala, as subrogee of Luz, entitled to
reimbursement from Raul? 2) May Cala recover what it has
paid Luz?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) No. Luz executed a release in favor of Raul (Manila
Mahogany Mfg Corp v CA GR 52756, 12 Oct 1987)
2) Yes. Cala lost its right against Raul because of the
release executed by Luz. Since the release was made
without the consent of Cala, Cala may recover the amount
of P5,000 form Luz (Manila Mahogany Mfg Corp v CA GR 52756,
12 Oct 1987).
Insurer; Authorized Driver Clause (1991)
Sheryl insured her newly acquired car, a Nissan Maxima
against any loss or damage for P50th and against 3rd party
liability for P20th with the XYZ Ins Co. Under the policy,
the car must be driven only by an authorized driver who is
either: 1) the insured, or 2) any person driving on the
insureds order or with his permission: provided that the
person driving is permitted in accordance with the licensing
or other laws or regulations to drive the motor vehicle and
is not disqualified from driving such motor vehicle by order
of a court.
During the effectivity of the policy, the car, then driven by
Sheryl herself, who had no drivers license, met an accident
and was extensively damaged. The estimated cost of repair
was P40th. Sheryl immediately notified XYZ, but the latter
refused to pay on the policy alleging that Sheryl violated
the terms thereof when she drove it without a drivers
license. Is the insurer correct?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The insurer was not correct in denying the claim since the
proviso that the person driving is permitted in accordance
with the licensing, etc. qualified only a person driving the
vehicle other than the insured at the time of the accident
(Palermo v Pyramid Ins Co GR 36480 31 May 88)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
The insurer is correct. The clause authorized driver in
the policy evidently applies to both the insured and any
other person driving the vehicle at the time of the accident.
The term authorized driver should be construed as a
person who is authorized by law to driver the vehicle (Peza v
Alikpala 160s31)
Insurer; Authorized Driver Clause (2003)
Rick de la Cruz insured his passenger jeepney with Asiatic
Insurers, Inc. The policy provided that the authorized
driver of the vehicle should have a valid and existing
drivers license. The passenger jeepney of Rick de la Cruz
which was at the time driven by Jay Cruz,
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
figured in an accident resulting in the death of a passenger.
At the time of the accident, Jay Cruz was licensed to drive
but it was confiscated by an LTO agent who issued him a
Traffic Violation Report (TVR) just minutes before the
accident. Could Asiatic Insurers, Inc., be made liable under
its policy? Why? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Asiatic Insurers, Inc., should be made liable under the
policy. The fact that the driver was merely holding a TVR
does not violate the condition that the driver should have
a valid and existing drivers license.
Besides, such a condition should be disregarded because
what is involved is a passenger jeepney, and what is
involved here is not own damage insurance but third party
liability where the injured party is a third party not privy to
the contract of insurance.
Insurer; Authorized Driver Clause; vehicle is stolen
(1993)
HL insured his brand new car with P Ins Co for
comprehensive coverage wherein the insurance company
undertook to indemnify him against loss or damage to the
car a) by accidental collision ... b) by fire, external
explosion, burglary, or theft, and c) malicious act.
After a month, the car was carnapped while parked in the
parking space in front of the Intercontinental Hotel in
Makati. HLs wife who was driving said car before it was
carnapped reported immediately the incident to various
government agencies in compliance with the insurance
requirements.
Because the car could not be recovered, HL filed a claim
for the loss of the car with the insurance company but it
was denied on the ground that his wife who was driving
the car when it was carnapped was in the possession of an
expired drivers license, a violation of the authorized
driver clause of the insurance company. 1) May the
insurance company be held liable to
indemnify HL for the loss of the insured vehicle?
Explain. 2) Supposing that the car was brought by HL on
installment basis and there were installments due
and payable before the loss of the car as well as
installments not yet payable. Because of the loss of
the car, the vendor demanded from HL the unpaid
balance of the promissory note. HL resisted the
demand and claimed that he was only liable for the
installments due and payable before the loss of the
car but no longer liable for other installments not yet
due at the time of the loss of the car. Decide.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) Yes. The car was lost due to theft. What applies in this
case is the theft clause, and not the authorized driver
clause. It is immaterial that HLs wife was driving the car
with an expired drivers license at the time it was
carnapped. (Perla Compania de Seguros v CA 208 s 487)
2) The promissory note is not affected by whatever befalls
the subject matter of the accessory contract. The
Page 58 of 103 unpaid balance on the promissory note
should be paid and not only the installments due and
payable before the loss of the car.
Insurer; Group Insurance; Employer-Policy Holder (2000)
X company procured a group accident insurance policy for
its construction employees variously assigned to its
provincial infrastructure projects. Y Insurance Company
underwrote the coverage, the premiums of which were paid
for entirely by X Company without any employee
contributions. While the policy was in effect, five of the
covered employees perished at sea on their way to their
provincial assignments. Their wives sued Y Insurance
Company for payment of death benefits under the policy.
While the suit was pending, the wives signed a power of
attorney designating X Company executive, PJ, as their
authorized representative to enter into a settlement with
the insurance company. When a settlement was reached, PJ
instructed the insurance company to issue the settlement
check to the order of X Company, which will undertake
the payment to the individual claimants of their respective
shares. PJ misappropriated the settlement amount and the
wives pursued their case against Y Insurance Co. Will the
suit prosper? Explain (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. The suit will prosper. Y Ins Co is liable. X Co,
through its executive, PJ, acted as agent of Y Ins Co. The
latter is thus bound by the misconduct of its agent. It is
the usual practice in the group insurance business that the
employer-policy holder is the agent of the insurer.
Insurer; Liability of the Insurers (1990)
a) Suppose that Fortune owns a house valued at P600th
and insured the same against fire with 3 insurance
companies as follows: X P400th Y P200th Z P600th
In the absence of any stipulation in the policies from
which insurance company or companies may Fortune
recover in case fire should destroy his house completely?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Fortune may recover from the insurers in such order as he
may select up to their concurrent liability (Sec 94 Ins
Code)
Valued Policy
b) If each of the fire insurance policies obtained by
Fortune in the problem (a) is a valued policy and the value
of his house was fixed in each of the policies at P1m, how
much would Fortune recover from X if he has already
obtained full payment on the insurance policies issued by
Y and Z?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Fortune may still recover only the balance of P200,000
from X insurance company since the insured may only
recover up to the extent of his loss.
ALTERNATIVE:
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Having already obtained full payment on the insurance
policies issued by Y and Z, Fortune may no longer recover
from X insurance policy.
Open Policy
c) If each of the policies obtained by Fortune in the
problem (a) above is an open policy and it was immediately
determined after the fire that the value of Fortunes house
was P2.4m, how much may he collect from X,Y and Z?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
In an open policy, the insured may recover his total loss up
to the amount of the insurance cover. Thus, the extent of
recovery would be P400th from X, P200th from Y, and
P600th from Z.
d) In problem (a), what is the extent of the liability of the
insurance companies among themselves?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
In problem (a), the insurance companies among themselves
would be liable, viz: X 4/12 of P600th = P200th Y
2/12 of P600th = P100th Z 6/12 of P600th = P300th
e) Supposing in problem (a) above, Fortune was able to
collect from both Y and Z, may he keep the entire amount
he was able to collect from the said 2 insurance
companies?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, he can only be indemnified for his loss, not profit
thereby; hence he must return P200th of the P800th he
was able to collect.
Loss: Actual Total Loss (1996)
RC Corporation purchased rice from Thailand, which it
intended to sell locally. Due to stormy weather, the ship
carrying the rice became submerged in sea water, and with
it the rice cargo. When the cargo arrived in Manila, RC
filed a claim for total loss with the insurer, because the rice
was no longer fit for human consumption. Admittedly, the
rice could still be used as animal feed. Is RCs claim for
total loss justified? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, RCs claim for total loss is justified. The rice, which
was imported from Thailand for sale locally, is obviously
intended for consumption by the public. The complete
physical destruction of the rice is not essential to constitute
an actual total loss. Such a loss exists in this case since the
rice, having been soaked in sea water and thereby rendered
unfit for human consumption, has become totally useless
for the purpose for which it was imported (Pan Malayan Ins
Co v CA gr 95070 Sep 5, 1991)
Loss: Constructive Total Loss (2005)
M/V Pearly Shells, a passenger and cargo vessel, was
insured for P40,000,000.00 against constructive total
loss. Due to a typhoon, it sank near Palawan. Luckily,
there were no casualties, only injured passengers. The ship
owner sent a notice of abandonment of his interest over
the vessel to the insurance company which then
Page 59 of 103 hired professionals to afloat the vessel
for P900,000.00. When re-floated, the vessel needed
repairs estimated at P2,000,000.00. The insurance
company refused to pay the claim of the ship owner,
stating that there was no constructive total loss. a) Was
there constructive total loss to entitle the ship
owner to recover from the insurance company?
Explain. b) Was it proper for the ship owner to send a
notice of
abandonment to the insurance company? Explain.
(5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, there was no "constructive total loss" because the
vessel was refloated and the costs of refloating plus the
needed repairs (P 2.9 Million) will not be more than
three-fourths of the value of the vessel. A constructive
total loss is one which gives to a person insured a right to
abandon. (Sec, 131, Insurance Code) There would have
been a constructive total loss had the vessel MN Pearly
Shells suffer loss or needed refloating and repairs of more
than the required three-fourths of its value, i.e., more than
P30.0 Million (Sec. 139, Insurance Code, cited in Oriental Assurance v.
Court of Appeals and Panama Saw Mill, G.R. No. 94052, August 9,
1991)
However, the insurance company shall pay for the total
costs of refloating and needed repairs (P2.9 Million).
c) Was it proper for the ship owner to send a
notice of abandonment to the insurance company?
Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, it was not proper for the ship owner to send a notice
of abandonment to the insurance company because
abandonment can only be availed of when, in a marine
insurance contract, the amount to be expended to recover
the vessel would have been more than three-fourths of its
value. Vessel MN Pearly Shells needed only P2.9 Million,
which does not meet the required three-fourths of its value
to merit abandonment. (Section 139, Insurance Code, cited
in Oriental Assurance v. Court of Appeals and Panama Saiv Mill, G.R.
No. 94052, August 9, 1991)
Loss: Total Loss Only (1992)
An insurance company issued a marine insurance policy
covering a shipment by sea from Mindoro to Batangas of
1,000 pieces of Mindoro garden stones against total loss
only. The stones were loaded in two lighters, the first with
600 pieces and the second with 400 pieces. Because of
rough seas, damage was caused the second lighter resulting
in the loss of 325 out of the 400 pieces. The owner of the
shipment filed claims against the insurance company on
the ground of constructive total loss inasmuch as more
than of the value of the stones had been lost in one of
the lighters. Is the insurance company liable under its
policy? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The insurance company is not liable under its policy
covering against total loss only the shipment of 1,000
pieces of Mindoro garden stones. There is no constructive
total loss that can claimed since the rule is to be
computed on the total 1,000 pieces of Mindoro
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
garden stones covered by the single policy coverage (see
Oriental Assurance Co v CA 200 s 459)
Marine Insurance; Implied Warranties (2000)
What warranties are implied in marine insurance?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The following warranties are implied in marine insurance:
1) That the ship is seaworthy to make the voyage
and/or to take in certain cargoes 2) That the ship shall not
deviate from the voyage
insured; 3) That the ship shall carry the necessary
documents to
show nationality or neutrality and that it will not
carry any document which will cast reasonable
suspicion thereon; 4) That the ship shall not carry
contraband, especially if
it is making a voyage through belligerent waters.
Marine Insurance; Peril of the Ship vs. Peril of the Sea
(1998)
A marine insurance policy on a cargo states that the
insurer shall be liable for losses incident to perils of the
sea. During the voyage, seawater entered the compartment
where the cargo was stored due to the defective drainpipe
of the ship. The insured filed an action on the policy for
recovery of the damages caused to the cargo. May the
insured recover damages? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The proximate cause of the damage to the cargo
insured was the defective drainpipe of the ship. This is
peril of the ship, and not peril of the sea. The defect in the
drainpipe was the result of the ordinary use of the ship. To
recover under a marine insurance policy, the proximate
cause of the loss or damage must be peril of the sea.
Mutual Insurance Company; Nature & Definition (2006)
What is a mutual insurance company or association?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A mutual life insurance corporation is a cooperative that
promotes the welfare of its own members, with the money
collected from among themselves and solely for their own
protection and not for profit. Members are both the
insurer and insured. A mutual life insurance company has
no capital stock and relies solely upon its contributions or
premiums to meet unexpected losses, contingencies and
expenses (Republic v. Sunlife, G.R. No 158085, October 14,
2005).
Intellectual Property
Copyright (1995)
What intellectual property rights are protected by
copyright?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Sec 5 of PD 49 provides that Copyright shall consist in
the exclusive right:
Copyright; Commissioned Artist (1995)
Solid Investment House commissioned Mon Blanco and
his son Steve, both noted artists, to paint a mural for the
Main Lobby of the new building of Solid for a contract
price of P2m. a) who owns the mural? Explain b) Who
owns the copyright of the mural? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Solid owns the mural. Solid was the one who
commissioned the artists to do the work and paid for the
work in the sum of P2m
b)Unless there is a stipulation to the contrary in the
contract, the copyright shall belong in joint ownership to
Solid and Mon and Steve.
Copyright; Commissioned Artist (2004)
BR and CT are noted artists whose paintings are highly
prized by collectors. Dr. DL commissioned them to paint
a mural at the main lobby of his new hospital for children.
Both agreed to collaborate on the project for a total fee of
two million pesos to be equally divided between them. It
was also agreed that Dr. DL had to provide all the
materials for the painting and pay for the wages of
technicians and laborers needed for the work on the
project.
Assume that the project is completed and both BR and
CT are fully paid the amount of P2M as artists' fee by DL.
Under the law on intellectual property, who will own the
mural? Who will own the copyright in the mural? Why?
Explain. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Under Section 178.4 of the Intellectual Property Code, in
case of commissioned work, the creator (in the absence of
a written stipulation to the contrary) owns the copyright,
but the work itself belongs to the person who
commissioned its creation. Accordingly, the mural belongs
to DL. However, BR and CT own the copyright, since
there is no stipulation to the contrary.
Copyright; Infringement (1994)
1
)
Can A now bring an action in the name of the
corporation to question the issuance of the shares
to X without receiving any payment?
2
)
Can X question the right of A to sue him in behalf
of the corporation on the ground that A has only
one share in his name?
3
)
Cannot the shares issued to X be considered as
watered stock?
1
)
when justified by definite corporate expansion
projects or programs approved by the BOD; or
2
)
when the corporation is prohibited under any loan
agreement with any financial institution or creditor,
whether local or foreign, from declaring dividends
without its or his consent, and such consent has not
yet been secured; or
3
)
when it can be clearly shown that such retention is
necessary under special circumstances obtaining in
the corporation, such as when there is need for
special reserve for probable contingencies.
a
.
Page 60 of 103 to print, reprint, publish, copy,
distribute, multiply, sell and make photographs,
photo engravings, and pictorial illustrations of the
works;
b
.
to make any translation or other version or extracts
or arrangements or adaptation thereof; to dramatize
if it be a non-dramatic work; to convert it into a
non-dramatic work if it be a drama; to complete or
execute it if it be a model or design;
c
.
to exhibit, perform, represent, produce or
reproduce the work in any manner or by any
method whatever for profit or otherwise; if not
reproduced in copies for sale, to sell any
manuscripts or any record whatsoever thereof;
d
.
to make any other use or disposition of the work
consistent with the laws of the land
Johann.
a. seize and destroy
b. injunction
c.
damages in such amount may have
bee
n
obtained from the use of the invention
i
f
properly transacted which can be more
tha
n
what the infringer (Johann ) received.
d. Attorneys fees and cost
1
)
Negotiability - That quality or attribute whereby a
bill, note or check passes or may pass from hand to
hand, similar to money, so as to give the holder in
due course the right to hold the instrument and
collect the sum payable for himself free from
defenses.
2
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
The Victoria Hotel chain reproduces videotapes, distributes
the copies thereof to its hotels and makes them available to
hotel guests for viewing in the hotel guest rooms. It charges
a separate nominal fee for the use of the videotape player.
1) Can the Victoria Hotel be enjoined for infringing
copyrights and held liable for damages? 2) Would it make
any difference if Victoria Hotel does not charge any fee for
the use of the videotape?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) Yes. Victoria Hotel has no right to use such video tapes
in its hotel business without the consent of the creator/
owner of the copyright.
2) No. The use of the videotapes is for business and not
merely for home consumption. (Filipino Society of Composers,
Authors Publishers v Tan 148 s 461; pd 1988)
Copyright; Infringement (1997)
In an action for damages on account of an infringement
of a copyright, the defendant (the alleged pirate) raised the
defense that he was unaware that what he had copied was
a copyright material. Would this defense be valid?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. An intention to pirate is not an element of
infringement. Hence, an honest intention is no defense to
an action for infringement.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Yes. The owner of the copyright must make others aware
that the material in question is under or covered by a
copyright. This is done by the giving of such notice at a
prominent portion of the copyright material. When the
alleged pirate is thus made aware thereof, his act of
pirating the copy material will constitute infringement.
Copyright; Infringement (1998)
Juan Xavier wrote and published a story similar to an
unpublished copyrighted story of Manoling Santiago. It
was, however, conclusively proven that Juan Xavier was
not aware that the story of Manoling Santiago was
protected by copyright. Manoling Santiago sued Juan
Xavier for infringement of copyright. Is Juan Xavier liable?
(2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. Juan Xavier is liable for infringement of copyright. It
is not necessary that Juan Xavier is aware that the story of
Manoling Santiago was protected by copyright. The work
of Manoling Santiago is protected at the time of its
creation.
Copyright; Infringement (2006)
In a written legal opinion for a client on the difference
between apprenticeship and learnership, Liza quoted
without permission a labor law expert's comment appearing
in his book entitled "Annotations on the Labor Code." Can
the labor law expert hold Liza liable for infringement of
copyright for quoting a portion of his book without his
permission? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Page 61 of 103 Liza cannot be held liable for
infringement of copyright since under the Intellectual
Property Code, one of the limitations to the copyright is
the making of quotations from a published work for
purpose of any judicial proceedings or for giving of
professorial advice by legal practitioner, provided that the
source and name of the author are identified (See Section
184.1[k] of the Intellectual Property Code of the
Philippines).
Copyright; Photocopy; when allowed (1998)
May a person have photocopies of some pages of the
book of Professor Rosario made without violating the
copyright law? (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. The private reproduction of a published work in a
single copy, where the reproduction is made by a natural
person exclusively for research and private study, is
permitted, without the authorization of the owner of the
copyright in the work.
Infringement vs. Unfair Competition (1996)
What is the distinction between infringement and unfair
competition?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The distinction between infringement (presumably
trademark) and unfair competition are as follows: 1)
Infringement of trademark is the unauthorized use
of a trademark, whereas unfair competition is the
passing off of ones goods as those of another;
2) Fraudulent intent is unnecessary in infringement of
trademark, whereas fraudulent intent is essential in
unfair competition;
3) The prior registration of the trademark is a
prerequisite to an action for infringement of trademark,
whereas registration of the trademark is not necessary in
unfair competition. (Del Monte Corp v CA 78325 Jan 25,90
181s410)
Infringement vs. Unfair Competition (2003)
In what way is an infringement of a trademark similar to
that which pertains to unfair competition?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Infringement; Jurisdiction (2003)
K-9 Corporation, a foreign corporation alleging itself to be
the registered owner of trademark K-9 and logo K,
filed an Inter Partes case with the Intellectual Property
Office against Kanin Corporation for the cancellation of
the latters mark K-9 and logo K. During the
pendency of the case before the IPO, Kanin Corporation
brought suit against K-9 Corporation before the RTC for
infringement and damages. Could the action before the
RTC prosper? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Patent; Non-Patentable Inventions (2006)
Supposing Albert Einstein were alive today and he filed
with the Intellectual Property Office (IPO) an application
for patent for his theory of relativity expressed in the
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
formula E=mc2. The IPO disapproved Einstein's
application on the ground that his theory of relativity is not
patentable. Is the IPO's action correct? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, the IPO is correct because under the Intellectual
Property Code, discoveries, scientific theories and
mathematical methods, are classified to be as "non-
patentable inventions." Eintein's theory of relativity falls
within the category of being a non-patentable "scientific
theory."
Patents: Gas-Saving Device: first to file rule (2005)
Cezar works in a car manufacturing company owned by
Joab. Cezar is quite innovative and loves to tinker with
things. With the materials and parts of the car, he was able
to invent a gas-saving device that will enable cars to
consume less gas. Francis, a co-worker, saw how Cezar
created the device and likewise, came up with a similar
gadget, also using scrap materials and spare parts of the
company. Thereafter, Francis filed an application for
registration of his device with the Bureau of Patents.
Eighteen months later, Cezar filed his application for the
registration of his device with the Bureau of Patents.
1) Is the gas-saving device patentable? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, the gas-saving device is patentable because it provides
a technical solution to a problem in a field of human
activity. It is new and involves an inventive step, and
certainly industrially applicable. It therefore fulfills the
requisites mandated by the intellectual Property Code for
what is patentable.
2) Assuming that it is patentable, who is entitled to the
patent? What, if any, is the remedy of the losing
party?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Cezar is entitled to the patent because he was the real
inventor. Francis, copying from the work of Cezar, cannot
claim the essential criteria of an inventor, who must possess
essential elements of novelty, originality and precedence to
be entitled to protection. Nevertheless, under the "first to
file rule," Francis application would have to be given
priority. Cezar, however, has within three months from the
decision, to have it cancelled as the rightful inventor; or
within one year from publication, to file an action to prove
his priority to the invention, which has been taken from him
and fraudulently registered by Francis.
3) Supposing Joab got wind of the inventions of his
employees and also laid claim to the patents, asserting that
Cezar and Francis were using his materials and company
time in making the devices, will his claim prevail over those
of his employees? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, Joab's claim cannot prevail over those of his
employees. In the first place, Joab did not commission any
of the two employees to invent the device, and its
Page 62 of 103 invention did not fall within their regular
duties. What prevails is the provision of the Intellectual
Property Code that holds that the invention belongs to the
employee, if the inventive activity is not a part of his
regular duties, even if he uses the time, facilities and
materials of the employer.
Patents: Infringement; Remedies & Defenses (1993)
Ferdie is a patent owner of a certain invention. He
discovered that his invention is being infringed by Johann.
1) What are the remedies available to Ferdie against
Johann? 2) If you were the lawyer of Johann in the
infringement suit, what are the defenses that your client
can assert?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) The following remedies are available to Ferdie against
2) These are the defenses that can be asserted in
an infringement suit:
Patent is invalid (Sec 45 RA 165, as
amended)
Patent is not new or patentable
Specification of the invention does not
comply with Sec 14
Patent was issued not to the true and
actual inventor, designer or author of the utility
model or the plaintiff did not derive his rights
from the true and actual inventor, designer or
author of the utility model (Sec 28 RA 165 as
amended)
Patents; Infringement (1992)
In an action for infringement of patent, the alleged
infringer defended himself by stating 1) that the patent
issued by the Patent Office was not really an invention
which was patentable; 2) that he had no intent to infringe
so that there was no actionable case for infringement; and
3) that there was no exact duplication of the patentees
existing patent but only a minor improvement. With those
defenses, would you exempt the alleged violator from
liability? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
I would not exempt the alleged violator from liability for
the following reasons: 1) A patent once issued by the
Patent Office raises a
presumption that the article is patentable; it can,
however be shown otherwise (Sec 45 RA 165). A mere
statement or allegation is not enough to destroy that
presumption. (Aquas v de Leon 30 Jan 82 L32160)
2) An intention to infringe is not necessary nor an
element in a case for infringement of a patent.
1
)
Can A now bring an action in the name of the
corporation to question the issuance of the shares
to X without receiving any payment?
2
)
Can X question the right of A to sue him in behalf
of the corporation on the ground that A has only
one share in his name?
3
)
Cannot the shares issued to X be considered as
watered stock?
1
)
when justified by definite corporate expansion
projects or programs approved by the BOD; or
2
)
when the corporation is prohibited under any loan
agreement with any financial institution or creditor,
whether local or foreign, from declaring dividends
without its or his consent, and such consent has not
yet been secured; or
3
)
when it can be clearly shown that such retention is
necessary under special circumstances obtaining in
the corporation, such as when there is need for
special reserve for probable contingencies.
a
.
Page 60 of 103 to print, reprint, publish, copy,
distribute, multiply, sell and make photographs,
photo engravings, and pictorial illustrations of the
works;
b
.
to make any translation or other version or extracts
or arrangements or adaptation thereof; to dramatize
if it be a non-dramatic work; to convert it into a
non-dramatic work if it be a drama; to complete or
execute it if it be a model or design;
c
.
to exhibit, perform, represent, produce or
reproduce the work in any manner or by any
method whatever for profit or otherwise; if not
reproduced in copies for sale, to sell any
manuscripts or any record whatsoever thereof;
d
.
to make any other use or disposition of the work
consistent with the laws of the land
Johann.
a. seize and destroy
b. injunction
c.
damages in such amount may have
bee
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
3) There is no need of exact duplication of the
patentees existing patent such as when the improvement
made by another is merely minor (Frank v Benito, 51p713). To
be independently patentable, an improvement of an existing
patented invention must be a major improvement (Aquas v de
Leon L-32160 30Jan82)
Patents; Rights over the Invention (1990)
Cheche invented a device that can convert rainwater into
automobile fuel. She asked Macon, a lawyer, to assist in
getting her invention patented. Macon suggested that they
form a corporation with other friends and have the
corporation apply for the patent, 80% of the shares of
stock thereof to be subscribed by Cheche and 5% by
Macon. The corporation was formed and the patent
application was filed. However, Cheche died 3 months
later of a heart attack.
Franco, the estranged husband of Cheche, contested the
application of the corporation and filed his own patent
application as the sole surviving heir of Cheche. Decide
the issue with reasons.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The estranged husband of Checke cannot successfully
contest the application. The right over inventions accrue
from the moment of creation and as a right it can lawfully
be assigned. Once the title thereto is vested in the
transferee, the latter has the right to apply for its
registration. The estranged husband of Cheche, if not
disqualified to inherit, merely would succeed to the interest
of Cheche.
Note: An examinee who answers on the basis of the issue of
validity of the transfer of patent as a valid consideration for
subscription of the shares of stocks should be given due credit.
Trademark (1990)
In 1988, the Food and Drug Administration approved the
labels submitted by Turbo Corporation for its new drug
brand name, Axilon. Turbo is now applying with the
Bureau of Patents, Trademarks and Technology Transfer
for the registration of said brand name. It was subsequently
confirmed that Accilonne is a generic term for a class of
anti-fungal drugs and is used as such by the medical
profession and the pharmaceutical industry, and that it is
used as a generic chemical name in various scientific and
professional publications. A competing drug manufacturer
asks you to contest the registration of the brand name
Axilon by Turbo. What will you advice be?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The application for registration by Turbo Corporation may
be contested. The Trademark Law would not allow the
registration of a trademark which, when applied to or used
in connection with his products, is merely descriptive or
deceptively misdescriptive of them. Confusion can result
from the use of Axilon as the generic product itself.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Medical drugs may be procured only upon prescription
made by a duly licensed physician. The possibility of
Page 63 of 103 deception could be rather remote. Since
it cannot really be said that physicians can be so easily
deceived by such trademark as Axilon, it may be hard to
expect an opposition thereto to succeed.
ANOTHER ANSWER:
The application for registration of Turbo Corporation may
be contested. The factual settings do not indicate that
there had been prior use for at least 2 months of the
trademark Axilon.
Trademark (1994)
Laberge, Inc., manufactures and markets after-shave lotion,
shaving cream, deodorant, talcum powder and toilet soap,
using the trademark PRUT, which is registered with the
Phil Patent Office. Laberge does not manufacture briefs
and underwear and these items are not specified in the
certificate of registration.
JG who manufactures briefs and underwear, wants to
know whether, under our laws, he can use and register the
trademark PRUTE for his merchandise. What is your
advice?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. The trademark registered in the name of Laberge Inc
covers only after-shave lotion, shaving cream, deodorant,
talcum powder and toilet soap. It does not cover briefs and
underwear.
The limit of the trademark is stated in the certificate issued
to Laberge Inc. It does not include briefs and underwear
which are different products protected by Larberges
trademark.
JG can register the trademark PRUTE to cover its briefs
and underwear (Faberge Inc v IAC 215 s 316)
Trademark, Test of Dominancy (1996)
What is the test of dominancy?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The test of dominancy requires that if the competing
trademark contains the main or essential features of
another and confusion and deception is likely to result,
infringement takes place. Duplication or imitation is not
necessary; not is it necessary that the infringing label
should suggest an effort to imitate. Similarity in size, form
and color, while relevant, is not conclusive. (Asia Brewery v
CA GR 103543 Jul5,93 224s437)
Trademark; Infringement (1991)
Sony is a registered trademark for TV, stereo, radio,
cameras, betamax and other electronic products. A local
company, Best Manufacturing Inc produced electric fans
which it sold under the trademark Sony without the
consent of Sony. Sony sued Best Manufacturing for
infringement. Decide the case.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
There is no infringement. In order that a case for
infringement of trademark can prosper, the products on
which the trademark is used must be of the same kind. The
electric fans produced by Best Manufacturing cannot
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
be said to be similar to such products as TV, stereo and
radio sets or cameras or betamax products of Sony.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
There is infringement. If the owner of a trademark which
manufactures certain types of goods could reasonably be
expected to engage in the manufacture of another product
using the same trademark, another party who uses the
trademark for that product can be held liable for using that
trademark. Using this standard, infringement exists because
Sony can be reasonably expected to use such trademark on
electric fans.
Trademark; Test of Dominancy (1996)
N Corporation manufactures rubber shoes under the
trademark Jordann which hit the Phil market in 1985,
and registered its trademark with the Bureau of Patents,
Trademarks and Technology (BPTTT) in 1990. PK
Company also manufactures rubber shoes with the
trademark Javorski which it registered with BPTTT in
1978.
In 1992, PK Co adopted and copied the design of N
Corporations Jordann rubber shoes, both as to shape
and color, but retained the trademark Javorski on its
products.
May PK Company be held liable to N Co? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
PK Co may be liable for unfairly competing against N Co.
By copying the design, shape and color of N Corporations
Jordann rubber shoes and using the same in its rubber
shoes trademarked Javorski, PK is obviously trying to
pass off its shoes for those of N. It is of no moment that
he trademark Javorski was registered ahead of the
trademark Jordann. Priority in registration is not material
in an action for unfair competition as distinguished from an
action for infringement of trademark. The basis of an
action for unfair competition is confusing and misleading
similarity in general appearance, not similarity of
trademarks
(Converse Rubber Co v Jacinto Rubber & Plastics Co GR 27425 and
30505, Apr28,80 97s158)
Tradename: International Affiliation (2005)
S Development Corporation sued Shangrila Corporation for
using the S logo and the tradename Shangrila. The
former claims that it was the first to register the logo and the
tradename in the Philippines and that it had been using the
same in its restaurant business. Shangrila Corporation
counters that it is an affiliate of an international organization
which has been using such logo and tradename Shangrila
for over 20 years. However, Shangrila Corporation registered
the tradename and logo in the Philippines only after the suit
was filed.
Which of the two corporations has a better right to use
the logo and the tradename? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
S Development Corporation has a better right to use the
logo and the tradename, since the protective benefits of
Page 64 of 103
the law are conferred by the fact of registration and not by
use. Although Shangrila Corporation's parent had used the
tradename and logo long before, the protection of the laws
will be for S Development Corporation because it was the
first entity to register the intellectual properties.
How does the international affiliation of Shangrila
Corporation affect the outcome of the dispute?
Explain. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The international affiliation of Shangrila Corporation may
be critical in the event that its affiliates or parent company
abroad had registered in a foreign jurisdiction the
tradename and the logo. A well-known mark and
tradename is subject to protection under Treaty of Paris
for the Protection of Intellectual Property to which the
Philippines is a member.
Insolvency & Corporate
Recovery
Insolvency vs. Suspension of Payment (1998)
Distinguish insolvency from suspension of payments. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) In insolvency, the liabilities of the debtor are
more than his assets, while in suspension of payments,
assets of the debtor are more than his liabilities.
b) In insolvency, the assets of the debtor are to be
converted into cash for distribution among his creditors,
while in suspension of payments, the debtor is only asking
for time within which to convert his frozen assets into
liquid cash with which to pay his obligations when the
latter fall due.
Insolvency: Voluntary Insolvency (2005)
Aaron, a well-known architect, is suffering from financial
reverses. He has four creditors with a total claim of P26
Million. Despite his intention to pay these obligations, his
current assets are insufficient to cover all of them. His
creditors are about to sue him. Consequently, he was
constrained to file a petition for insolvency. (5%) a) Since
Aaron was merely forced by circumstances to
petition the court to declare him insolvent, can the
judge properly treat the petition as one for involuntary
insolvency? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. This is a case for voluntary insolvency because this
was filed by an insolvent debtor owing debts exceeding the
amount of P1,000.00 under Section 14 of the Insolvency
Law. Under Section 20 of the Insolvency Law, the petition
must be filed by three or more creditors. In the case at bar,
it is Aaron, the debtor, who filed the insolvency
proceedings.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
b) If Aaron is declared an insolvent by the court,
what would be the effect, if any, of such declaration on his
creditors? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A declaration by the court that the petitioner is insolvent
will have the following effects:
1) The sheriff shall take possession of all assets
of the debtor until the appointment of a receiver or
assignee;
2) Payment to the debtor of any debts due to
him and the delivery to the debtor of any property
belonging to him, and the transfer of any property by
him are forbidden;
3) All civil proceedings pending against the
insolvent shall be stayed; and
4) Mortgages and pledges are not affected by
the order declaring a person insolvent. (Sec. 59,
Insolvency Law)
c) Assuming that, Aaron has guarantors for his
debts, are the guarantors released from their obligations
once Aaron is discharged from his debts? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, precisely under the principle of excussion, the liability
of the guarantors arises only after the exhaustion of the
assets of the principal obligor. The effect of discharge
merely confirms exhaustion of the assets of the obligor
available to his creditors.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Yes. Article 2076 of the Civil Code provides: The
obligation of the guarantor is extinguished at the same time
as that of the debtor, and for the same causes as all other
obligations.
d) What remedies are available to the guarantors in
case they are made to pay the creditors? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Under Article 2081, the guarantor may set up against the
creditor all the defenses that pertain to the principal
debtor. The discharge obtained by Aaron on the principal
obligation can now be used as a defense by the guarantors
against the creditors. The guarantors are also entitled to
indemnity under Article 2066 of the Civil Code.
Insolvency; Assets vs. Liabilities (1998)
Horacio opened a coffee shop using money borrowed
from financial institutions. After 3 months, Horacio left
for the US with the intent of defrauding his creditors.
While his liabilities are worth P1.2m, his assets, however
are worth P1.5m. May Horacio be declared insolvent?
(2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. Horacio may not be declared insolvent. His assets
worth P1.5m are more than his liabilities worth P1.2m.
Insolvency; Assignees (1996)
On June 16, 1995, Vicente obtained a writ of preliminary
attachment against Carlito. The levy on Carlitos property
occurred on June 25, 1995. On July 29, 1995, another
creditor filed a petition for involuntary insolvency against
Carlito. The insolvency court gave due course to the
Page 65 of 103
petition. In the meantime, the case filed by Vicente
proceeded and resulted in a judgment award in favor of
Vicente. May the judgment obtained by Vicente be
enforced independently of the insolvency proceedings?
Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The judgment obtained by Vicente can be enforced
independently of the insolvency proceedings. Under Sec 32
of the Insolvency Law, the assignment to the assignee of
all the real and personal property, estate and effects of the
debtor made by the clerk of the court shall vacate and set
aside any judgment entered in any action commenced with
30 days immediately prior to the commencement of
insolvency proceedings. In this case, however, the action
filed by Vicente against Carlito was commenced by Vicente
not later than June 16, 1995 (the facts on this point are not
clear) when Vicente obtained a writ of preliminary
attachment against Carlito or more than 30 days before the
petition for involuntary insolvency was filed against Carlito
by his other creditors. (i.e. on July 29, 1995) (Radiola-Toshiba
Phil v IAC GR 75222 July18,91 199s373)
Insolvency; Effect; Declaration of Insolvency (1991)
What are the effects of a judgment in insolvency in
Voluntary Insolvency cases?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The adjudication or declaration of insolvency by the court,
after hearing or default, shall have the following effects: a)
Forbid the payment to the debtor of any debt due to
him and the delivery to him of any property
belonging to him; b) Forbid the transfer of any property
by him; and c) Stay of all civil proceedings against the
insolvent but
foreclosure may be allowed (Secs 18 & 24 Insolvency
Law)
Insolvency; Fraudulent Payment (2002)
As of June 1, 2002, Edzo Systems Corporation (Edzo) was
indebted to the following creditors: a) Ace Equipment
Supplies for various personal
computers and accessories sold to Edzo on credit
amounting to P300,000.
b) Handyman Garage for mechanical repairs
(parts and service) performed on Edzos company car
amounting to P10,000.
c) Joselyn Reyes former employee of Edzo who
sued Edzo for unlawful termination of employment and
was able to obtain a final judgment against Edzo for
P100,000.
d) Bureau of Internal Revenue for unpaid
value-added taxes amounting to P30,000.
e) Integrity Bank which granted Edzo a loan in
2001 in the amount of P500,000. The loan was not secured
by any asset of Edzo, but it was guaranteed unconditionally
and solidarily by Edzos President and controlling
stockholder, Eduardo Z. Ong, as accommodation surety.
The loan due to Integrity Bank fell due on June 15, 2002.
Despite pleas for extension of payment by Edzo, the
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
bank demanded immediate payment. Because the bank
threatened to proceed against the surety, Eduardo Z. Ong,
Edzo decided to pay up all its obligations to Integrity
Bank. On June 20, 2002, Edzo paid to Integrity Bank the
full principal amount of P500,000, plus accrued interests
amounting to P55,000. As a result, Edzo had hardly any
cash left for operations and decided to close its business.
After paying the unpaid salaries of its employees, Edzo
filed a petition for insolvency on July 1, 2002.
In the insolvency proceedings in court, the assignee in
insolvency sought to invalidate the payment made by Edzo
to Integrity Bank for being a fraudulent transfer because it
was made within 30 days before the filing of the insolvency
petition. In defense, Integrity Bank asserted that the
payment to it was for a legitimate debt that was not
covered by the prohibition because it was a valuable
pecuniary consideration made in good faith, thus falling
within the exception specified in the Insolvency Law. As
judge in the pending insolvency case, how would you
decide the respective contentions of the assignee in
insolvency and of Integrity Bank? Explain (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The contention of the assignee in insolvency is correct.
The payment made by Edzo to Integrity Bank was a
fraudulent preference or payment, being made within thirty
(30) days before the filing of the insolvency petition.
Insolvency; Jurisdiction; Sole Proprietorship (1990)
One day Jerry Haw, doing business under the name
Starlight Enterprise, a sole proprietorship, finds himself
short on cash and unable to pay his debts as they fall due
although he has sufficient property to cover such debts.
He asks you, as his retained counsel, for advice on the
following queries: a) Should he file a petition with the SEC
to be declared in a state of suspension of payments in view
of the said financial condition he faces? Explain your
answer. b) Should he sell profit participation certificates to
his 10 brothers and sisters in order to raise cash for his
business? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) I would counsel Jerry to file the Petition for Suspension
of Payment with the ordinary courts, rather than the SEC.
SECs jurisdiction over such cases is confined only to
petitions filed by corporations and partnerships under its
regulatory powers.
b) Instead of selling profit participation certificates, I
would urge Jerry to enter into a partnership or to
incorporate in order to raise cash for his business.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
b) Jerry may sell profit participation certificates to his
brothers and sisters without registering the same with the
SEC because his sale is an exempted transaction being
isolated and not a sale to the public.
Insolvency; obligations that survive (1997)
Page 66 of 103 An insolvent debtor, after lawful
discharge following an adjudication of insolvency, is
released from, generally, all debts, claims, liabilities and
demands which are or have been proved against his estate.
Give 5 obligations of the insolvent debtor to survive.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The 5 obligations of the insolvent debtor that survive are
as follows:
1 Taxes and assessments due the government,
national or local;
2 Obligations arising from embezzlement or fraud;
3 Obligation of any person liable with the insolvent
debtor for the same debt, either as a solidary codebtor,
surety, guarantor, partner, indorser or otherwise.
4 Alimony or claim for support; and
5 Debts not provable against the estate (such as
after-incurred obligations) of, or not included in the
schedule submitted by, the insolvent debtor.
Insolvency; Voluntary Insolvency Proceeding (1991)
Is the issuance of an order, declaring a petition in a
Voluntary Insolvency proceeding insolvent, mandatory
upon the court?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Assuming that the petition was in due form and substance
and that the assets of the petitioner are less than his
liabilities, the court must adjudicate the insolvency (Sec 18
Insolvency Law)
Insolvency; Voluntary vs. Involuntary Solvency (1995)
Distinguish between voluntary insolvency and involuntary
insolvency.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
In voluntary insolvency, it is the debtor himself who files
the petition for insolvency, while in involuntary insolvency,
at least 3 creditors are the ones who file the petition for
insolvency against the insolvent debtor.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
The following are the distinctions:
1 In involuntary insolvency, 3 or more creditors are
required, whereas in voluntary insolvency, one creditor may
be sufficient;
2 In involuntary insolvency, the creditors must be
residents of the Philippines, whose credits or demand
accrued in the Philippines, and none of the creditors has
become a creditor by assignment within 30 days prior to the
filing of the petition, whereas in voluntary insolvency, these
are not required.
3 In involuntary insolvency, the debtor must have
done any of the acts of insolvency as enumerated by Sec 20,
whereas in voluntary insolvency, the debtor must not have
done any of said acts.
4 In involuntary insolvency, the amount of
indebtedness must not be less than P1,000 whereas in
voluntary insolvency, it must exceed P1,000.
5 In involuntary insolvency, the petition must be
accompanied by a bond, whereas such is not required in
voluntary insolvency.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Law on Corporate Recovery (2003)
X Corporation applied for its rehabilitation and submitted a
rehabilitation plan which called for the entry by it into a
joint venture agreement with Y Corporation. Under the
agreement, Y Corporation was to lend to X Corporation its
credit facilities with certain banks to obtain funds not only
to operate X Corporation but also for a part thereof in the
amount of P1 million as initial deposit in a sinking fund to
be augmented annually in amounts equivalent to 10% of
the yearly income from its operation of the business of X
Corporation. From this fund the creditors of X
Corporation were to be paid annually, starting from the
second year of operations, with the entire indebtedness to
be liquidated in 15 years. The creditors of X Corporation
objected to the plan because Y Corporation would be
taking over the business and assets of X Corporation.
Could the court approve the plan despite the objections of
the creditors of X Corporation and could the creditors be
compelled to follow the plan? Could Y Corporation, in
managing the business of X Corporation in the meantime,
be deemed to have taken-over X Corporation itself? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Rehabilitation; Stay Order (2006)
The Blue Star Corporation filed with the Regional Trial Court
a petition for rehabilitation on the ground that it foresaw the
impossibility of paying its obligations as they fall due. Finding
the petition sufficient in form and substance, the court issued
an Order appointing a rehabilitation receiver and staying the
enforcement of all claims against the corporation.
What is the rationale for the Stay Order? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The purpose of the stay order is intended to give the
management committee or rehabilitation receiver the
leeway to make the business viable again, without having
to divert attention and resources to litigation in various
fora (Philippine Airlines v. Spouses Kurangking, et al, G.R. No. 146698,
September 24, 2002; BF Homes, Inc. v. Court of Appeals,
G.R. Nos. 76879 & 77143, October 3, 1990; Rubberworld [Phils.] Inc.
v. NLRC, G.R. No. 126773, April 14, 1999; Sobrejuanite v. ASB Dev.
Corp., G.R. No. 165675, September 30, 2005). It also prevents a
creditor from obtaining an advantage or preference over
another with respect to actions against the corporation
(Finasia Investments and Finance Corp v. Court of Appeals, G. R. No.
107002, October 7,1994).
Suspension of Payment vs. Insolvency (1995)
Distinguish between suspension of payments and
insolvency.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
In suspension of payments, the debtor is not insolvent. He
only needs time within which to convert his asset/s into
cash with which to pay his obligations when they fall due.
In the case of insolvency, the debtor is insolvent, that is,
his assets are less than his liabilities.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
The following are the distinctions:
Page 67 of 103
1 In suspension of payments, the debtor has
sufficient property to cover all his debts but foresees the
impossibility of meeting them when they respectively fall
due, whereas, in insolvency, the debtor does not have
sufficient property to pay all his debts in full;
2 In suspension of payments, the purpose is to
suspend or delay payment of debts which remain unaffected
although a postponement of payment is declared, whereas,
in insolvency, the object is to obtain discharge from all debts
and liability;
3 In suspension of payments, no limit for the
amount of indebtedness is required, whereas, in insolvency,
the debts must exceed P1,000 in case of voluntary
insolvency, or must not be less than P1,000 in case of
involuntary insolvency.
Suspension of Payments vs. Stay Order (2003)
Distinguish the stay order in corporate rehabilitation from
a declaration in a state of suspension of payments? (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Suspension of Payments; Rehabilitation Receiver (1999)
Debtor Corporation and its principal stockholders filed
with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) a
petition for rehabilitation and declaration of a state of
suspension of payments under PD 902-A. The objective
was for SEC to take control of the corporation and all its
assets and liabilities, earnings and operations, and to
determine the feasibility of continuing operations and
rehabilitating the company for the benefit of investors and
creditors.
Generally, the unsecured creditors had manifested
willingness to cooperate with Debtor Corporation. The
secured creditors, however, expressed serious objections
and reservations.
First Bank had already initiated judicial foreclosure
proceedings on the mortgage constituted on the factory of
Debtor Corporation.
Second Bank had already initiated foreclosure proceedings
on a third-party mortgage constituted on certain assets of
the principal stockholders.
Third Bank had already filed a suit against the principal
stockholders who had held themselves liable jointly and
severally for the loans of Debtor Corporation with said
Bank.
After hearing, the SEC directed the appointment of a
rehabilitation receiver and ordered the suspension of all
actions and claims against the Debtor corporation as well
as against the principal stockholders. a) Discuss the
validity of the SEC order or suspension?
(2%)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
b) Discuss the effects of the SEC order of
suspension on the judicial foreclosure proceedings
initiated by First Bank. (2%)
c) Would the order of suspension have any effect on
the foreclosure proceedings initiated by Second Bank?
Explain (2%)
d) Would the order of suspension have any effect
on the suit filed by Third Bank? Explain. (2%)
e) What are the legal consequences of a
rehabilitation receivership? (2%)
f) What measures may the receiver take to preserve
the assets of Debtor Corporation? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a. The SEC order of suspension of payment is valid with
respect to the debtor corporation, but not with respect to
the principal stockholders. The SEC has jurisdiction to
declare suspension of payments with respect to
corporations, partnership or associations, but not with
respect to individuals.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
b. The SEC order of suspension of payment suspended the
judicial proceedings initiated by the First Bank. According
to the Supreme Court in a line of cases, the suspension
order applies to secured creditors and to the action to
enforce the security against the corporation regardless of
the stage thereof.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
c. The order of suspension of payments suspended the
foreclosure proceedings initiated by the Second Bank.
While the foreclosure is against the property of a third
party, it is in reality an action to collect the principal
obligation owned by the corporation. During the time that
the payment of the principal obligation is suspended, the
debtor corporation is considered to be not in default and,
therefore, even the right to enforce the security, whether
owned by the debtor-corporation or of a third party, has
not yet arisen.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
c. The suspension order does not apply to a third party
mortgage because in such a case, the credit is not yet being
enforced against the corporation but against the third
party mortgagors property.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
d. For the same reason as in (c), the order of suspension of
payments suspended the suit filed by Third Bank against
the principal stockholders.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
d. The action against the principal stockholders surety in
favor of the corporation is not suspended as it is not an
action against the corporation but against the stockholders
whose personality is separate from that of the corporation.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
e. Under PD 902A, the appointment of a rehabilitation
receiver will suspend all actions for claims against the
corporation and the corporation will be placed under
Page 68 of 103
rehabilitation in accordance with a rehabilitation plan
approved by the SEC.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
f. To preserve the assets of the Debtor Corporation, the
receiver may take custody of, and control over, all the
existing assets and property of the corporation; evaluate
existing assets and liabilities, earnings and operations of
the corporation; and determine the best way to salvage
and protect the interest of the investors and creditors.
Suspension of Payments; Remedies (2003)
When is the remedy of declaration in a state of suspension
of payments available to a corporation?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
(per dondee) This remedy is available to a corporation
when it experiences inability to pay one's debts and
liabilities, and where the petitioning corporation either:
1 has sufficient property to cover all its debts but
foresees the impossibility of meeting them when they fall
due (solvent but illiquid) or
2 has no sufficient property (insolvent) but is under
the management of a rehabilitation receiver or a
management committee, the applicable law is P.D. No.
902-A pursuant to Sec. 5 par.
Letters of Credit
Letter of Credit: Mortgage (2005)
Ricardo mortgaged his fishpond to AC Bank to secure a
P1 Million loan. In a separate transaction, he opened a
letter of credit with the same bank for $500,000.00 in
favor of HS Bank, a foreign bank, to purchase outboard
motors. Likewise, Ricardo executed a Surety Agreement in
favor of AC Bank.
The outboard motors arrived and were delivered to
Ricardo, but he was not able to pay the purchase price
thereof. a) Can AC Bank take possession of the outboard
motors? Why? b) Can AC Bank also foreclose the
mortgage over the fishpond? Explain. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) No, for AC Bank has no legal standing, much less
a lien, on the outboard motors. Insofar as AC Bank is
concerned, it has privity with the person of Ricardo under
the Surety Agreement, and a lien on the fishpond based on
the real estate mortgage constituted therein.
b) Yes, but only to enforce payment of the principal
loan of P1million secured by the real estate mortgage on
the fishpond
Letter of Credit; Certification from Consignee (1993)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
BV agreed to sell to AC, a Ship and Merchandise Broker,
2,500 cubic meters of logs at $27 per cubic meter FOB.
After inspecting the logs, CD issued a purchase order.
On the arrangements made upon instruction of the
consignee, H&T Corporation of LA, California, the SP
Bank of LA issued an irrevocable letter of credit available
at sight in favor of BV for the total purchase price of the
logs. The letter of credit was mailed to FE Bank with the
instruction to forward it to the beneficiary. The letter of
credit provided that the draft to be drawn is on SP Bank
and that it be accompanied by, among other things, a
certification from AC, stating that the logs have been
approved prior shipment in accordance with the terms and
conditions of the purchase order.
Before loading on the vessel chartered by AC, the logs were
inspected by custom inspectors and representatives of the
Bureau of Forestry, who certified to the good condition and
exportability of the logs. After the loading was completed,
the Chief Mate of the vessel issued a mate receipt of the
cargo which stated that the logs are in good condition.
However, AC refused to issue the required certification in
the letter of credit. Because of the absence of certification,
FE Bank refused to advance payment on the letter of credit.
1) May Fe Bank be held liable under the letter of credit?
Explain. 2) Under the facts above, the seller, BV, argued
that FE Bank, by accepting the obligation to notify him that
the irrevocable letter of credit has been transmitted to it on
his behalf, has confirmed the letter of credit. Consequently,
FE Bank is liable under the letter of credit. Is the argument
tenable? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) No. The letter of credit provides as a condition a
certification of AC. Without such certification, there is no
obligation on the part of FE Bank to advance payment of
the letter of credit. (Feati Bank v CA 196 S 576)
2) No. FE Bank may have confirmed the letter of credit
when it notified BV, that an irrevocable letter of credit has
been transmitted to it on its behalf. But the conditions in
the letter of credit must first be complied with, namely that
the draft be accompanied by a certification from AC.
Further, confirmation of a letter of credit must be
expressed. (Feati Bank v CA 196 s 576)
Letters of Credit; Liability of a confirming and notifying
bank (1994)
In letters of credit in banking transactions, distinguish the
liability of a confirming bank from a notifying bank.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
In case anything wrong happens to the letter of credit, a
confirming bank incurs liability for the amount of the
letter of credit, while a notifying bank does not incur any
liability.
Letters of Credit; Liability of a Notifying Bank (2003)
a) What liability, if any is incurred by an advising or
notifying bank in a letter of credit transaction?
Page 69 of 103
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
It incurs no liability unless it is also the negotiating bank
b) Bravo Bank received from Cisco Bank by
registered mail an irrevocable letter of credit issued by
Delta Bank for the account of Y Company in the amount
of US$10,000,000 to cover the sale of canned fruit juices.
The beneficiary of the letter of credit was X Corporation
which later on partially availed itself of the letter of credit
by submitting to Bravo Bank all documents relative to the
shipment of the cans of fruit juices. Bravo Bank paid X
Corporation for its partial availment. Later, however, it
refused further availment because of suspicions of fraud
being practiced upon it and, instead , sued X Corporation
to recover what it had paid the latter. How would you rule
if you were the judge to decide the controversy? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Letters of Credit; Three Distinct Contract Relationships
(2002)
Explain the three (3) distinct but intertwined contract
relationships that are indispensable in a letter of credit
transaction.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The three (3) distinct but intertwined contract
relationships that are indispensable in a letter of credit
transaction are:
1) Between the applicant/buyer/importer and the
beneficiary/seller/exporter The applicant/buyer/importer is the
one who procures the letter of credit and obliges himself to
reimburse the issuing bank upon receipt of the documents of title,
while the beneficiary/seller/exporter is the one who in compliance
with the contract of sale ships the goods to the buyer and delivers
the documents of title and draft to the issuing bank to recover
payment for the goods. Their relationship is governed by the
contract of sale.
2) Between the issuing bank and the
beneficiary/seller/exporter The issuing bank is the one that
issues the letter of credit and undertakes to pay the seller
upon receipt of the draft and proper documents of title and
to surrender the documents to the buyer upon
reimbursement. Their relationship is governed by the terms of
the letter of credit issued by the bank.
3) Between the issuing bank and the
applicant/buyer/importer Their relationship is governed by
the terms of the application and agreement for the issuance of
the letter of credit by the bank.
Maritime Commerce
Average; Particular Average vs. General Average (2003)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
M/V Ilog de Manila with a cargo of 500 tons of iron ore
left the Port of Zamboanga City bound for Manila. For
one reason or another, M/V Ilog de Manila hit a
submerged obstacle causing it to sink along with its cargo.
A salvor, Salvador, Inc., was contracted to refloat the
vessel for P1 Million. What kind of average was the
refloating fee of P1 million, and for whose account should
it be? Why? (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Particular Average. The owner of the vessel shall shoulder
the average. Generally speaking, simple or particular
averages include all expenses and damages caused to the
vessel or cargo which have not inured to the common
benefit (Art. 809, and are, therefore, to be borne only by
the owner of the property which gave rise to the same (Art.
810) while general or gross averages include "all the
damages and expenses which are deliberately caused in
order to save the vessel, its cargo, or both at the same time,
from a real and known risk" (Art. 811). Being for the
common benefit, gross averages are to be borne by the
owners of the articles saved (Art. 812). In the present case
there is no proof that the vessel had to be put afloat to save
it from an imminent danger.
Bottomry (1994)
Gigi obtained a loan from Jojo Corporation, payable in
installments. Gigi executed a chattel mortgage in favor of
Jojo whereby she transferred in favor of Jojo, its
successors and assigns, all her title, rights ... to a vessel of
which Gigi is the absolute owner. The chattel mortgage
was registered with the Philippine Coast Guard pursuant to
PD 1521. Gigi defaulted and had a total accountability of
P3M. But Jojo could not foreclose the mortgage on the
vessel because it sank during a typhoon. Meanwhile,
Lutang Corporation which rendered salvage services for
refloating the vessel sued Gigi. Whose lien should be given
preference, that of Jojo or Lutang?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Lutang Corporations lien should be given preference. The
lien of Jojo by virtue of a loan of bottomry was
extinguished when the vessel sank. Under such loan on
bottomry Jojo acted not only as creditor but also as
insurer. Jojos right to recover the amount of the loan is
predicated on the safe arrival of the vessel at the port of
destination. The right was lost when the vessel sank (Sec
17 PD 1521)
Carriage of Goods: Deviation: Liability (2005)
On a clear weather, M/V Sundo, carrying insured cargo,
left the port of Manila bound for Cebu. While at sea, the
vessel encountered a strong typhoon forcing the captain to
steer the vessel to the nearest island where it stayed for
seven days. The vessel ran out of provisions for its
passengers. Consequently, the vessel proceeded to Leyte to
replenish its supplies.
Assuming that the cargo was damaged because of such
deviation, who between the insurance company and the
owner of the cargo bears the loss? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Page 70 of 103 The insurance company should bear the
loss to the cargo because the deviation of the vessel was
proper in order to avoid a peril, which was the strong
typhoon. The running out of provisions was a direct
consequence of the proper deviation in order to avoid the
peril of the typhoon.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
The owner of the cargo bears the loss because in the case
at bar, they stayed too long at the island, making it an
improper deviation. Every deviation not specified in Sec.
124 is improper. (Sec. 125, Insurance Code)
Carriage of Goods; Deviation; When Proper (2005)
Under what circumstances can a vessel properly proceed
to a port other than its port of destination? Explain. (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Deviation is proper:
a) when caused by circumstances over which neither
the master nor the owner of the ship has any
control; b) when necessary to comply with a warranty or
avoid a
peril, whether or not the peril is insured against; c) when
made in good faith, and upon reasonable
grounds of belief in its necessity to avoid a peril; or d)
when in good faith, for the purpose of saving human
life, or relieving another vessel in distress. (Sec. 124,
Insurance Code)
Carriage of Goods; Exercise Extraordinary Diligence
(2005)
Star Shipping Lines accepted 100 cartons of sardines from
Master to be delivered to 555 Company in Manila. Only 88
cartons were delivered, however, these were in bad
condition. 555 Company claimed from Star Shipping Lines
the value of the missing goods, as well as the damaged
goods. Star Shipping Lines refused because the former
failed to present a bill of lading. Resolve with reasons the
claim of 555 Company. (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The claim of 555 Company is meritorious, even if it fails to
present a bill of lading. Although a bill of lading is the best
evidence of the contract of carriage for cargo, nevertheless
such contract can exist even without a bill of lading. Like
any other contract, a contract of carriage is a meeting of
minds that gives rise to an obligation on the part of the
carrier to transport the goods. Jurisprudence has held that
the moment the carrier receives the cargo for transport,
then its duty to exercise extraordinary diligence arises. (Cia.
Maritima v. Insurance Co. of North America,
G.R. No. L-18965, October 30, 1964; Negre v. Cabahug Shipping &
Co., G.R. No. L-19609, April 29, 1966)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Star Shipping Lines can refuse to honor 555 Company's
claim for the missing and damaged goods. The Bill of
Lading is the document of title that legally establishes the
ownership of 555 Company over said goods. 555 needs to
present the Bill of Lading to legally claim said goods.
(National Union Fire Insurance of Pittsburg v. Stolt-Nielaen, G.R. No.
87958, April 26, 1990)
Charter Party (1991)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
The Saad Dev Co enters into a voyage charter with XYZ
over the latters vessel, the MV LadyLove. Before the Saad
could load it, XYZ sold Lady Love to Oslob Maritime Co
which decided to load it for its own account. a) May XYZ
Shipping Co validly ask for the rescission of the charter
party? If so, can Saad recover damages? To what extent? b)
If Oslob did not load it for its own account, is it bound by
the charter party? c) Explain the meaning of owner pro
hac vice of the vessel. In what kind of charter party does
this obtain?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) XYZ may ask for the rescission of the charter party if,
as in this case, it sold the vessel before the charterer has
begun to load the vessel and the purchaser loads it for his
own account. Saad may recover damages to the extent of
its losses (Art 689 Code of Commerce)
b) If Oslob did not load Lady Love for its own account, it
would be bound by the charter party, but XYZ would
have to indemnify Oslob if it was not informed of the
Charter Party at the time of sale. (Art 689 Code of
Commerce)
c) The term Owner Pro Hac Vice of the Vessel, is
generally understood to be the charterer of the vessel in
the case of bareboat or demise charter (Litonjua Shipping Co v
National Seamens Board GR 51910 10Aug1989)
Charter Party (2004)
Under a charter party, XXO Trading Company shipped
sugar to Coca-Cola Company through SS Negros Shipping
Corp., insured by Capitol Insurance Company. The cargo
arrived but with shortages. Coca-Cola demanded from
Capitol Insurance Co. P500.000 in settlement for XXO
Trading. The MM Regional Trial Court, where the civil suit
was filed, "absolved the insurance company, declaring that
under the Code of Commerce, the shipping agent is civilly
liable for damages in favor of third persons due to the
conduct of the carrier's captain, and the stipulation in the
charter party exempting the owner from liability is not
against public policy. Coca-Cola appealed. Will its appeal
prosper? Reason briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The appeal of Coca-Cola will not prosper. Under
Article 587 of the Code of Commerce, the shipping agent
is civilly liable for damages in favor of third persons due to
the conduct of the carrier's captain, and the shipping agent
can exempt himself therefrom only by abandoning the
vessel with all his equipment and the freight he may have
earned during the voyage. On the other hand, assuming
there is bareboat charter, the stipulation in the charter
party exempting the owner from liability is not against
public policy because the public at large is not involved
(Home Insurance Co. v. American Steamship Agencies, Inc., 23 SCRA25
(1968).
COGSA: Prescription of Claims/Actions (2004)
Page 71 of 103 AA entered into a contract with BB thru
CC to transport ladies' wear from Manila to France with
transhipment at Taiwan. Somehow the goods were not
loaded at Taiwan on time. Hence, when the goods arrived
in France, they arrived "off-season" and AA was paid only
for one-half the value by the buyer. AA claimed damages
from the shipping company and its agent. The defense of
the respondents was prescription. Considering that the
ladies' wear suffered "loss of value," as claimed by AA,
should the prescriptive period be one year under the
Carriage of Goods by Sea Act, or ten years under the Civil
Code? Explain briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The applicable prescriptive period is ten years under the
Civil Code. The one-year prescriptive period under the
Carriage of Goods by Sea Act applies in cases of loss or
damages to the cargo. The term "loss" as interpreted by
the Supreme Court in Mitsui O.S.K. Lines Ltd. v. Court of Appeals,
287 SCRA 366 (1998), contemplates a situation where no
delivery at all was made by the carrier of the goods because
the same had perished or gone out of commerce
deteriorated or decayed while in transit. In the present
case, the shipment of ladies' wear was actually delivered.
The "loss of value" is not the total loss contemplated by
the Carriage of Goods by Sea Act.
COGSA; Prescription of Claims (1992)
A local consignee sought to enforce judicially a claim
against the carrier for loss of a shipment of drums of
lubricating oil from Japan under the Carriage of Goods by
Sea Act (COGSA) after the carrier had rejected its demand.
The carrier pleaded in its Answer the affirmative defense of
prescription under the provisions of said Act inasmuch as
the suit was brought by the consignee after one (1) year
from the delivery of the goods. In turn, the consignee
contended that the period of prescription was suspended
by the written extrajudicial demand it had made against the
carrier within the one-year period, pursuant to Article 1155
of the Civil Code providing that the prescription of actions
is interrupted when there is a written extrajudicial demand
by the creditors. a) Has the action in fact prescribed? Why?
b) If the consignees action were predicated on misdelivery
or conversion of the goods, would your answer be the
same? Explain briefly.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) The action taken by the local consignee has, in fact,
prescribed. The period of one year under the Carriage of
Goods by Sea Act (COGSA) is not interrupted by a written
extrajudicial demand. The provisions of Art 1155 of the
NCC merely apply to prescriptive periods provided for in
said Code and not to special laws such as COGSA except
when otherwise provided. (Dole v Maritime Co 148 s 118).
b) If the consignees action were predicated on
misdelivery or conversion of goods, the provisions of the
COGSA would be inapplicable. In these cases, the NCC
prescriptive periods, including Art 1155 of the NCC will
apply (Ang v Compania Maritama 133 s 600)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 72 of 103
COGSA; Prescription of Claims (2000)
RC imported computer motherboards from the United
States and had them shipped to Manila aboard an ocean-
going cargo ship owned by BC Shipping Company. When
the cargo arrived at Manila seaport and delivered to RC,
the crate appeared intact; but upon inspection of the
contents, RC discovered that the items inside had all been
badly damaged. He did not file any notice of damage or
anything with anyone, least of all with BC Shipping
Company. What he did was to proceed directly to your
office to consult you about whether he should have given a
notice of damage and how long a time he had to initiate a
suit under the provisions of the Carriage of Goods by Sea
Act (CA 65). What would your advice be? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
My advice would be that RC should give notice of the
damage sustained by the cargo within 3 days and that he
has to file the suit to recover the damage sustained by the
cargo within one year from the date of the delivery of the
cargo to him.
COGSA; Prescriptive Period (1995)
What is the prescriptive period for actions involving lost
or damaged cargo under the Carriage of Goods by Sea
Act?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
ONE YEAR after the delivery of the goods or the date
when the goods should have been delivered (Sec 3(6),
COGSA)
Doctrine of Inscrutable Fault (1995)
1. 2 vessels coming from the opposite directions collided with
each other due to fault imputable to both. What are the
liabilities of the two vessels with respect to the damage
caused to them and their cargoes? Explain.
2. If it cannot be determined which of the two vessels was at
fault resulting in the collision, which party should bear the
damage caused to the vessels and the cargoes? Explain.
3. Which party should bear the damage to the vessels and the
cargoes if the cause of the collision was a fortuitous event?
Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. Each vessel must bear its own damage. Both of them were
at fault. (Art 827, Code of Commerce)
2. Each of them should bear their respective damages. Since
it cannot be determined as to which vessel is at fault. This is
the doctrine of inscrutable fault.
3. No party shall be held liable since the cause of the collision
is fortuitous event. The carrier is not an insurer.
Doctrine of Inscrutable Fault (1997)
Explain the doctrine in Maritime accidents Doctrine of
Inscrutable Fault
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Under the doctrine of inscrutable fault, where fault is
established but it cannot be determined which of the two
vessels were at fault, both shall be deemed to have been at
fault.
Doctrine of Inscrutable Fault (1998)
A severe typhoon was raging when the vessel SS Masdaam
collided with MV Princes. It is conceded that the typhoon
was the major cause of the collision, although there was a
very strong possibility that it could have been avoided if
the captain of SS Masdaam was not drunk and the captain
of the MV Princes was not asleep at the time of collisions.
Who should bear the damages to the vessels and their
cargoes? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The shipowners of SS Masdaam and MV Princess shall
each bear their respective loss of vessels. For the losses
and damages suffered by their cargoes both shipowners
are solidarily liable.
Limited Liability Rule (1994)
Toni, a copra dealer, loaded 1000 sacks of copra on board
the vessel MV Tonichi (a common carrier engaged in
coastwise trade owned by Ichi) for shipment from Puerto
Galera to Manila. The cargo did not reach Manila because
the vessel capsized and sank with all its cargo.
When Toni sued Ichi for damages based on breach of
contract, the latter invoked the limited liability rule. 1)
What do you understand of the rule invoked by Ichi? 2)
Are there exceptions to the limited liability rule?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) By limited liability rule is meant that the liability of a
shipowner for damages in case of loss is limited to the
value of the vessel involved. His other properties cannot
be reached by the parties entitled to damages.
2) Yes. When the ship owner of the vessel involved is
guilty of negligence, the limited liability rule does not
apply. In such case, the ship owner is liable to the full
extent of the damages sustained by the aggrieved parties
(Mecenas v CA 180 s 83)
Limited Liability Rule (1997)
Explain the doctrine in Maritime accidents The Doctrine
of Limited Liability
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Under the doctrine of limited liability the exclusively
real and hypothecary nature of maritime law operates to
limit the liability of the shipowner to the value of the
vessel, earned freightage and proceeds of the insurance.
However, such doctrine does not apply if the shipowner
and the captain are guilty of negligence.
Limited Liability Rule (1999)
Thinking that the impending typhoon was still 24 hours
away, MV Pioneer left port to sail for Leyte. That was a
miscalculation of the typhoon signals by both the ship-
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
owner and the captain as the typhoon came earlier and
overtook the vessel. The vessel sank and a number of
passengers disappeared with it.
Relatives of the missing passengers claimed damages
against the shipowner. The shipowner set up the defense
that under the doctrine of limited liability, his liability was
co-extensive with his interest in the vessel. As the vessel
was totally lost, his liability had also been extinguished.
. How will you advice the claimants? Discuss the
doctrine of limited liability in maritime law. (3%)
. Assuming that the vessel was insured, may the
claimants go after the insurance proceeds? (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
. Under the doctrine of limited liability in maritime law,
the liability of the shipowner arising from the operation of a ship
is confined to the vessel, equipment, and freight, or insurance, if
any, so that if the shipowner abandoned the ship, equipment, and
freight, his liability is extinguished. However, the doctrine of
limited liability does not apply when the shipowner or captain is
guilty of negligence.
. Yes. In case of a lost vessel, the claimants may go after
the proceeds of the insurance covering the vessel.
Limited Liability Rule (2000)
MV Mariposa, one of five passenger ships owned by
Marina Navigation Co, sank off the coast of Mindoro while
en route to Iloilo City. More than 200 passengers perished
in the disaster. Evidence showed that the ship captain
ignored typhoon bulletins issued by Pag-asa during the
24-hour period immediately prior to the vessels departure
from Manila. The bulletins warned all types of sea crafts to
avoid the typhoons expected path near Mindoro. To make
matters worse, he took more load than was allowed for the
ships rated capacity. Sued for damages by the victims
surviving relatives, Marina Nav Co contended 1) that its
liability, if any, had been extinguished with the sinking of
MV Mariposa; and 2) that assuming it had not been so
extinguished, such liability should be limited to the loss of
the cargo. Are these contentions meritorious in the context
of applicable provisions of the Code of Commerce? (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. The contentions of Marina Nav Co are meritorious.
The captain of MV Mariposa is guilty of negligence in
ignoring the typhoon bulletins issued by PAGASA and in
overloading the vessel. But only the captain of the vessel
MV Mariposa is guilty of negligence. The ship owner is
not. Therefore, the ship owner can invoke the doctrine of
limited liability.
Limited Liability Rule; Doctrine of Inscrutable Fault
(1991)
In a collision between M/T Manila, a tanker, and M/V
Don Claro, an inter-island vessel, Don Claro sank and
many of its passengers drowned and died. All its cargoes
were lost. The collision occurred at nighttime but the sea
was calm, the weather fair and visibility was good. Prior to
the collision and while still 4 nautical miles apart, Don
Page 73 of 103 Claro already sighted Manila on its radar
screen. Manila had no radar equipment. As for speed,
Don Claro was twice as fast as Manila.
At the time of the collision, Manila failed to follow Rule
19 of the International Rules of the Road which requires 2
vessels meeting head on to change their course by each
vessel steering to starboard (right) so that each vessel may
pass on the port side (left) of the other. Manila signaled
that it would turn to the port side and steered accordingly,
thus resulting in the collision. Don Claros captain was
off-duty and was having a drink at the ships bar at the
time of the collision. a) Who would you hold liable for the
collision? b) If Don Claro was at fault, may the heirs of the
passengers who died and the owners of the cargoes
recover damages from the owner of said vessel?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
I can hold the 2 vessels liable. In the problem given,
whether on the basis of the factual settings or under the
doctrine of inscrutable fault, both vessels can be said to
have been guilty of negligence. The liability of the 2
carriers for the death or injury of passengers and for the
loss of or damage to the goods arising from the collision is
solidary. Neither carrier may invoke the doctrine of last
clear chance which can only be relevant, if at all, between
the two vessels but not on the claims made by passengers
or shippers (Litonjua Shipping v National Seamen Board GR 51910
10Aug1989)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, but subject to the doctrine of limited liability. The
doctrine is to the effect that the liability of the shipowners
would only be to the extent of any remaining value of the
vessel, proceeds of insurance, if any, and earned freightage.
Given the factual settings, the shipowner himself was not
guilty of negligence and, therefore, the doctrine can well
apply (Amparo de los Santos v CA 186 s 69)
Limited Liability Rule; General Average Loss (2000)
X Shipping Company spent almost a fortune in refitting
and repairing its luxury passenger vessel, the MV Marina,
which plied the inter-island routes of the company from
La Union in the north to Davao City in the south. The
MV Marina met an untimely fate during its post-repair
voyage. It sank off the coast of Zambales while en route to
La Union from Manila. The investigation showed that the
captain alone was negligent. There were no casualties in
that disaster. Faced with a claim for the payment of the
refitting and repair, X Shipping company asserted
exemption from liability on the basis of the hypothecary or
limited liability rule under Article 587 of the Code of
Commerce. Is X Shipping Companys assertion valid?
Explain (3%).
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The assertion of X Shipping Company is not valid.
The total destruction of the vessel does not affect the
liability of the ship owner for repairs on the vessel
completed before its loss.
Limited Liability Rule; General Average Loss (2000)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
MV SuperFast, a passenger-cargo vessel owned by SF
Shipping Company plying the inter-island routes, was on its
way to Zamboanga City from the Manila port when it
accidentally, and without fault or negligence of anyone on
the ship, hit a huge floating object. The accident caused
damage to the vessel and loss of an accompanying crated
cargo of passenger PR. In order to lighten the vessel and
save it from sinking and in order to avoid risk of damage to
or loss of the rest of the shipped items (none of which was
located on the deck), some had to be jettisoned. SF
Shipping had the vessel repaired at its port of destination.
SF Shipping thereafter filed a complaint demanding all the
other cargo owners to share in the total repair costs
incurred by the company and in the value of the lost and
jettisoned cargoes. In answer to the complaint, the
shippers sole contention was that, under the Code of
Commerce, each damaged party should bear its or his own
damage and those that did not suffer any loss or damage
were not obligated to make any contribution in favor of
those who did. Is the shippers contention valid? Explain
(2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The shippers contention is not valid. The owners of
the cargo jettisoned, to save the vessel from sinking and to
save the rest of the cargoes, are entitled to contribution.
The jettisoning of said cargoes constitute general average
loss which entitles the owners thereof to contribution from
the owner of the vessel and also from the owners of the
cargoes saved.
SF Shipping is not entitled to contribution/ reimbursement
for the costs of repairs on the vessel from the shippers.
Nationalized Activities or
Undertakings
Nationalized Activities or Undertakings (1993)
1) A invested P500th in a security agency on October 30,
1990. He was charged with being a dummy of his friend, a
foreigner. If you were the prosecutor, what evidence can
you present to prove violation of the Anti-Dummy Law?
2) Juana de la Cruz, a common law wife of a foreigner
wrested the control of a television firm. At the instance of
the minority group of the firm, she was charged with
violation of the Anti-Dummy Law. May she be convicted
by the mere fact that she is a common law wife of a
foreigner? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) A allows or permits the use or exploitation or enjoyment
of a right, privilege or business, the exercise or enjoyment
of which is expressly reserved by the Constitution or the
laws to citizens of the Philippines, by the foreigner not
possessing the requisites prescribed by the Constitution or
the laws of the Philippines. The prosecutor should prove
the above elements of the crime
Page 74 of 103 and also the fact that A does not have
the means and resources to invest P500th in the security
agency.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
1) The prosecutor may establish the fact that the P500th
would constitute a major investment and yet A is not even
elected member of the BOD or one of the officers.
Furthermore, it may also be shown that A does not even
have the means to raise the amount of P500th and that the
officers or majority of the directors are foreigners.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
2) No. The mere fact of being a common law wife of a
foreigner does not bring her within the ambit of the
Anti-Dummy Law.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
2) Yes. Being a common law wife, it can be presumed that
she is the one running the business, which raises a prima
facie presumption of violation of the Anti-dummy Law,
(RA 6084).
Nationalized Activities or Undertakings (1994)
Celeste, a domestic corporation wholly owned by Filipino
citizens, is engaged in trading and operates as general
contractor. It buys and resells the products of Matilde, a
domestic corporation, 90% of whose capital stock is
owned by aliens. All of Matildes goods are made in the
Philippines from materials found or produced in the
Philippines. On the other hand, ECQ Integrated is a 100%
Filipino owned corporation and manufacturer of asbestos
products. Celeste and ECQ took part in a public bidding
conducted by MWSS for its asbestos pipe requirements.
Celeste won the bid, having offered 13% lower than that
offered by ECQ; and MWSS awarded the contract to
supply its asbestos pipes to Celeste. ECQ sought to nullify
the award in favor of Celeste.
1) Is Celeste barred under the Flag Law from taking part
in biddings to supply the government? 2) Did Celeste and
Matilde violate the Anti-Dummy Law? 3) Did Celeste and
Matilde violate the Retail Trade Nationalization Law?
Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) No. The materials offered in the bids submitted are
made in the Philippines from articles produced or grown
in the Philippines, and the bidder, Celeste, is a domestic
entity. The Flag Law does not apply. It can be invoked
only against a bidder who is not a domestic entity, or
against a domestic entity who offers imported materials.
2) No, since Celeste is merely a dealer of Matilde and not
an alter ego of the latter. Celeste buys and sells on its own
account the products of Matilde.
3) Matilde did not violate the Retail Trade Law since it
does not sell its products to consumers, but to dealers
who resell them. Neither did Celeste violate the Retail
Trade Law since, in the first place, it is not prohibited to
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
engage in retail trade. Besides, Matildes sale of the asbestos
products to Celeste, being wholesale, the transaction is not
covered by the Retail Trade Law
(Asbestos Integrated v Peralta 155 S 213)
Nationalized Activities or Undertakings (1995)
Global KL Malaysia, a 100% Malaysian owned corporation,
desires to build a hotel beach resort in Samal Island, Davao
City, to take advantage of the increased traffic of tourists
and boost the tourism industry of the Philippines.
1. Assuming that Global has US$100M to invest in a hotel
beach resort in the Philippines, may it be allowed to acquire
the land on which to build the resort? If so, under what
terms and conditions may Global acquire the land? Discuss
fully.
2. May Global be allowed to manage the hotel beach resort?
Explain.
3. May Global be allowed to operate restaurants within the
hotel beach resort? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. Global can secure a lease on the land. As a corporation
with a Malaysian nationality, Global cannot own the land.
2. Yes, Global can manage the hotel beach resort. There is no
law prohibiting it from managing the resort.
3. Global may be allowed to operate restaurants within the
beach resort. This is part of the operation of the resort.
Retail Trade Law (1990)
Acme Trading Co Inc, a trading company wholly owned by
foreign stockholders, was persuaded by Paulo Alva, a
Filipino, to invest in 20% of the outstanding shares of stock
of a corporation he is forming which will engage in the
department store business (the department store
corporation). Paulo also urged Acme to invest in 40% of
the outstanding shares of stock of the realty corporation he
is putting up to own the land on which the department
store will be built (the realty corporation). a) May Acme
invest in the said department store
corporation? Explain your answer. b) May Acme invest in
the realty corporation? Discuss. c) May the President of
Acme, a foreigner, sit in the
BOD of the said department store corporation? May
he be a director of the realty corporation? Discuss. d) May
the Treasurer of Acme, another foreigner,
occupy the same position in the said department
store corporation? May he be the treasurer of the
said realty corporation? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Acme may not invest in the department store
corporation since the Retail Trade Act allows, in the case
of corporations, only 100% Filipino owned companies to
engage in retail trade.
b) Acme may invest in the realty corporation, on the
assumption that the balance of 60% of ownership of the
latter corporation, is Filipino owned since the law merely
Page 75 of 103 requires 60% Filipino holding in land
corporate ownership.
c) The Anti-dummy Law allows board representation to
the extent of actual and permissible foreign investments in
corporations. Accordingly, the President of Acme may no
sit in the BOD of the department store corporation but
can do so in the realty corporation.
d) The Treasurer of Acme may not hold that position
either in the department store corporation or in the realty
corporation since the Anti-Dummy Law prohibits the
employment of aliens in such nationalized areas of
business except those that call for highly technical
qualifications.
Retail Trade Law (1991)
Is the Filipino common-law wife of a foreigner barred
from engaging in the retail business?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A Filipino common-law wife of a foreigner is not barred
from engaging in retail business. On the assumption that
she acts for and in her own behalf, and absent a violation
of the Anti-Dummy Law which prohibits a foreigner from
being either the real proprietor or an employee of a person
engaged in the retail trade, she would be violating the
Retail Trade Act.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
An engagement by a wife (including common-law
relationships) of a foreigner in the retail trade business,
raises the presumption that she has violated the
Anti-Dummy Law. Hence, the wife is barred from
engaging in the retail trade business.
Retail Trade Law (1992)
A Cooperative purchased from Y Co on installments a rice
mill and made a down payment therefore. As security for
the payment of the balance, the Cooperative executed a
chattel mortgage in favor of Y Corporation. Y Co in turn
assigned its rights to the chattel mortgage to Z Co a 5%
foreign owned company doing business in the Philippines.
The cooperative thereafter made installment payments to
Z Co.
Because the Cooperative was unable to meet its obligations
in full, Z Co filed against it a court suit for collection. The
Coop resisted contending that Z Co was illegally engaged in
the retail trade business for having sold a consumer good as
opposed to a producer item. The Coop also alleged that Z
had violated the Anti-Dummy Law. Is Z guilty of violating
the Retail Trade Law and the Anti-Dummy Law? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Z Co is not guilty of violating the Retail Trade Law and the
Anti-Dummy Law. The term RETAIL under the Retail
Trade Act requires that the seller must be habitually
engaged in selling to the general public consumption
goods. By consumption goods are meant personal, family
and household purposes. A Rice Mill
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
does not fall under the category. Neither does it appear
that Z is habitually engaged in selling to the general public
that commodity. Since there is no violation of the Retail
Trade Law, there would likewise by no violation of the
Anti-Dummy Law.
Retail Trade Law (1993)
A foreign firm is engaged in the business of manufacturing
and selling rubber products to dealers who in turn sell them
to others. It also sells directly to agricultural enterprises,
automotive assembly plants, public utilities which buy them
in large bulk, and to its officers and employees. 1) Is there
violation of the Retail Trade Law? Explain. 2) May said firm
operate a canteen inside the premises of its plant exclusively
for its officials and employees without violating the Retail
Trade Act? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) On the assumption that the foreign firm is doing
business in the Philippines, the sale to the dealers of
agricultural enterprises, automotive assembly plants, and
public utilities is wholesale and, therefore, not in violation
of the Retail Trade Act (BF Goodrich v Reyes 121 s 363)
2) Yes. The operation of the canteen inside the premises
exclusively for its officers and employees, would amount
to an input in the manufacturing process and, therefore,
does not violate the Retail Trade Act.
Retail Trade Law (1996)
With a capital of P2th Maria operates a stall at a public
market. She manufactures soap that she sells to the general
public. Her common law husband, MaLee, who has a
pending petition for naturalization, occasionally finances
the purchase of goods for resale, and assists in the
management of the business. Is there a violation of the
Retail Trade Law? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, there is no violation of the Retail Trade Law. Maria is
a manufacturer who sells to the general public, through her
stall in the public market, the soap which she
manufactures. Inasmuch as her capital does not exceed
P5th (it is only P2th) then she is considered under Sec 4a
of the Retail Trade Law as not engaged in the retail
business. Inasmuch as Marias business is not a retail
business, then the requirement in Sec 1 of the Retail
Trade Law that only Philippine nationals shall engage,
directly, or indirectly, in the retail business is inapplicable.
For this reason, the participation of Ma Lee, Marias
common Law husband, in the management of the business
would not be a violation of the Retail Trade Law in
relation to the Anti-Dummy Law.
Retail Trade Law (1996)
EL Inc, a domestic corporation with foreign equity,
manufactures electric generators, and sells them to the
following customers: a) government offices which use the
generators during brownouts to render public service, b)
agricultural enterprises which utilize the generators as
Page 76 of 103 backup in the processing of goods, c)
factories, and d) its own employees. Is EL engaged in
retail trade? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The sale by EL of generators to government offices,
agricultural enterprises and factories are outside the scope
of the term retail business and may, therefore, be made
by the said corporation. However, sales of generators by
EL to its own employees constitute retail sales and are
proscribed. Under the amendment to the Retail Trade Law
introduced by PD 714, the term retail business shall not
include a manufacturer (such as EL) selling to industrial
and commercial users or consumers who use the products
bought by them to render service to the general public (eg
government offices) and/or to produce or manufacture
goods which are in turn sold by them (eg agricultural
enterprises and factories). (Goodyear Tires v Reyes Sr Gr 30063, Jly
2, 83 123s273).
Retail Trade Law; Consignment (1991)
ABC Manufacturing Inc, a company wholly owned by
foreign nationals, manufactures typewriters which ABC
distributes to the general public in 2 ways:
1 ABC consigns its typewriters to independent
dealers who in turn sell them to the public; and,
2 Through individuals, who are not employees of
ABC, and who are paid strictly on a commission basis for
each sale.
Do these arrangements violate the Retail Trade Law?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) The first arrangement would not be in violation of the
Retail Trade Law. The law applies only when the sale is
direct to the general public. A dealer buys and sells for and
in his own behalf and, therefore, the sale to the general
public is made by the dealer and not by the manufacturer
(Marsman & Co v First Coconut Control Co GR39841 20June1988)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
a) The first arrangement violates the Retail Trade Law
because when ABC consigned the typewriters, the
transaction was one of consignment sale. In consignment
sale, an agency relationship is created so it is as if ABC
sells directly to the public through its agents.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
b) The second arrangement would be violative of the Retail
Trade Law, since the sale is done through individuals being
paid strictly on a commission basis. The said individuals
would then be acting merely as agents of the manufacturer.
Sales, therefore, made by such agents are deemed direct
sales by the manufacturer.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
b) The 2nd arrangement is not violative of the Retail Trade
Law because typewriters are not consumption goods or
goods for personal, household and family use.
Negotiable Instruments Law
Bond: Cash Bond vs. Surety Bond (2004)
Distinguish clearly cash bond from surety bond.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A SURETY BOND is issued by a surety or insurance
company in favor of a designated beneficiary, pursuant to
which such company acts as a surety to the debtor or
obligor of such beneficiary. A CASH BOND is a security
in the form of cash established by a guarantor or surety to
secure the obligation of another.
Checks: Crossed Checks (2005)
What is a crossed check? What are the effects of crossing
a check? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A Crossed Check under accepted banking practice,
crossing a check is done by writing two parallel lines
diagonally on the left top portion of the checks. The
crossing is special where the name of the bank or a
business institution is written between the two parallel
lines, which means that the drawee should pay only with
the intervention of that company.
Effects of Crossed Checks
1) The check may not be encashed but only deposited
in the bank. 2) The check may be negotiated only
onceto one
who has an account with a bank. 3) The act of crossing
the check serves as a warning to
the holder that the check has been issued for a
definite purpose, so that he must inquire if he has
received the check pursuant to that purpose;
otherwise, he is not a holder in due course.
Checks: Crossed Checks vs. Cancelled Checks (2004)
Distinguish clearly (1) crossed checks from cancelled
checks;
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A crossed check is one with two parallel lines drawn
diagonally across its face or across a corner thereof. On
the other hand, a cancelled check is one marked or
stamped "paid" and/or "cancelled" by or on behalf of a
drawee bank to indicate payment thereof.
Checks; Crossed Check (1991)
Mr Pablo sought to borrow P200th from Mr Carlos.
Carlos agreed to loan the amount in the form of a post-
dated check which was crossed (i.e. 2 parallel lines
diagonally drawn on the top left portion of the check).
Before the due date of the check, Pablo discounted it with
Noble On due date, Noble deposited the check with his
bank. The check was dishonored. Noble sued Pablo. The
court dismissed Nobles complaint. Was the courts
decision correct?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The courts decision was incorrect. Pablo and Carlos,
being immediate parties to the instrument, are governed
by the rules of privity. Given the factual circumstances of
the problem, Pablo has no valid excuse from denying
liability, (State investment House v IAC GR 72764 13July1989).
Pablo undoubtedly had benefited in the transaction. To
hold otherwise would also contravene the basic rules of
unjust enrichment. Even in negotiable instruments, the
Page 77 of 103 Civil Code and other laws of general
application can still apply suppletorily.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
The dismissal by the court was correct. A check whether or
not post-dated or crossed, is still a negotiable instrument
and unless Pablo is a general indorser, which is not
expressed in the factual settings, he cannot be held liable
for the dishonor of the instrument. In State Investment House v
IAC (GR 72764 13Jul1989), the court did not go so far as to
hold that the fact of crossing would render the instrument
non-negotiable.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
In State Investment House v IAC (GR 72764 13Jul1989), the SC
considered a crossed check as subjecting a subsequent
holder thereof to the contractual covenants of the payor
and the payee. If such were the case, then the instrument is
not one which can still be said to contain an unconditional
promise to pay or order a sum certain in money. In the
transfer of non-negotiable credits by assignment, the
transferor does not assume liability for the fault of the
debtor or obligor. Accordingly the courts decision was
correct.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
Yes. The check is crossed. It should have forewarned Mr.
Noble that it was issued for a specific purpose. Hence, Mr
Noble could not be a holder in due course. He is subject to
the personal defense of breach of trust/ agreement by Mr.
Pablo. Such defense is available in favor of Mr Carlos
against Mr Noble.
Checks; Crossed Check (1994)
Po Press issued in favor of Jose a postdated crossed check,
in payment of newsprint which Jose promised to deliver.
Jose sold and negotiated the check to Excel Inc. at a
discount. Excel did not ask Jose the purpose of crossing
the check. Since Jose failed to deliver the newsprint, Po
ordered the drawee bank to stop payment on the check.
Efforts of Excel to collect from Po failed. Excel wants to
know from you as counsel: 1) What are the effects of
crossing a check? 2) Whether as second indorser and
holder of the
crossed check, is it a holder in due course? 3) Whether
Pos defense of lack of consideration as
against Jose is also available as against Excel?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) The effects of crossing a check are:
The check is for deposit only in the account
of the payee
The check may be indorsed only once in
favor of a person who has an account with a bank
The check is issued for a specific purpose and
the person who takes it not in accordance with said
purpose does not become a holder in due course and is
not entitled to payment thereunder.
2) No. It is a crossed check and Excel did not take it in
accordance with the purpose for which the check was
issued. Failure on its part to inquire as to said purpose,
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
prevented Excel from becoming a holder in due course, as
such failure or refusal constituted bad faith.
3) Yes. Not being a holder in due course, Excel is subject
to the personal defense which Po Press can set up against
Jose (State Investment House v IAC 175 S 310)
Checks; Crossed Check (1995)
On Oct 12, 1993, Chelsea Straights, a corp engaged in the
manufacture of cigarettes, ordered from Moises 2,000
bales of tobacco. Chelsea issued to Moises two crossed
checks postdated 15 Mar 94 and 15 Apr 94 in full payment
therefor. On 19 Jan 94 Moises sold to Dragon Investment
House at a discount the two checks drawn by Chelsea in
his favor. Moises failed to deliver the bales of tobacco as
agreed despite Chelseas demand. Consequently, on 1 Mar
94 Chelsea issued a stop payment order on the 2 checks
issued to Moises. Dragon, claiming to be a holder in due
course, filed a complaint for collection against Chelsea for
the value of the checks. Rule on the complaint of Dragon.
Give your legal basis.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Dragon cannot collect from Chelsea. The instruments are
crossed checks which were intended to pay for the 2,000
bales of tobacco to be delivered to Moises. It was therefore
the obligation of Dragon to inquire as to the purpose of
the issuance of the 2 crossed checks before causing them
to be discounted. Failure on its part to make such inquiry,
which resulted in its bad faith, Dragon cannot claim to be a
holder in due course. Moreover, the checks were sold, not
endorsed, by him to Dragon which did not become a
holder in due course. Not being a holder in due course,
Dragon is subject to the personal defense on the part of
Chelsea concerning the breach of trust on the part of
Moises Lim in not complying with his obligation to deliver
the 2000 bales of tobacco.
Checks; Crossed Check (1996)
What are the effects of crossing a check?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The effects of crossing a check are as follows:
The check may not be encashed but only deposited in a
bank;
The check may be negotiated only once to one who has
an account with a bank;
The act of crossing a check serves as a warning to the
holder thereof that the check has been issued for a definite
purpose so that the holder must inquire if he has received the
check pursuant to that purpose, otherwise he is not a holder in
due course (See Bataan Cigar and Cigarette Factory, Inc. v CA GR 93048,
Mar 3, 1994; 230 s 643)
Checks; Crossed Check (1996)
On March 1, 1996, Pentium Company ordered a computer
from CD Bytes, and issued a crossed check in the amount
of P30,000 post-dated Mar 31, 1996. Upon receipt of the
check, CD Bytes discounted the check with Fund House.
Page 78 of 103
On April 1, 1996, Pentium stopped payment of the check
for failure of CD Bytes to deliver the computer. Thus,
when Fund House deposited the check, the drawee bank
dishonored it.
If Fund House files a complaint against Pentium and CD
Bytes for the payment of the dishonored check, will the
complaint prosper? Explain. SUGGESTED ANSWER:: The
complaint filed by Fund House against Pentium will not
prosper but the one against CD Bytes will. Fund House is
not a holder in due course and, therefore, Pentium can
raise the defense of failure of consideration against it. The
check in question was issued by Pentium to pay for a
computer that it ordered from CD Bytes. The computer
not having been delivered, there was a failure of
consideration. The check discounted with Fund House by
CD Bytes is a crossed check and this should have put Fund
House on inquiry. It should have ascertained the title of
CD Bytes to the check or the nature of the latters
possession. Failing in this respect, Fund House is deemed
guilty of gross negligence amounting to legal absence of
good faith and, thus, not a holder in due course. Fund
House can collect from CD Bytes as the latter was the
immediate indorser of the check. (See Bataan Cigar and Cigarette
Factory v CA et al 230 s 643 GR 93048 Mar 3, 94)
Checks; Effect; Acceptance by the drawee bank (1998)
X draws a check against his current account with the
Ortigas branch of Bonifacio Bank in favor of B. Although
X does not have sufficient funds, the bank honors the
check when it is presented for payment. Apparently, X has
conspired with the banks bookkeeper so that his ledger
card would show that he still has sufficient funds.
The bank files an action for recovery of the amount paid
to B because the check presented has no sufficient funds.
Decide the case (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The bank cannot recover the amount paid to B for the
check. When the bank honored the check, it became an
acceptor. As acceptor, the bank became primarily and
directly liable to the payee/holder B.
The recourse of the bank should be against X and its
bookkeeper who conspired to make Xs ledger show that
he has sufficient funds.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
The bank can recover from B. This is solutio indebiti because
there is payment by the bank to B when such payment is
not due. The check issued by X to B as payee had no
sufficient funds.
Checks; Effects; Alterations; Prescriptive Period (1996)
William issued to Albert a check for P10,000 drawn on
XM Bank. Albert altered the amount of the check to
P210,000 and deposited the check to his account with ND
Bank. When ND Bank presented the check for
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
payment through the Clearing House, XM Bank honored
it. Thereafter, Albert withdrew the P210,000 and closed
his account.
When the check was returned to him after a month,
William discovered the alteration. XM Bank recredited
P210,000 to Williams current account, and sought
reimbursement from ND Bank. ND Bank refused,
claiming that XM Bank failed to return the altered check to
it within 24 hour clearing period. Who, as between, XM
Bank and ND Bank, should bear the loss? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
ND Bank should bear the loss if XM Bank returned the
altered check to ND Bank within twenty four hours after
its discovery of the alteration. Under the given facts,
William discovered the alteration when the altered check
was returned to him after a month. It may safely be
assumed that William immediately advised XM Bank of
such fact and that the latter promptly notified ND Bank
thereafter. Central Bank Circular No. 9, as amended, on
which the decisions of the Supreme Court in Hongkong &
Shanghai Banking Corp v Peoples Bank & Trust Co and Republic
Bank vs CA were based was expressly cancelled and
superseded by CB No 317 dated Dec 23 1970. The latter
was in turn amended by CB Circular No 580, dated Sept
19, 1977. As to altered checks, the new rules provide that
the drawee bank can still return them even after 4:00 pm
of the next day provided it does so within 24 hours from
discovery of the alteration but in no event beyond the
period fixed or provided by law for filing of a legal action
by the returning bank against the bank sending the same.
Assuming that the relationship between the drawee bank
and the collecting bank is evidenced by some written
document, the prescriptive period would be 10 years.
(Campos, NIL 5th ed 454-455)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
XM Bank should bear the loss. When the drawee bank
(XM Bank) failed to return the altered check to the
collecting bank (ND Bank) within the 24 hour clearing
period provided in Sec 4c of CB Circular 9, dated Feb 17,
1949, the latter is absolved from liability. (See HSBC v PB&T
Co GR L-28226 Sep 30 1970; 35 s 140; also Rep Bank v CA GR
42725 Apr 22, 1991 196 s 100)
Checks; Forged Check; Effects (2006)
Discuss the legal consequences when a bank honors a
forged check. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The legal consequences when a bank honors a forged
check are as follows:
(a) When Drawer's Signature is Forged: Drawee-bank
by accepting the check cannot set up the defense of
forgery, because by accepting the instrument, the drawee
bank admits the genuineness of signature of drawer (BPI
Family Bank vs. Buenaventura G.R. No. 148196, September 30, 2005;
Section 23, Negotiable Instruments Law).
Unless a forgery is attributable to the fault or negligence
of the drawer himself, the remedy of the drawee-bank is
against the party responsible for the forgery. Otherwise,
Page 79 of 103
drawee-bank bears the loss (BPI Family Bank v. Buenaventura,
G.R. No. 148196, September 30, 2005). A drawee-bank paying
on a forged check must be considered as paying out of its
funds and cannot charge the amount to the drawer
(Samsung Construction Co. Phils, v. Far East Bank, G.R. No. 129015,
August 13, 2004). If the drawee-bank has charged drawer's
account, the latter can recover such amount from the
drawee-bank (Associated Bank v. Court of Appeals,
G.R. No. 107382, January 31, 1996; Bank of P. I. v. Case Montessori
Internationale, G.R. No. 149454, May 28, 2004).
However, the drawer may be precluded or estopped from
setting up the defense of forgery as against the
drawee-bank, when it is shown that the drawer himself had
been guilty of gross negligence as to have facilitated the
forgery (Metropolitan Waterworks v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. L-
62943, 143 SCRA 20, July 14, 1986).
(NOTA BENE: The question does not qualify the term
"forged check". An answer addressing the liabilities of a drawer
should be deemed sufficient. Answers addressing liabilities of
parties should likewise be given full credit)
Drawee Bank versus Collecting Bank When the
signature of the drawer is forged, as between the
drawee-bank and collecting bank, the drawee-bank
sustains the loss, since the collecting bank does not
guarantee the signature of the drawer. The payment of the
check by the drawee bank constitutes the proximate
negligence since it has the duty to know the signature of
its client-drawer. (Philippine National Bank v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. L-26001,
October 29, 1968).
(b) Forged Payee's Signature: When drawee-bank pays
the forged check, it must be considered as paying out of
its funds and cannot charge the amount so paid to the
account of the depositor. In such case, the bank becomes
liable since its primary duty is to verify the authenticity of
the payee's signature (Traders Royal Bank v. Radio Philippines
Network, G.R. No. 138510, October 10, 2002; Westmont Bank v. Ong,
G.R. No. 132560, January 30, 2002).
(c) Forged
Indorsement:
Drawer's account cannot be charged, and if
charged, he can recover from the drawee-bank
(Associated Bank v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 107382
January 31,1996).
Drawer has no cause of action against
collecting bank, since the duty of collecting bank is
only to the payee. A collecting bank is not guilty of
negligence over a forged indorsement on checks for it
has no way of ascertaining the authority of the
endorsement and when it caused the checks to pass
through the clearing house before allowing withdrawal
of the proceeds thereof
(Manila Lighter Transportation, Inc. v. Court of Appeals,
G.R. No. 50373, February 15, 1990). On the other hand, a
collecting bank which endorses a check bearing a
forged endorsement and presents it to the drawee
bank guarantees all prior endorsements including the
forged endorsement itself and should be held liable
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
therefor (Traders Royal Bank v. RPN, G.R. No. 138510,
October 10, 2002).
Drawee-bank can recover from the
collecting bank (Great Eastern Life Ins. Co. v. Hongkong &
Shanghai Bank, G.R. No. 18657, August 23,1922)
because even if the indorsement on the check
deposited by the bank's client is forged, collecting
bank is bound by its warranties as an indorser and
cannot set up defense of forgery as against drawee
bank (Associated Bank v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No.
107382, January 31, 1996).
Checks; Liability; Drawee Bank (1995)
Mario Guzman issued to Honesto Santos a check for
P50th as payment for a 2nd hand car. Without the
knowledge of Mario, Honesto changed the amount to
P150th which alteration could not be detected by the
naked eye. Honesto deposited the altered check with Shure
Bank which forwarded the same to Progressive Bank for
payment. Progressive Bank without noticing the alteration
paid the check, debiting P150th from the account of
Mario. Honesto withdrew the amount of P15th from
Shure Bank and disappeared. After receiving his bank
statement, Mario discovered the alteration and demanded
restitution from Progressive Bank. Discuss fully the rights
and the liabilities of the parties concerned.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The demand of Mario for restitution of the amount of
P150,000 to his account is tenable. Progressive Bank has no
right to deduct said amount from Marios account since the
order of Mario is different. Moreover, Progressive Bank is
liable for the negligence of its employees in not noticing the
alteration which, though it cannot be detected by the naked
eye, could be detected by a magnifying instrument used by
tellers.
As between Progressive Bank and Shure Bank, it is the
former that should bear the loss. Progressive Bank failed
to notify Shure Bank that there was something wrong with
the check within the clearing hour rule of 24 hours.
Checks; Material Alterations; Liability (1999)
A check for P50,000.00 was drawn against drawee bank
and made payable to XYZ Marketing or order. The check
was deposited with payees account at ABC Bank which
then sent the check for clearing to drawee bank. Drawee
bank refused to honor the check on ground that the serial
number thereof had been altered. XYZ marketing sued
drawee bank.
Is it proper for the drawee bank to dishonor the check
for the reason that it had been altered? Explain (2%)
In instant suit, drawee bank contended that XYZ
Marketing as payee could not sue the drawee bank as there was
no privity between then. Drawee theorized that there was no
basis to make it liable for the check. Is this contention correct?
Explain. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a. No. The serial number is not a material particular of the
check. Its alteration does not constitute material
Page 80 of 103 alteration of the instrument. The serial
number is not material to the negotiability of the
instrument.
b. Yes. As a general rule, the drawee is not liable under the
check because there is no privity of contract between XYZ
Marketing, as payee, and ABC Bank as the drawee bank.
However, if the action taken by the bank is an abuse of
right which caused damage not only to the issuer of the
check but also to the payee, the payee has a cause of action
under quasi-delict.
Checks; Presentment (1994)
Gemma drew a check on September 13, 1990. The holder
presented the check to the drawee bank only on March 5,
1994. The bank dishonored the check on the same date.
After dishonor by the drawee bank, the holder gave a
formal notice of dishonor to Gemma through a letter
dated April 27, 1994. 1) What is meant by unreasonable
time as applied to presentment? 2) Is Gemma liable to the
holder?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) As applied to presentment for payment, reasonable
time: is meant not more than 6 months from the date of
issue. Beyond said period, it is unreasonable time and
the check becomes stale.
2) No. Aside form the check being already stale, Gemma
is also discharged form liability under the check, being a
drawer and a person whose liability is secondary, this is
due to the giving of the notice of dishonor beyond the
period allowed by law. The giving of notice of dishonor on
April 27, 1994 is more than one (1) month from March 5,
1994 when the check was dishonored. Since it is not
shown that Gemma and the holder resided in the same
place, the period within which to give notice of dishonor
must be the same time that the notice would reach
Gemma if sent by mail. (NIL Sec 103 & 104; Far East
Realty Investment Inc v CA 166 S 256)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
2) Gemma can still be liable under the original contract
for the consideration of which the check was issued.
Checks; Presentment (2003)
A bank issues its own check. May the holder hold the
bank liable thereunder if he fails to
prove presentment for payment, or
present the bill to the drawee for acceptance?
Explain your answers. (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Checks; Validity; Waiver of Banks liability for
negligence (1991)
Mr. Lim issued a check drawn against BPI Bank in favor
of Mr Yu as payment of certain shares of stock which he
purchased. On the same day that he issued the check to
Yu, Lim ordered BPI to stop payment. Per standard
banking practice, Lim was made to sign a waiver of BPIs
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
liability in the event that it should pay Yu through
oversight or inadvertence. Despite the stop order by Lim,
BPI nevertheless paid Yu upon presentation of the check.
Lim sued BPI for paying against his order. Decide the case.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
In the event that Mr. Lim, in fact, had sufficient legal
reasons to issue the stop payment order, he may sue BPI
for paying against his order. The waiver executed by Mr
Lim did not mean that it need not exercise due diligence to
protect the interest of its account holder. It is not amiss to
state that the drawee, unless the instrument has earlier
been accepted by it, is not bound to honor payment to the
holder of the check that thereby excludes it from any
liability if it were to comply with its stop payment order
(Sec 61 NIL)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
1991 6b) BPI would not be liable to Mr Lim. Mr Lim and
BPI are governed by their own agreement. The waiver
executed by Mr Lim, neither being one of future fraud or
gross negligence, would be valid. The problem does not
indicate the existence of fraud or gross negligence on the
part of BPI so as to warrant liability on its part.
Defenses; Forgery (2004)
CX maintained a checking account with UBANK, Makati
Branch. One of his checks in a stub of fifty was missing.
Later, he discovered that Ms. DY forged his signature and
succeeded to encash P15,000 from another branch of the
bank. DY was able to encash the check when ET, a friend,
guaranteed due execution, saying that she was a holder in
due course. Can CX recover the money from the bank?
Reason briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, CX can recover from the bank. Under Section 23 of
the Negotiable Instruments Law, forgery is a real defense.
The forged check is wholly inoperative in relation to CX.
CX cannot be held liable thereon by anyone, not even by a
holder in due course. Under a forged signature of the
drawer, there is no valid instrument that would give rise to
a contract which can be the basis or source of liability on
the part of the drawer. The drawee bank has no right or
authority to touch the drawer's funds deposited with the
drawee bank.
Forgery; Liabilities; Prior & Subsequent Parties (1990)
Jose loaned Mario some money and, to evidence his
indebtedness, Mario executed and delivered to Jose a
promissory note payable to his order.
Jose endorsed the note to Pablo. Bert fraudulently
obtained the note from Pablo and endorsed it to Julian
by forging Pablos signature. Julian endorsed the note to
Camilo. a) May Camilo enforce the said promissory note
against Mario and Jose? b) May Camilo go against Pablo?
c) May Camilo enforce said note against Julian? d)
Against whom can Julian have the right of recourse?
Page 81 of 103
e) May Pablo recover from either Mario or Jose?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Camilo may not enforce said promissory note against
Mario and Jose. The promissory note at the time of forgery
being payable to order, the signature of Pablo was essential
for the instrument to pass title to subsequent parties. A
forged signature was inoperative (Sec 23 NIL).
Accordingly, the parties before the forgery are not
juridically related to parties after the forgery to allow such
enforcement.
b) Camilo may not go against Pablo, the latter not having
indorsed the instrument.
c) Camilo may enforce the instrument against Julian
because of his special indorsement to Camilo, thereby
making him secondarily liable, both being parties after the
forgery.
d) Julian, in turn, may enforce the instrument against Bert
who, by his forgery, has rendered himself primarily liable.
e) Pablo preserves his right to recover from either Mario
or Jose who remain parties juridically related to him. Mario
is still considered primarily liable to Pablo. Pablo may, in
case of dishonor, go after Jose who, by his special
indorsement, is secondarily liable.
Note: It is possible that an answer might distinguish
between blank and special indorsements of prior parties
which can thereby materially alter the above suggested
answers. The problem did not clearly indicate the kind of
indorsements made.
Forgery; Liabilities; Prior & Subsequent Parties (1995)
Alex issued a negotiable PN (promissory note) payable to
Benito or order in payment of certain goods. Benito
indorsed the PN to Celso in payment of an existing
obligation. Later Alex found the goods to be defective.
While in Celsos possession the PN was stolen by Dennis
who forged Celsos signature and discounted it with Edgar,
a money lender who did not make inquiries about the PN.
Edgar indorsed the PN to Felix, a holder in due course.
When Felix demanded payment of the PN from Alex the
latter refused to pay. Dennis could no longer be located.
1. What are the rights of Felix, if any, against Alex,
Benito, Celso and Edgar? Explain
2. Does Celso have any right against Alex, Benito and
Felix? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. Felix has no right to claim against Alex, Benito and
Celso who are parties prior to the forgery of Celsos
signature by Dennis. Parties to an instrument who are
such prior to the forgery cannot be held liable by any party
who became such at or subsequent to the forgery.
However, Edgar, who became a party to the instrument
subsequent to the forgery and who indorsed the same to
Felix, can be held liable by the latter.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
2. Celso has the right to collect from Alex and Benito.
Celso is a party subsequent to the two. However, Celso has
no right to claim against Felix who is a party subsequent to
Celso (Sec 60 and 66 NIL)
Incomplete & Delivered (2004)
AX, a businessman, was preparing for a business trip
abroad. As he usually did in the past, he signed several
checks in blank and entrusted them to his secretary with
instruction to safeguard them and fill them out only when
required to pay accounts during his absence. OB, his
secretary, filled out one of the checks by placing her name
as the payee. She filled out the amount, endorsed and
delivered the check to KC, who accepted it in good faith
for payment of gems that KC sold to OB. Later, OB told
AX of what she did with regrets. AX timely directed the
bank to dishonor the check. Could AX be held liable to
KC? Answer and reason briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. AX could be held liable to KC. This is a case of an
incomplete check, which has been delivered. Under
Section 14 of the Negotiable Instruments Law, KC, as a
holder in due course, can enforce payment of the check as
if it had been filled up strictly in accordance with the
authority given by AX to OB and within a reasonable time.
Incomplete and Delivered (2005)
Brad was in desperate need of money to pay his debt to
Pete, a loan shark. Pete threatened to take Brads life if he
failed to pay. Brad and Pete went to see Seorita Isobel,
Brads rich cousin, and asked her if she could sign a
promissory note in his favor in the amount of P10,000.00
to pay Pete. Fearing that Pete would kill Brad, Seorita
Isobel acceded to the request. She affixed her signature on
a piece of paper with the assurance of Brad that he will just
fill it up later. Brad then filled up the blank paper, making
a promissory note for the amount of P100,000.00. He then
indorsed and delivered the same to Pete, who accepted the
note as payment of the debt.
What defense or defenses can Seorita Isobel set up
against Pete? Explain. (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The defense (personal defense) which Seorita Isobel can
set up against Pete is that the amount of P100,000.00 is
not in accordance with the authority given to her to Brad
(in the presence of Pete) and that Pete was not a holder in
due course for acting in bad faith when accepted the note
as payment despite his knowledge that it was only
10,000.00 that was allowed by Seorita Isobel during their
meeting with Brad.
Incomplete Instruments; Incomplete Delivered
Instruments vs. Incomplete Undelivered Instrument
(2006)
Jun was about to leave for a business trip. As his usual
practice, he signed several blank checks. He instructed
Ruth, his secretary, to fill them as payment for his
obligations. Ruth filled one check with her name as payee,
placed P30,000.00 thereon, endorsed and
Page 82 of 103 delivered it to Marie. She accepted the
check in good faith as payment for goods she delivered to
Ruth. Eventually, Ruth regretted what she did and
apologized to Jun. Immediately he directed the drawee
bank to dishonor the check. When Marie encashed the
check, it was dishonored.
1. Is Jun liable to Marie? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. This covers the delivery of an incomplete instrument,
under Section 14 of the Negotiable Instruments Law,
which provides that there was prima facie authority on the
part of Ruth to fill-up any of the material particulars
thereof. Having done so, and when it is first completed
before it is negotiated to a holder in due course like Marie,
it is valid for all purposes, and Marie may enforce it within
a reasonable time, as if it had been filled up strictly in
accordance with the authority given.
2. Supposing the check was stolen while in Ruth's pos-
session and a thief filled the blank check, endorsed and
delivered it to Marie in payment for the goods he
purchased from her, is Jun liable to Marie if the check is
dishonored? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. Even though Marie is a holder in due course, this is an
incomplete and undelivered instrument, covered by Section
15 of the Negotiable Instruments Law. Where an
incomplete instrument has not been delivered, it will not, if
completed and negotiated without authority, be a valid
contract in the hands of any holder, as against any person,
including Jun, whose signature was placed thereon before
delivery. Such defense is a real defense even against a
holder in due course, available to a party like Jun whose
signature appeared prior to delivery.
Indorser: Irregular Indorser vs. General Indorser (2005)
Distinguish an irregular indorser from a general indorser.
(3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Irregular Indorser is not a party to the instrument but he
places his signature in blank before delivery. He is not a
party but he becomes one because of his signature in the
instrument. Because his signature he is considered an
indorser and he is liable to the parties in the instrument.
While, a General Indorser warrants that the instrument is
genuine, that he has a good title to it, that all prior parties
had capacity to contract; that the instrument at the time of
the indorsement is valid and subsisting; and that on due
presentment, the instrument will be accepted or paid or
both accepted and paid according to its tenor, and that if it
is dishonored, he will pay if the necessary proceedings for
dishonor are made.
Negotiability (1993)
Discuss the negotiability or non-negotiability of the
following notes
1) Manila, September 1, 1993
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
P2,500.00 I promise to pay Pedro San Juan or order the
sum of P2,500.
(Sgd.) Noel Castro
2) Manila, June 3, 1993
P10,000.00 For value received, I promise to pay Sergio
Dee or order the sum of P10,000.00 in five (5)
installments, with the first installment payable on October
5, 1993 and the other installments on or before the fifth
day of the succeeding month or thereafter.
(Sgd.) Lito Villa
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The promissory note is negotiable as it complies with Sec
1, NIL.
Firstly, it is in writing and signed by the maker, Noel
Castro.
Secondly, the promise is unconditional to pay a sum
certain in money, that is, P2,500.00
Thirdly, it is payable on demand as no date of maturity
is specified.
Fourth, it is payable to order.
The promissory note is negotiable. All the requirements of
Sec 1 NIL are complied with. The sum to be paid is still
certain despite that the sum is to be paid by installments
(Sec 2b NIL)
Negotiability (2002)
Which of the following stipulations or features of a
promissory note (PN) affect or do not affect its
negotiability, assuming that the PN is otherwise negotiable?
Indicate your answer by writing the paragraph number of
the stipulation or feature of the PN as shown below and
your corresponding answer, either Affected or Not
affected. Explain (5%).
a) The date of the PN is February 30, 2002.
b) The PN bears interest payable on the last day of
each calendar quarter at a rate equal to five percent (5%)
above the then prevailing 91-day Treasury Bill rate as
published at the beginning of such calendar quarter.
c) The PN gives the maker the option to make
payment either in money or in quantity of palay or
equivalent value.
d) The PN gives the holder the option either to
require payment in money or to require the maker to serve
as the bodyguard or escort of the holder for 30 days.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Paragraph 1 negotiability is NOT
AFFECTED. The date is not one of the requirements for
negotiability.
Page 83 of 103 b) Paragraph 2 negotiability is NOT
AFFECTED
The interest is to be computed at a particular time
and is determinable. It does not make the sum
uncertain or the promise conditional. c) Paragraph 3
negotiability is AFFECTED.
Giving the maker the option renders the promise
conditional d) Paragraph 4 negotiability is NOT
AFFECTED.
Giving the option to the holder does not make the
promise conditional.
Negotiability; Holder in Due Course (1992)
Perla brought a motor car payable on installments from
Automotive Company for P250th. She made a down
payment of P50th and executed a promissory note for the
balance. The company subsequently indorsed the note to
Reliable Finance Corporation which financed the purchase.
The promissory note read: For value received, I promised
to pay Automotive Company or order at its office in
Legaspi City, the sum of P200,000.00 with interest at
twelve (12%) percent per annum, payable in equal
installments of P20,000.00 monthly for ten (10) months
starting October 21, 1991.
Manila September 21, 1991.
(sgd) Perla
Pay to the order of Reliable Finance Corporation.
Automotive Company
By: (Sgd) Manager
Because Perla defaulted in the payment of her installments,
Reliable Finance Corporation initiated a case against her for
a sum of money. Perla argued that the promissory note is
merely an assignment of credit, a non-negotiable instrument
open to all defenses available to the assignor and, therefore,
Reliable Finance Corporation is not a holder in due course.
a) Is the promissory note a mere assignment of credit or a
negotiable instrument? Why? b) Is Reliable Finance Corp a
holder in due course? Explain briefly.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) The promissory note in the problem is a negotiable
instrument, being in compliance with the provisions of
Sec 1 NIL. Neither the fact that the payable sum is to be
paid with interest nor that the maturities are in stated
installments renders uncertain the amount payable (Sec 2
NIL)
b) Yes, Reliable Finance Corporation is a holder in due
course given the factual settings. Said corporation
apparently took the promissory note for value, and there
are no indications that it acquired it in bad faith (Sec 52
NIL see Salas v CA 181 s 296)
Negotiability; Requisites (2000)
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
a) MP bought a used cell phone from JR. JR preferred cash
but MP is a friend so JR accepted MRs promissory note
for P10,000. JR thought of converting the note into cash
by endorsing it to his brother KR. The promissory note is
a piece of paper with the following hand-printed notation:
MP WILL PAY JR TEN THOUSAND PESOS IN
PAYMENT FOR HIS CELLPHONE 1 WEEK FROM
TODAY. Below this notation MPs signature with
8/1/00 next to it, indicating the date of the promissory
note. When JR presented MPs note to KR, the latter said
it was not a negotiable instrument under the law and so
could not be a valid substitute for cash. JR took the
opposite view, insisting on the notes negotiability. You are
asked to referee. Which of the opposing views is correct?
b) TH is an indorsee of a promissory note that simply
states: PAY TO JUAN TAN OR ORDER 400 PESOS.
The note has no date, no place of payment and no
consideration mentioned. It was signed by MK and written
under his letterhead specifying the address, which happens
to be his residence. TH accepted the promissory note as
payment for services rendered to SH, who in turn received
the note from Juan Tan as payment for a prepaid cell
phone card worth 450 pesos. The payee acknowledged
having received the note on August 1, 2000. A Bar
reviewee had told TH, who happens to be your friend, that
TH is not a holder in due course under Article 52 of the
Negotiable Instruments Law (Act 2031) and therefore does
not enjoy the rights and protection under the statute. TH
asks for our advice specifically in connection with the note
being undated and not mentioning a place of payment and
any consideration. What would your advice be? (2%).
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) KR is right. The promissory note is not negotiable. It is
not issued to order or bearer. There is no word of
negotiability containing therein. It is not issued in
accordance with Section 1 of the Negotiable Instruments
Law
b) The fact that the instrument is undated and does not
mention the place of payment does not militate against its
being negotiable. The date and place of payment are not
material particulars required to make an instrument
negotiable.
The fact that no mention is made of any consideration is
not material. Consideration is presumed.
Negotiable Instrument: Ambiguous Instruments (1998)
How do you treat a negotiable instrument that is so
ambiguous that there is doubt whether it is a bill or a note?
(5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. Where a negotiable instrument is so ambiguous that
there is doubt whether it is a bill or a note, the holder may
treat it either as a bill of exchange or a promissory note
at his election.
Page 84 of 103 Negotiable Instrument: Definition &
Characteristics (2005) What is a negotiable instrument?
Give the characteristics of a negotiable instrument. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Negotiable Instrument is a written contract for the
payment of money which is intended as a substitute for
money and passes from one person to another as money,
in such a manner as to give a holder in due course the right
to hold the instrument free from defenses available to
prior parties. Such instrument must comply with Sec. 1 of
the Negotiable Instrument Law to be considered
negotiable.
The characteristics of a negotiable instrument are;
Negotiable Instrument: Identification (2005)
State and explain whether the following are negotiable
instruments under the Negotiable Instruments Law: (5%)
1) Postal Money Order;
2) A certificate of time deposit which states This is
to certify that bearer has deposited in this bank the sum of
FOUR THOUSAND PESOS (P4,000.00) only, repayable
to the depositor 200 days after date.
3) Letters of credit;
4) Warehouse receipts;
5) Treasury warrants payable from a specific fund.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) Postal Money Order Non-Negotiable as it is
governed by postal rules and regulation which may be
inconsistent with the NIL and it can only be negotiated
once.
2) A certificate of time deposit which states This is
to certify that bearer has deposited in this bank the sum of
FOUR THOUSAND PESOS (P4,000.00) only, repayable
to the depositor 200 days after date. Non-Negotiable as
it does not comply with the requisites of Sec. 1 of NIL
3) Letters of credit - Non-Negotiable
4) Warehouse receipts - Non-Negotiable for the
same as Bill of Lading it merely represents good, not
money.
5) Treasury warrants payable from a specific fund -
Non-Negotiable being payable out of a particular fund.
1
)
Can A now bring an action in the name of the
corporation to question the issuance of the shares
to X without receiving any payment?
2
)
Can X question the right of A to sue him in behalf
of the corporation on the ground that A has only
one share in his name?
3
)
Cannot the shares issued to X be considered as
watered stock?
1
)
when justified by definite corporate expansion
projects or programs approved by the BOD; or
2
)
when the corporation is prohibited under any loan
agreement with any financial institution or creditor,
whether local or foreign, from declaring dividends
without its or his consent, and such consent has not
yet been secured; or
3
)
when it can be clearly shown that such retention is
necessary under special circumstances obtaining in
the corporation, such as when there is need for
special reserve for probable contingencies.
a
.
Page 60 of 103 to print, reprint, publish, copy,
distribute, multiply, sell and make photographs,
photo engravings, and pictorial illustrations of the
works;
b
.
to make any translation or other version or extracts
or arrangements or adaptation thereof; to dramatize
if it be a non-dramatic work; to convert it into a
non-dramatic work if it be a drama; to complete or
execute it if it be a model or design;
c
.
to exhibit, perform, represent, produce or
reproduce the work in any manner or by any
method whatever for profit or otherwise; if not
reproduced in copies for sale, to sell any
manuscripts or any record whatsoever thereof;
d
.
to make any other use or disposition of the work
consistent with the laws of the land
Johann.
a. seize and destroy
b. injunction
c.
damages in such amount may have
bee
n
obtained from the use of the invention
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Negotiable Instrument: Negotiable Document vs.
Negotiable Instrument (2005)
Distinguish a negotiable document from a negotiable
instrument. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Negotiable Instrument have requisites of Sec. 1 of the
NIL, a holder of this instrument have right of recourse
against intermediate parties who are secondarily liable,
Holder in due course may have rights better than
transferor, its subject is money and the Instrument itself is
property of value.
On the other hand, negotiable document does not contain
requisites of Sec. 1 of NIL, it has no secondary liability of
intermediate parties, transferee merely steps into the shoes
of the transferor, its subject are goods and the instrument
is merely evidence of title; thing of value are the goods
mentioned in the document.
Negotiable Instrument; Negotiability (1997)
Can a bill of exchange or a promissory note qualify as a
negotiable instrument if
a. it is not
dated; or
b. the day and the month, but not the year of its
maturity, is given; or
c. it is payable to
cash or
d. it names two alternative
drawees
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Yes. Date is not a material particular required by Sec 1
NIL for the negotiability of an instrument.
b) No. The time for payment is not determinable in this
case. The year is not stated.
c) Yes. Sec 9d NIL makes the instrument payable to bearer
because the name of the payee does not purport to be the
name of any person.
d) A bill may not be addressed to two or more drawees in
the alternative or in succession, to be negotiable (Sec 128
NIL). To do so makes the order conditional.
Negotiable Instruments; Bearer Instrument (1998)
Richard Clinton makes a promissory note payable to
bearer and delivers the same to Aurora Page. Aurora Page,
however, endorses it to X in this manner:
Payable to X. Signed: Aurora Page.
Later, X, without endorsing the promissory note, transfers
and delivers the same to Napoleon. The note is
subsequently dishonored by Richard Clinton. May
Napoleon proceed against Richard Clinton for the note?
(5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. Richard Clinton is liable to Napoleon under the
promissory note. The note made by Richard Clinton is a
bearer instrument. Despite special indorsement made by
Aurora Page thereon, the note remained a bearer
instrument and can be negotiated by mere delivery. When
X delivered and transferred the note to Napoleon, the
Page 85 of 103 latter became a holder thereof. As such
holder, Napoleon can proceed against Richard Clinton.
Negotiable Instruments; Bearer Instruments (1997)
A delivers a bearer instrument to B. B then specially
indorses it to C and C later indorses it in blank to D. E
steals the instrument from D and, forging the signature of
D, succeeds in negotiating it to F who acquires the
instrument in good faith and for value. a) If, for any
reason, the drawee bank refuses to honor the check, can F
enforce the instrument against the drawer? b) In case of
the dishonor of the check by both the drawee and the
drawer, can F hold any of B, C and D liable secondarily on
the instrument?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Yes. The instrument was payable to bearer as it was a
bearer instrument. It could be negotiated by mere delivery
despite the presence of special indorsements. The forged
signature is unnecessary to presume the juridical relation
between or among the parties prior to the forgery and the
parties after the forgery. The only party who can raise the
defense of forgery against a holder in due course is the
person whose signature is forged.
b) Only B and C can be held liable by F. The instrument at
the time of the forgery was payable to bearer, being a bearer
instrument. Moreover, the instrument was indorsed in
blank by C to D. D, whose signature was forged by E
cannot be held liable by F.
Negotiable Instruments; bearer instruments; liabilities of
maker and indorsers (2001)
A issued a promissory note payable to B or bearer. A
delivered the note to B. B indorsed the note to C. C placed
the note in his drawer, which was stolen by the janitor X. X
indorsed the note to D by forging Cs signature. D
indorsed the note to E who in turn delivered the note to F,
a holder in due course, without indorsement. Discuss the
individual liabilities to F of A, B and C. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A is liable to F. As the maker of the promissory note, A is
directly or primarily liable to F, who is a holder in due
course. Despite the presence of the special indorsements
on the note, these do not detract from the fact that a
bearer instrument, like the promissory note in question, is
always negotiable by mere delivery, until it is indorsed
restrictively For Deposit Only.
B, as a general indorser, is liable to F secondarily, and
warrants that the instrument is genuine and in all respects
what it purports to be; that he has good title to it; that all
prior parties had capacity to contract; that he has no
knowledge of any fact which would impair the validity of
the instrument or render it valueless; that at the time of his
indorsement, the instrument is valid and subsisting; and
that on due presentment, it shall be accepted or paid, or
both, according to its tenor, and that if it be dishonored
and the necessary proceedings on dishonor
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
be duly taken, he will pay the amount thereof to the
holder, or to any subsequent indorser who may be
compelled to pay.
C is not liable to F since the latter cannot trace his title to
the former. The signature of C in the supposed
indorsement by him to D was forged by X. C can raise the
defense of forgery since it was his signature that was
forged.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
As a general endorser, B is secondarily liable to F. C is
liable to F since it is due to the negligence of C in placing
the note in his drawer that enabled X to steal the same and
forge the signature of C relative to the indorsement in
favor of D. As between C and F who are both innocent
parties, it is C whose negligence is the proximate cause of
the loss. Hence C should suffer the loss.
Negotiable Instruments; incomplete and undelivered
instruments; holder in due course (2000)
PN makes a promissory note for P5,000.00, but leaves the
name of the payee in blank because he wanted to verify its
correct spelling first. He mindlessly left the note on top of
his desk at the end of the workday. When he returned the
following morning, the note was missing. It turned up later
when X presented it to PN for payment. Before X, T, who
turned out to have filched the note from PNs office, had
endorsed the note after inserting his own name in the blank
space as the payee. PN dishonored the note, contending
that he did not authorize its completion and delivery. But X
said he had no participation in, or knowledge about, the
pilferage and alteration of the note and therefore he enjoys
the rights of a holder in due course under the Negotiable
Instruments Law. Who is correct and why? (3%)
b) Can the payee in a promissory note be a holder in due
course within the meaning of the Negotiable Instruments
Law (Act 2031)? Explain your answer. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) PN is right. The instrument is incomplete and
undelivered. It did not create any contract that would bind
PN to an obligation to pay the amount thereof.
b) A payee in a promissory note cannot be a holder in due
course within the meaning of the Negotiable Instruments
Law, because a payee is an immediate party in relation to
the maker. The payee is subject to whatever defenses, real
of personal, available to the maker of the promissory note.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
b) A payee can be a holder in due course. A holder is
defined as the payee or indorsee of the instrument who is
in possession of it. Every holder is deemed prima facie to
be a holder in due course.
Negotiable Instruments; Incomplete
DeliveredInstruments; Comparative
Negligence (1997)
Page 86 of 103 A, single proprietor of a business
concern, is about to leave for a business trip and, as he so
often does on these occasions, signs several checks in
blank. He instructs B, his secretary, to safekeep the checks
and fill them out when and as required to pay accounts
during his absence. B fills out one of the checks by placing
her name as payee, fills in the amount, endorses and
delivers the check to C who accepts it in good faith as
payment for goods sold to B. B regrets her action and tells
A what she did. A directs the Bank in time to dishonor the
check. When C encashes the check, it is dishonored. Can
A be held liable to C?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, A can be held liable to C, assuming that the latter gave
notice of dishonor to A. This is a case of an incomplete
instrument but delivered as it was entrusted to B, the
secretary of A. Moreover, under the doctrine of
comparative negligence, as between A and C, both
innocent parties, it was the negligence of A in entrusting
the check to B which is the proximate cause of the loss.
Negotiable Instruments; kinds of negotiable instrument;
words of negotiability (2002)
A. Define the following: (1) a negotiable promissory note,
(2) a bill of exchange and (3) a check. (3%)
B. You are Pedro Cruz. Draft the appropriate contract
language for (1) your negotiable promissory note and (2)
your check, each containing the essential elements of a
negotiable instrument (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A. (1) A negotiable promissory note is an unconditional
promise in writing made by one person to another, signed
by the maker, engaging to pay on demand or at a fixed or
determinable future time, a sum certain in money to order
or bearer.
(2) A bill of exchange is an unconditional order in writing
addressed by one person to another, signed by the person
giving it, requiring the person to whom it is addressed to
pay on demand or at a fixed or determinable future time a
sum certain in money to order or to bearer.
(3) A check is a bill of exchange drawn on a bank payable
on demand.
B. (1) Negotiable promissory note -
September 15, 2002
For value received, I hereby promise to pay Juan Santos
or order the sum of TEN THOUSAND PESOS (P10,000)
thirty (30) days from date hereof.
(Signed) Pedro Cruz
to: Philippine National Bank
Escolta, Manila Branch
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 87 of 103
Negotiable Instruments; Requisites (1996)
What are the requisites of a negotiable instrument?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The requisites of a negotiable instrument are as follows: a)
It must be in writing and signed by the maker or
drawer; b) It must contain an unconditional promise or
order
to pay a sum certain in money; c) It must be payable to
order or to bearer; and d) Where the instrument is
addressed to a drawee, he
must be named or otherwise indicated therein with
reasonable certainty. (Sec 1 NIL)
Notice Dishonor (1996)
When is notice of dishonor not required to be given to the
drawer?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Notice of dishonor is not required to be given to the
drawer in any of the following cases: a) Where the drawer
and drawee are the same person; b) When the drawee is a
fictitious person or a person
not having capacity to contract; c) When the drawer is the
person to whom the
instrument is presented for payment; d) Where the drawer
has no right to expect or require
that the drawee or acceptor will honor the
instrument; e) Where the drawer has countermanded
payment (Sec
114 NIL)
Parties; Accommodation Party (1990)
To accommodate Carmen, maker of a promissory note,
Jorge signed as indorser thereon, and the instrument was
negotiated to Raffy, a holder for value. At the time Raffy
took the instrument, he knew Jorge to be an accomodation
party only. When the promissory note was not paid, and
Raffy discovered that Carmen had no funds, he sued Jorge.
Jorge pleads in defense the fact that he had endorsed the
instrument without receiving value therefor, and the further
fact that Raffy knew that at the time he took the instrument
Jorge had not received any value or consideration of any
kind for his indorsement. Is Jorge liable? Discuss.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. Jorge is liable. Sec 29 of the NIL provides that an
accommodation party is liable on the instrument to a
holder for value, notwithstanding the holder at the time of
taking said instrument knew him to be only an
accommodation party. This is the nature or the essence of
accommodation.
Parties; Accommodation Party (1991)
On June 1, 1990, A obtained a loan of P100th from B, payable
not later than 20Dec1990. B required A to issue him a check
for that amount to be dated 20Dec1990. Since he does not
have any checking account, A, with the knowledge of B,
requested his friend, C, President of Saad Banking Corp
(Saad) to accommodate him. C agreed, he signed a check for
the aforesaid amount dated 20Dec 1990, drawn against Saads
account with the ABC
Commercial Banking Co. The By-laws of Saad requires that
checks issued by it must be signed by the President and the
Treasurer or the Vice-President. Since the Treasurer was
absent, C requested the Vice-President to co-sign the check,
which the latter reluctantly did. The check was delivered to B.
The check was dishonored upon presentment on due date for
insufficiency of funds. a) Is Saad liable on the check as an
accommodation party? b) If it is not, who then, under the above
facts, is/are the accommodation party?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a.) Saad is not liable on the check as an accommodation
party. The act of the corporation in accommodating a
friend of the President, is ultra vires (Crisologo-Jose v CA GR
80599, 15Sep1989). While it may be legally possible for the
corporation, whose business is to provide financial
accommodations in the ordinary course of business, such
as one given by a financing company to be an
accommodation party, this situation, however, is not the
case in the bar problem.
b) Considering that both the President and Vice-President
were signatories to the accommodation, they themselves
can be subject to the liabilities of accommodation parties to
the instrument in their personal capacity (Crisologo-Jose v CA
15Sep1989)
Parties; Accommodation Party (1996)
Nora applied for a loan of P100th with BUR Bank. By way
of accommodation, Noras sister, Vilma, executed a
promissory note in favor of BUR Bank. When Nora
defaulted, BUR Bank sued Vilma, despite its knowledge
that Vilma received no part of the loan. May Vilma be held
liable? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, Vilma may be held liable. Vilma is an accommodation
party. As such, she is liable on the instrument to a holder
for value such as BUR Bank. This is true even if BUR Bank
was aware at the time it took the instrument that Vilma is
merely an accommodation party and received no part of the
loan (See Sec 29, NIL; Eulalio Prudencio v CA GR L-34539, Jul 14, 86
143 s 7)
Parties; Accommodation Party (1998)
For the purpose of lending his name without receiving
value therefore, Pedro makes a note for P20,000 payable
to the order of X who in turn negotiates it to Y, the latter
knowing that Pedro is not a party for value.
1. May Y recover from Pedro if the latter interposes
the absence of consideration? (3%)
2. Supposing under the same facts, Pedro pays the said
P20,000 may he recover the same amount from X?
(2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. Yes. Y can recover from Pedro. Pedro is an
accommodation party. Absence of consideration is in the
nature of an accommodation. Defense of absence of
consideration cannot be validly interposed by
accommodation party against a holder in due course.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
2. If Pedro pays the said P20,000 to Y, Pedro can recover
the amount from X. X is the accommodated party or the
party ultimately liable for the instrument. Pedro is only an
accommodation party. Otherwise, it would be unjust
enrichment on the part of X if he is not to pay Pedro.
Parties; Accommodation Party (2003)
Susan Kawada borrowed P500,000 from XYZ Bank which
required her, together with Rose Reyes who did not receive
any amount from the bank, to execute a promissory note
payable to the bank, or its order on stated maturities. The
note was executed as so agreed. What kind of liability was
incurred by Rose, that of an accommodation party or that
of a solidary debtor? Explain. (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
(per Dondee) Rose may be held liable. Rose is an
accommodation party. Absence of consideration is in the
nature of an accommodation. Defense of absence of
consideration cannot be validly interposed by
accommodation party against a holder in due course.
Parties; Accommodation Party (2003)
Juan Sy purchased from A Appliance Center one
generator set on installment with chattel mortgage in favor
of the vendor. After getting hold of the generator set, Juan
Sy immediately sold it without consent of the vendor. Juan
Sy was criminally charged with estafa.
To settle the case extra judicially, Juan Sy paid the sum of
P20,000 and for the balance of P5,000.00 he executed a
promissory note for said amount with Ben Lopez as an
accommodation party. Juan Sy failed to pay the balance. 1)
What is the liability of Ben Lopez as an accommodation
party? Explain. 2) What is the liability of Juan Sy?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) Ben Lopez, as an accommodation party, is liable as
maker to the holder up to the sum of P5,000 even if he did
not receive any consideration for the promissory note.
This is the nature of accommodation. But Ben Lopez can
ask for reimbursement from Juan Sy, the accommodation
party.
2) Juan Sy is liable to the extent of P5,000 in the hands of a
holder in due course (Sec 14 NIL). If Ben Lopez paid the
promissory note, Juan Sy has the obligation to reimburse
Ben Lopez for the amount paid. If Juan Sy pays directly to
the holder of the promissory note, or he pays Ben Lopez
for the reimbursement of the payment by the latter to the
holder, the instrument is discharged.
Parties; Accommodation Party (2005)
Dagul has a business arrangement with Facundo. The
latter would lend money to another, through Dagul, whose
name would appear in the promissory note as the lender.
Dagul would then immediately indorse the note to
Facundo. Is Dagul an accommodation party? Explain.
(2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Page 88 of 103 YES! Dagul is an accommodation party
because in the case at bar, he is essentially, a person who
signs as maker without receiving any consideration, signs as
an accommodation party merely for the purpose of lending
the credit of his name. And as an accommodation party he
cannot set up lack of consideration against any holder, even
as to one who is not a holder in due course.
Parties; Holder in Due Course (1993)
Larry issued a negotiable promissory note to Evelyn and
authorized the latter to fill up the amount in blank with his
loan account in the sum of P1,000. However, Evelyn
inserted P5,000 in violation of the instruction. She
negotiated the note to Julie who had knowledge of the
infirmity. Julie in turn negotiated said note to Devi for
value and who had no knowledge of the infirmity. 1) Can
Devi enforce the note against Larry and if she can, for how
much? Explain. 2) Supposing Devi endorses the note to
Baby for value but who has knowledge of the infirmity,
can the latter enforce the note against Larry?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) Yes, Devi can enforce the negotiable promissory note
against Larry in the amount of P5,000. Devi is a holder in
due course and the breach of trust committed by Evelyn
cannot be set up by Larry against Devi because it is a
personal defense. As a holder in due course, Devi is not
subject to such personal defense.
2) Yes. Baby is not a holder in due course because she has
knowledge of the breach of trust committed by Evelyn
against Larry which is just a personal defense. But having
taken the instrument from Devi, a holder in due course,
Baby has all the rights of a holder in due course. Baby did
not participate in the breach of trust committed by Evelyn
who filled the blank but filled up the instrument with
P5,000 instead of P1,000 as instructed by Larry (Sec 58
NIL)
Parties; Holder in Due Course (1996)
What constitutes a holder in due course?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A holder in due course is one who has taken the
instrument under the following conditions:
1 That it is complete and regular upon its face;
2 That he became holder of it before it was
overdue and without notice that it had been previously
dishonored, if such was the fact;
3 That he took it in good faith and for value;
4 That at the time it was negotiated to him, he had
no notice of any infirmity in the instrument or defect in the
title of the person negotiating it. (Sec 52, NIL)
Parties; Holder in Due Course (1996)
1996 2.2) Eva issued to Imelda a check in the amount of
P50th post-dated Sep 30, 1995, as security for a diamond
ring to be sold on commission. On Sep 15, 1995, Imelda
negotiated the check to MT investment which paid the
amount of P40th to her. Eva failed to sell the ring, so she
returned it to Imelda on Sep 19, 1995. Unable to retrieve
her check, Eva withdrew
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
her funds from the drawee bank. Thus, when MT
Investment presented the check for payment, the drawee
bank dishonored it. Later on, when MT Investment sued
her, Eva raised the defense of absence of consideration,
the check having been issued merely as security for the ring
that she could not sell. Does Eva have a valid defense?
Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. Eva does not have a valid defense. First, MT
Investment is a holder in due course and, as such, holds
the postdated check free from any defect of title of prior
parties and from defenses available to prior parties among
themselves. Eva can invoke the defense of absence of
consideration against MT Investment only if the latter was
privy to the purpose for which the checks were issued and,
therefore, not a holder in due course. Second, it is not a
ground for the discharge of the postdated check as against
a holder in due course that it was issued merely as security.
The only grounds for the discharge of negotiable
instruments are those set forth in Sec 119 of the NIL and
none of those grounds are available to Eva. The latter may
not unilaterally discharge herself from her liability by the
mere expediency of withdrawing her funds from the
drawee bank. (State Investments v CA GR 101163, Jan 11, 93
217s32).
Parties; Holder in Due Course (1998)
X makes a promissory note for P10,000 payable to A, a
minor, to help him buy school books. A endorses the note
to B for value, who in turn endorses the note to C. C
knows A is a minor. If C sues X on the note, can X set up
the defenses of minority and lack of consideration? (3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. C is not a holder in due course. The promissory note
is not a negotiable instrument as it does not contain any
word of negotiability, that is, order or bear, or words of
similar meaning or import. Not being a holder in due
course, C is to subject such personal defenses of minority
and lack of consideration. C is a mere assignee who is
subject to all defenses.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
X cannot set up the defense of the minority of A. Defense
of minority is available to the minor only. Such defense is
not available to X.
X cannot set up the defense against C. Lack of
consideration is a personal defense which is only available
between immediate parties or against parties who are not
holders in due course. Cs knowledge that A is a minor
does not prevent C from being a holder in due course. C
took the promissory note from a holder for value, B.
Parties; Holder in Due Course; Indorsement in blank
(2002)
A. AB issued a promissory note for P1,000 payable to CD
or his order on September 15, 2002. CD indorsed the note
in blank and delivered the same to EF. GH stole the note
from EF and on September 14, 2002 presented it to AB
for payment. When asked by AB, GH said CD
Page 89 of 103 gave him the note in payment for two
cavans of rice. AB therefore paid GH P1,00 on the same
date. On September 15, 2002, EF discovered that the note
of AB was not in his possession and he went to AB. It was
then that EF found out that AB had already made payment
on the note. Can EF still claim payment from AB? Why?
(3%)
B. As a sequel to the same facts narrated above, EF, out of
pity for AB who had already paid P1,000.00 to GH,
decided to forgive AB and instead go after CD who
indorsed the note in blank to him. Is CD still liable to EF
by virtue of the indorsement in blank? Why? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A. No. EF cannot claim payment from AB. EF is not a
holder of the promissory note. To make the presentment
for payment, it is necessary to exhibit the instrument,
which EF cannot do because he is not in possession
thereof.
B. No, because CD negotiated the instrument by delivery.
Place of Payment (2000)
PN is the holder of a negotiable promissory note within
the meaning of the Negotiable Instruments Law (Act
2031). The note was originally issued by RP to XL as
payee. XL indorsed the note to PN for goods bought by
XL. The note mentions the place of payment on the
specified maturity date as the office of the corporate
secretary of PX Bank during banking hours. ON maturity
date, RP was at the aforesaid office ready to pay the note
but PN did not show up. What PN later did was to sue XL
for the face value of the note, plus interest and costs. Will
the suit prosper? Explain. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. The suit will prosper as far as the face value of the
note is concerned, but not with respect to the interest due
subsequent to the maturity of the note and the costs of
collection. RP was ready and willing to pay the note at the
specified place of payment on the specified maturity date,
but PN did not show up. PN lost his right to recover the
interest due subsequent to the maturity of the note and the
costs of collection.
Public Service Law
Certificate of public Convenience (1998)
The Batong Bakal Corporation filed with the Board of
Energy an application for a Certificate of Public
Convenience for the purpose of supplying electric power
and lights to the factory and its employees living within the
compound. The application was opposed by the Bulacan
Electric Corporation contending that the Batong Bakal
Corporation has not secured a franchise to operate and
maintain an electric plant. Is the oppositions contention
correct? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. A certificate of public convenience may be granted to
Batong Bakal Corporation, though not possessing a
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
legislative franchise, if it meets all the other requirements.
There is nothing in the law nor the Constitution, which
indicates that a legislative franchise is necessary or required
for an entity to operate as supplier of electric power and
light to its factory and its employees living within the
compound.
Certificate of Public Convenience; inseparability of
certificate and vessel (1992)
Antonio was granted a Certificate of Public Convenience
(CPC) in 1986 to operate a ferry between Mindoro and
Batangas using the motor vessel MV Lotus. He stopped
operations in 1988 due to unserviceability of the vessel. In
1989, Basilio was granted a CPC for the same route. After a
few months, he discovered that Carlos was operating on
his route under Antonios CPC. Because Basilio filed a
complaint for illegal operations with the Maritime Industry
Authority, Antonio and Carlos jointly filed an application
for sale and transfer of Antonios CPC and substitution of
the vessel MV Lotus with another owned by Carlos.
Should Antonios and Carlos joint application be
approved? Giver your reasons.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The joint application of Antonio and Carlos for the sale
and transfer of Antonios CPC and substitution of the
vessel MV Lotus with another vessel owned by the
transferee should not be approved. The certificate of
public convenience and MV Lotus are inseparable. The
unserviceability of the vessel covered by the certificate had
likewise rendered ineffective the certificate itself, and the
holder thereof may not legally transfer the same to
another. (Cohon v CA 188 s 719).
Certificate of Public Convenience; Requirements (1995)
What requirements must be met before a certificate of
public convenience may be granted under the Public
Service Act?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The following are the requirements for the granting of a
certificate of public convenience, to wit: a) The applicant
must be a citizen of the Philippines, or
a corporation, co-partnership or association organized
under the laws of the Philippines and at least 60% of
the stock of paid-up capital of which must belong to
citizens of the Philippines. (Sec 16a, CA 146, as
amended)
b) The applicant must prove public necessity.
c) The applicant must prove that the operation of
the public service proposed and the authorization to do
business will promote the public interest in a proper and
suitable manner. (Sec 16a CA 146 as amended)
d) The applicant must be financially capable of
undertaking the proposed service and meeting the
responsibilities incident to its operation.
Powers of the Public Service Commission (1993)
The City of Manila passed an ordinance banning provincial
buses from the city. The ordinance was challenged as
invalid under the Public Service Act by X
Page 90 of 103 who had a certificate of public
convenience to operate auto-trucks with fixed routes from
certain towns in Bulacan and Rizal to Manila and within
Manila. Firstly, he claimed that the ordinance was null and
void because, among other things, it in effect amends his
certificate of public convenience, a thing which only the
Public Service Commission can do under Sec 16 (m) of the
Public Service Act. Under said section, the Commission is
empowered to amend, modify, or revoke a certificate of
public convenience after notice and hearing. Secondly, he
contended that even if the ordinance was valid, it is only
the Commission which can require compliance with its
provisions under Sec 17 (j) of said Act and since the
implementation of the ordinance was without sanction or
approval of the Commission, its enforcement was
unauthorized and illegal. 1) May the reliance of X on
Section 16 (m) of the Public Service Act be sustained?
Explain. 2) Was X correct in his contention that under
Section 17
(j) of the Public Service Act it is only the Commissioner
which can require compliance with the provisions of the
ordinance? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) No. The power vested in the Public Service Commission
under Sec 16m is subordinate to the authority of the City of
Manila under Sec 18 (hh) of its revised charter to
superintend, regulate or control the streets of the city of
Manila. (Lagman v City of Manila 17 s 579) 2) No. The
powers conferred by law upon the Public Service
Commission were not designed to deny or supersede the
regulatory power of local governments over motor traffic
in the streets subject to their control.
(Lagman v City of Manila 17 s 579)
Public utilities (2000)
WWW Communications Inc. is an e-commerce company
whose present business activity is limited to providing its
clients with all types of information technology hardware. It
plans to re-focus its corporate direction of gradually
converting itself into a full convergence organization.
Towards this objective, the company has been aggressively
acquiring telecommunications businesses and broadcast
media enterprises, and consolidating their corporate
structures. The ultimate plan is to have only two
organizations: one to own the facilities of the combined
businesses and to develop and produce content materials,
and another to operate the facilities and provide mass media
and commercial telecommunications services. WWW
Communications will be the flagship entity which will own
the facilities of the conglomerate and provide content to the
other new corporation which, in turn, will operate those
facilities and provide the services. WWW Communications
seeks your professional advice on whether or not its
reorganized business activity would be considered a public
utility requiring a franchise or certificate or any other form of
authorization from the government. What will be your
advice? Explain (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
The reorganized business activity of WWW
Communications Inc. would not be considered a public
utility requiring a franchise or certificate or any other form
of authorization from the government. It owns the facilities,
but does not operate them.
Revocation of Certificate (1993)
1) Robert is a holder of a certificate of public convenience
to operate a taxicab service in Manila and suburbs. One
evening, one of his taxicab units was boarded by three
robbers as they escaped after staging a hold-up. Because of
said incident, the LTFRB revoked the certificate of public
convenience of Robert on the ground that said operator
failed to render safe, proper and adequate service as
required under Sec 19a of the Public Service Act. a) Was
the revocation of the certificate of public convenience of
Robert justified? Explain. b) When can the Commission
(Board) exercise its power to suspend or revoke certificate
of public convenience?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1a) No. A single hold-up incident which does not link
Roberts taxicab cannot be construed that he rendered a
service that is unsafe, inadequate and improper (Manzanal
v Ausejo 164 s 36)
1b) Under Sec 19a of the Public Service Act, the
Commission (Board) can suspend or revoke a certificate of
public convenience when the operator fails to provide a
service that is safe, proper or adequate, and refuses to
render any service which can be reasonably demanded and
furnished.
Revocation of Certificate (1993)
Pepay, a holder of a certificate of public convenience,
failed to register to the complete number of units required
by her certificate. However, she tried to justify such failure
by the accidents that allegedly befell her, claiming that she
was so shocked and burdened by the successive accidents
and misfortunes that she did not know what she was
doing, she was confused and thrown off tangent
momentarily, although she always had the money and
financial ability to buy new trucks and repair the destroyed
one. Are the reasons given by Pepay sufficient grounds to
excuse her from completing units? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The reasons given by Pepay are not sufficient grounds
to excuse her from completing her units. The same could
be undertaken by her children or by other authorized
representatives (Sec 16n Pub Serv Act; Halili v Herras 10 s
769)
Securities Regulation
Insider (2004)
Ms. OB was employed in MAS Investment Bank. WIC, a
medical drug company, retained the Bank to assess
whether it is desirable to make a tender offer for DOP
company, a drug manufacturer. OB overheard in the
Page 91 of 103 course of her work the plans of WIC. By
herself and thru associates, she purchased DOP stocks
available at the stock exchange priced at P20 per share.
When WIC's tender offer was announced, DOP stocks
jumped to P30 per share. Thus OB earned a sizable profit.
Is OB liable for breach and misuse of confidential or
insider information gained from her employment? Is she
also liable for damages to sellers or buyers with whom she
traded? If so, what is the measure of such damages?
Explain briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
OB is an insider (as defined in Subsection 3.8(3) of the
Securities Regulation Code) since she is an employee of the
Bank, the financial adviser of DOP, and this relationship
gives her access to material information about the issuer
(DOP) and the latter's securities (shares), which
information is not generally available to the public.
Accordingly, OB is guilty of insider trading under Section
27 of the Securities Regulation Code, which requires
disclosure when trading in securities.
OB is also liable for damages to sellers or buyers with
whom she traded. Under Subsection 63.1 of the Securities
Regulation Code, the damages awarded could be an amount
not exceeding triple the amount of the transaction plus
actual damages. Exemplary damages may also be awarded
in case of bad faith, fraud, malevolence or wantonness in
the violation of the Securities Regulation Code or its
implementing rules. The court is also authorized to award
attorney's fees not exceeding 30% of the award.
Insider Trading (1995)
Under the Revised Securities Act, it is unlawful for an
insider to sell or buy a security of the issuer if he knows a
fact of special significance with respect to the issuer or the
security that is not generally available, without disclosing
such fact to the other party. 3.a) What does the term
insider mean as used in the Revised Securities act? 3.b)
When is a fact considered to be of special significance
under the same Act? 3.c) What are the liabilities of a person
who violates the pertinent provisions of the Revised
Securities Act regarding the unfair use of inside
information?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
3a. Insider means 1) the issuer, 2) a director or officer
of, or a person controlling, controlled by, or under
common control with, the issuer, 3) a person whose
relationship or former relationship to the issuer gives or
gave him access to a fact of special significance about the
issuer or the security that is not generally available, or 4) a
person who learns such a fact from any of the foregoing
insiders with knowledge that the person from whom he
learns the fact is such an insider (Sec 30b, RSA)
3b. It is one which, in addition to being material, would be
likely to affect the market price of a security to a
significant extent on being made generally available, or one
which a reasonable person would consider especially
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
important under the circumstances in determining his
course of action in the light of such factors as the degree
of its specificity, the extent of its difference from
information generally available previously, and its nature
and reliability. (Sec. 30c, RSA)
3c. The person may be liable to 1) a fine of not less than
P5th nor more than P500th or 2) imprisonment of not
less than 7 years nor more than 21 years, 3) or both such
fine and imprisonment in the discretion of the court.
If the person is a corporation, partnership, association or
other juridical entity, the penalty shall be imposed upon
the officers of the corporation, etc. responsible for the
violation. And if such an officer is an alien, he shall, in
addition to the penalties prescribed, be deported without
further proceedings after service of sentence. (Sec 56 RSA)
Insider Trading; Manipulative Practices (1994)
1) Give a case where a person who is not an issuing
corporation, director or officer thereof, or a person
controlling, controlled by or under common control with
the issuing corporation, is also considered an insider. 2)
In Securities Law, what is a shortswing transaction. 3) In
insider trading, what is a fact of special significance?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) It may be a case where a person, whose relationship or
former relationship to the issuer gives or gave him access
to a fact of special significance about the issuer or the
security that is not generally available, or a person, who
learns such a fact from any of the insiders, with knowledge
that the person from whom he learns the fact, is such an
insider (Sec 30, par (b) Rev Securities Act)
2) A shortswing is a transaction where a person buys
securities and sells or disposes of the same within a period
of six (6) months.
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
2) It is a purchase by any person for the issuer or any
person controlling, controlled by, or under common
control with the issuer, or a purchase subject to the
control of the issuer or any such person, resulting in
beneficial ownership of more than 10% of any class of
shares (Sec 32 R Sec Act)
3) In insider trading, a fact of special significance is, in
addition to being material, such fact as would likely, on
being made generally available, to affect the market price of
a security to a significant extent, or which a reasonable
person would consider as especially important under the
circumstances in determining his course of action in the
light of such factors as the degree of its specificity, the
extent of its difference from information generally available
previously, and its nature and reliability (Sec 30 par c
RSecAct)
Manipulative Practices (2001)
Suppose A is the owner of several inactive securities. To
create an appearance of active trading for such securities,
Page 92 of 103 A connives with B by which A will offer
for sale some of his securities and B will buy them at a
certain fixed price, with the understanding that although
there would be an apparent sale, A will retain the beneficial
ownership thereof. a) Is the arrangement lawful? (3%) b) If
the sale materializes, what is it called? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) No. The arrangement is not lawful. It is an artificial
manipulation of the price of securities. This is prohibited
by the Securities Regulation Code. b) If the sale
materializes, it is called a wash sale or simulated sale.
Securities Regulation Code; Purpose (1998)
What is the principal purpose of laws and regulations
governing securities in the Philippines? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The principal purpose of laws and regulations governing
securities in the Philippines is to protect the public against
the nefarious practices of unscrupulous brokers and
salesmen in selling securities.
Securities; Definition (1996)
Define securities
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Stocks, bonds notes, convertible debentures, warrants or
other documents that represent a share in a company or a
debt owned by a company or government entity.
Evidences of obligations to pay money or of rights to
participate in earnings and distribution of corporate assets.
Instruments giving to their legal holders rights to money or
other property; they are therefore instruments which have
intrinsic value and are recognized and used as such in
the regular channels of commerce.
(Note: Sec 2a of the Revised Securities Act does not really define
the term securities.)
Securities; Selling of Securities; Meaning (2002)
2002 (18) Equity Online Corporation (EOL), a New York
corporation, has a securities brokerage service on the
Internet after obtaining all requisite U.S. licenses and
permits to do so. EOLs website (www.eonline..com),
which is hosted by a server in Florida, enables Internet
users to trade on-line in securities listed in the various stock
exchanges in the U.S. EOL buys and sells U.S. listed
securities for the accounts of its clients all over the world,
who convey their buy and sell instructions to EOL through
the Internet. EOL has no offices, employees or
representatives outside the U.S. The website has icons for
many countries, including an icon For Filipino Traders
containing the days prices of U.S. listed securities
expressed in U.S. dollars and their Philippine peso
equivalent. Grace Gonzales, a resident of Makati, is a
regular customer of the website and has been purchasing
and selling securities through EOL with the use of her
American Express credit card. Grace has never traveled
outside the Philippines. After a series of erroneous stock
picks, she had incurred a net indebtedness of US$30,000.
with EOL, at which time she cancelled her American
Express credit card. After a
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
number of demand letters sent to Grace, all of them
unanswered, EOL, through a Makati law firm, filed a
complaint for collection against Grace with the Regional
Trial Court of Makati. Grace, through her lawyer, filed a
motion to dismiss on the ground that EOL (a) was doing
business in the Philippines without a license and was
therefore barred from bringing suit and (b) violated the
Securities Regulation Code by selling or offering to sell
securities within the Philippines without registering the
securities with the Philippine SEC and thus came to court
with unclean hands. EOL opposed the motion to
dismiss, contending that it had never established a physical
presence in the Philippines, and that all of the activities
related to plaintiffs trading in U.S. securities all transpired
outside the Philippines. If you are the judge, decide the
motion to dismiss by ruling on the respective contentions
of the parties on the basis of the facts presented above.
(10%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The grounds of the motion to dismiss are both untenable.
EOL is not doing business in the Philippines, and it did not
violate the Securites Act, because it was not selling
securities in the country.
The contention of EOL is correct, because it never did
any business in the Philippines. All its transactions in
question were consummated outside the Philippines.
Tender Offer (2002)
2002 (6)
A. What is a tender offer?
B. In what instances is a tender offer required to be made?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A. Tender offer is a publicly announced intention of a
person acting alone or in concert with other persons to
acquire equity securities of a public company. It may also
be defined as a method of taking over a company by
asking stockholders to sell their shares at a price higher
than the current market price and on a particular date.
B. Instances where tender offer is required to be made:
a) The person intends to acquire 15% or more of
the equity share of a public company pursuant
to an agreement made between or among the
person and one or more sellers.
b) The person intends to acquire 30% or more of
the equity shares of a public company within a
period of 12 months.
c) The person intends to acquire equity shares
of a public company that would result in ownership
of more than 50% of the said shares.
Transportation Law
Boundary System (2005)
Baldo is a driver of Yellow Cab Company under the
boundary system. While cruising along the South
Expressway, Baldos cab figured in a collision, killing his
Page 93 of 103 passenger, Pietro. The heirs of Pietro
sued Yellow Cab Company for damages, but the latter
refused to pay the heirs, insisting that it is not liable
because Baldo is not its employee. Resolve with reasons.
(2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yellow Cab Company shall be liable with Baldo, on a
solidary basis, for the death of passenger Pietro. Baldo is
an employee of Yellow Cab under the boundary system.
As such, the death of passenger Pietro is breach of
contract of carriage, making both the common carrier
Yellow Cab and its employee, Baldo, solidarily liable.
(Hernandez v. Dolor, G.R, No. 160286, July 30, 2004)
Carriage; Breach of Contract; Presumption of
Negligence (1990)
Peter so hailed a taxicab owned and operated by Jimmy
Cheng and driven by Hermie Cortez. Peter asked Cortez
to take him to his office in Malate. On the way to Malate,
the taxicab collided with a passenger jeepney, as a result of
which Peter was injured, i.e., he fractured his left leg. Peter
sued Jimmy for damages, based upon a contract of
carriage, and Peter won. Jimmy wanted to challenge the
decision before the SC on the ground that the trial court
erred in not making an express finding as to whether or
not Jimmy was responsible for the collision and, hence,
civilly liable to Peter. He went to see you for advice. What
will you tell him? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
I will counsel Jimmy to desist from challenging the
decision. The action of Peter being based on culpa
contractual, the carriers negligence is presumed upon the
breach of contract. The burden of proof instead would lie
on Jimmy to establish that despite an exercise of utmost
diligence the collision could not have been avoided.
Carriage; Breach of Contract; Presumption of
Negligence (1997)
In a court case involving claims for damages arising from
death and injury of bus passengers, counsel for the bus
operator files a demurrer to evidence arguing that the
complaint should be dismissed because the plaintiffs did
not submit any evidence that the operator or its employees
were negligent. If you were the judge, would you dismiss
the complaint?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. In the carriage of passengers, the failure of the
common carrier to bring the passengers safely to their
destination immediately raises the presumption that such
failure is attributable to the carriers fault or negligence. In
the case at bar, the fact of death and injury of the bus
passengers raises the presumption of fault or negligence
on the part of the carrier. The carrier must rebut such
presumption. Otherwise, the conclusion can be properly
made that the carrier failed to exercise extraordinary
diligence as required by law.
Carriage; Fortuitous Event (1995)
M. Dizon Trucking entered into a hauling contract with
Fairgoods Co whereby the former bound itself to haul the
latters 2000 sacks of Soya bean meal from Manila
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Port Area to Calamba, Laguna. To carry out faithfully its
obligation Dizon subcontracted with Enrico Reyes the
delivery of 400 sacks of the Soya bean meal. Aside from
the driver, three male employees of Reyes rode on the
truck with the cargo. While the truck was on its way to
Laguna two strangers suddenly stopped the truck and
hijacked the cargo. Investigation by the police disclosed
that one of the hijackers was armed with a bladed weapon
while the other was unarmed. For failure to deliver the 400
sacks, Fairgoods sued Dizon for damages. Dizon in turn
set up a 3rd party complaint against Reyes which the latter
registered on the ground that the loss was due to force
majeure. Did the hijacking constitute force majeure to
exculpate Reyes from any liability to Dizon? Discuss fully.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The hijacking in this case cannot be considered force
majeure. Only one of the two hijackers was armed with a
bladed weapon. As against the 4 male employees of Reyes,
2 hijackers, with only one of them being armed with a
bladed weapon, cannot be considered force majeure. The
hijackers did not act with grave or irresistible threat,
violence or force.
Carriage; Liability; Lost Baggage or Acts of Passengers
(1997)
1997 (15) Antonio, a paying passenger, boarded a bus
bound for Batangas City. He chose a seat at the front row,
near the bus driver, and told the bus driver that he had
valuable items in his hand carried bag which he then
placed beside the drivers seat. Not having slept for 24
hours, he requested the driver to keep an eye on the bag
should he doze off during the trip. While Antonio was
asleep, another passenger took the bag away and alighted
at Calamba, Laguna. Could the common carrier be held
liable by Antonio for the loss?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. Ordinarily, the common carrier is not liable for acts of
other passengers. But the common carrier cannot relieve
itself from liability if the common carriers employees
could have prevented the act or omission by exercising due
diligence. In this case, the passenger asked the driver to
keep an eye on the bag which was placed beside the
drivers seat. If the driver exercised due diligence, he could
have prevented the loss of the bag.
Carriage; Prohibited & Valid Stipulations (2002)
Discuss whether or not the following stipulations in a
contract of carriage of a common carrier are valid:
1 a stipulation limiting the sum that may be recovered by
the shipper or owner to 90% of the value of the goods in case of
loss due to theft.
2 a stipulation that in the event of loss, destruction or
deterioration of goods on account of the defective condition of
the vehicle used in the contract of carriage, the carriers liability is
limited to the value of the goods appearing in the bill of lading
unless the shipper or owner declares a higher value (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Page 94 of 103
1 The stipulation is considered unreasonable,
unjust and contrary to public policy under Article 1745 of
the Civil Code.
2 The stipulation limiting the carriers liability to
the value of the goods appearing in the bill of lading
unless the shipper or owner declares a higher value, is
expressly recognized in Article 1749 of the Civil Code.
Carriage; Valuation of Damaged Cargo (1993)
A shipped thirteen pieces of luggage through LG Airlines
from Teheran to Manila as evidenced by LG Air Waybill
which disclosed that the actual gross weight of the luggage
was 180 kg. Z did not declare an inventory of the contents
or the value of the 13 pieces of luggage. After the said
pieces of luggage arrived in Manila, the consignee was able
to claim from the cargo broker only 12 pieces, with a total
weight of 174 kg. X advised the airline of the loss of one of
the 13 pieces of luggage and of the contents thereof.
Efforts of the airline to trace the missing luggage were
fruitless. Since the airline failed to comply with the demand
of X to produce the missing luggage, X filed an action for
breach of contract with damages against LG Airlines. In its
answer, LG Airlines alleged that the Warsaw Convention
which limits the liability of the carrier, if any, with respect
to cargo to a sum of $20 per kilo or $9.07 per pound,
unless a higher value is declared in advance and additional
charges are paid by the passenger and the conditions of the
contract as set forth in the air waybill, expressly subject the
contract of the carriage of cargo to the Warsaw
Convention. May the allegation of LG Airlines be
sustained? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes. Unless the contents of a cargo are declared or the
contents of a lost luggage are proved by the satisfactory
evidence other than the self-serving declaration of one
party, the contract should be enforced as it is the only
reasonable basis to arrive at a just award. The passenger or
shipper is bound by the terms of the passenger ticket or
the waybill. (Panama v Rapadas 209 s 67)
Common Carrier (1996)
Define a common carrier?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
A common carrier is a person, corporation, firm or
association engaged in the business of carrying or
transporting passengers or goods or both, by land, water or
air for compensation, offering its services to the public
(Art 1732, Civil Code)
Common Carrier; Breach of Contract; Damages (2003)
Vivian Martin was booked by PAL, which acted as a
ticketing agent of Far East Airlines, for a round trip flight
on the latters aircraft, from Manila-Hongkong-Manila.
The ticket was cut by an employee of PAL. The ticket
showed that Vivian was scheduled to leave Manila at 5:30
p.m. on 05 January 2002 aboard Far Easts Flight F007.
Vivian arrived at the Ninoy Aquino International Airport
an hour before the time scheduled in her ticket, but was
told that Far Easts Flight F007 had left at 12:10 p.m. It
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
turned out that the ticket was inadvertently cut and
wrongly worded. PAL employees manning the airports
ground services nevertheless scheduled her to fly two
hours later aboard their plane. She agreed and arrived in
Hongkong safely. The aircraft used by Far East Airlines
developed engine trouble, and did not make it to
Hongkong but returned to Manila. Vivian sued both
airlines, PAL and Far East, for damages because of her
having unable to take the Far East flight. Could either or
both airlines be held liable to Vivian? Why? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
(per dondee) No, there was breach of contract and that
she was accommodated well with the assistance of PAL
employees to take the flight without undue delay.
Common Carrier; Defenses (2002)
Why is the defense of due diligence in the selection and
supervision of an employee not available to a common
carrier? (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The defense of due diligence in the selection and
supervision of an employee is not available to a common
carrier because the degree of diligence required of a
common carrier is not the diligence of a good father of a
family but extraordinary diligence, i.e., diligence of the
greatest skill and utmost foresight.
Common Carrier; Defenses; Fortuitous Events (1994)
Marites, a paying bus passenger, was hit above her left eye
by a stone hurled at the bus by an unidentified bystander
as the bus was speeding through the National Highway.
The bus owners personnel lost no time in bringing
Marites to the provincial hospital where she was confined
and treated. Marites wants to sue the bus company for
damages and seeks your advice whether she can legally
hold the bus company liable. What will you advise her?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Marites can not legally hold the bus company liable. There
is no showing that any such incident previously happened
so as to impose an obligation on part of the personnel of
the bus company to warn the passengers and to take the
necessary precaution. Such hurling of a stone constitutes
fortuitous event in this case. The bus company is not an
insurer. (Pilapil v CA 180 s 346)
Common Carrier; Defenses; Limitation of Liability (1998)
X took a plane from Manila bound for Davao via Cebu
where there was a change of planes. X arrived in Davao
safely but to his dismay, his two suitcases were left behind
in Cebu. The airline company assured X that the suitcases
would come in the next flight but they never did. X
claimed P2,000 for the loss of both suitcases, but the
airline was willing to pay only P500 because the airline
ticket stipulated that unless a higher value was declared,
any claim for loss cannot exceed P250 for each piece of
luggage. X reasoned out that he did not sign the stipulation
and in fact had not even read it.
Page 95 of 103 X did not declare a greater value despite
the fact that the clerk had called his attention to the
stipulation in the ticket. Decide the case (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Even if he did not sign the ticket, X is bound by the
stipulation that any claim for loss cannot exceed P250 for
each luggage. He did not declare a higher value. X is
entitled to P500 for the two luggages lost.
Common Carrier; Defenses; Limitation of Liability (2001)
Suppose A was riding on an airplane of a common carrier
when the accident happened and A suffered serious
injuries. In an action by A against the common carrier, the
latter claimed that 1) there was a stipulation in the ticket
issued to A absolutely exempting the carrier from liability
from the passengers death or injuries ad notices were
posted by the common carrier dispensing with the
extraordinary diligence of the carrier, and 2) A was given
a discount on his plane fare thereby reducing the liability
of the common carrier with respect to A in particular. a)
Are those valid defenses? (1%) b) What are the defenses
available to any common carrier to limit or exempt it from
liability? (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) No. These are not valid defenses because they are
contrary to law as they are in violation of the extraordinary
diligence required of common carriers. (Article 1757, 1758
New Civil Code)
b) The defenses available to any common carrier to limit
or exempt it from liability are:
1 observance of extraordinary diligence,
2 or the proximate cause of the incident is a
fortuitous event or force majeure,
3 act or omission of the shipper or owner of
the goods,
4 the character of the goods or defects in the
packing or in the containers, and
5 order or act of competent public authority,
without the common carrier being guilty of even
simple negligence (Article 1734, NCC).
Common Carrier; Duration of Liability (1996)
A bus of GL Transit on its way to Davao stopped to
enable a passenger to alight. At that moment, Santiago,
who had been waiting for a ride, boarded the bus.
However, the bus driver failed to notice Santiago who was
still standing on the bus platform, and stepped on the
accelerator. Because of the sudden motion, Santiago
slipped and fell down suffering serious injuries. May
Santiago hold GL Transit liable for breach of contract of
carriage? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Santiago may hold GL Transit liable for breach of contract
of carriage. It was the duty of the driver, when he stopped
the bus, to do no act that would have the effect of
increasing the peril to a passenger such as Santiago while
he was attempting to board the same. When a bus is not in
motion there is no necessity for a
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
person who wants to ride the same to signal his intention
to board. A public utility bus, once it stops, is in effect
making a continuous offer to bus riders. It is the duty of
common carriers of passengers to stop their conveyances
for a reasonable length of time in order to afford
passengers an opportunity to board and enter, and they are
liable for injuries suffered by boarding passengers resulting
from the sudden starting up or jerking of their conveyances
while they are doing so. Santiago, by stepping and standing
on the platform of the bus, is already considered a
passenger and is entitled to all the rights and protection
pertaining to a contract of carriage.
(Dangwa Trans Co v CA 95582 Oct 7,91 202s574)
Common Carrier; Duty to Examine Baggages; Railway
and Airline (1992)
Marino was a passenger on a train. Another passenger,
Juancho, had taken a gallon of gasoline placed in a plastic
bag into the same coach where Marino was riding. The
gasoline ignited and exploded causing injury to Marino who
filed a civil suit for damages against the railway company
claiming that Juancho should have been subjected to
inspection by its conductor. The railway company
disclaimed liability resulting from the explosion contending
that it was unaware of the contents of the plastic bag and
invoking the right of Juancho to privacy. a) Should the
railway company be held liable for damages? b) If it were
an airline company involved, would your answer be the
same? Explain briefly.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) No. The railway company is not liable for damages. In
overland transportation, the common carrier is not bound
nor empowered to make an examination on the contents of
packages or bags, particularly those handcarried by
passengers.
b) If it were an airline company, the common carrier should
be made liable. In case of air carriers, it is not lawful to
carry flammable materials in passenger aircrafts, and airline
companies may open and investigate suspicious packages
and cargoes (RA 6235)
Common Carrier; Test (1996)
What is the test for determining whether or not one is a
common carrier?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The test for determining whether or not one is a common
carrier is whether the person or entity, for some business
purpose and with general or limited clientele, offers the
service of carrying or transporting passengers or goods or
both for compensation.
Common Carriers; Defenses (1996)
1) AM Trucking, a small company, operates two trucks for
hire on selective basis. It caters only to a few customers,
and its trucks do not make regular or scheduled trips. It
does not even have a certificate of public convenience.
Page 96 of 103 On one occasion, Reynaldo contracted
AM to transport for a fee, 100 sacks of rice from Manila to
Tarlac. However, AM failed to deliver the cargo, because
its truck was hijacked when the driver stopped in Bulacan
to visit his girlfriend.
a) May Reynaldo hold AM liable as a common
carrier?
b) May AM set up the hijacking as a defense to
defeat Reynaldos claim?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) Reynaldo may hold AM Trucking liable as a common
carrier. The facts that AM Trucking operates only two
trucks for hire on a selective basis, caters only to a few
customers, does not make regular or scheduled trips, and
does not have a certificate of public convenience are of no
moment as
the law does not distinguish between one whose
principal business activity is the carrying of persons or
goods or both and anyone who does such carrying only as
an ancillary activity,
the law avoids making any distinction between a
person or enterprise offering transportation service on a
regular or scheduled basis and one offering such service on
an occasional, episodic or unscheduled basis, and
the law refrains from making a distinction between
a carrier offering its services to the general public and one
who offers services or solicits business only from a narrow
segment of the general population
(Pedro de Guzman v CA L-47822 Dec 22,88 168s612)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
b) AM Trucking may not set up the hijacking as a defense
to defeat Reynaldos claim as the facts given do not
indicate that the same was attended by the use of grave or
irresistible threat, violence, or force. It would appear that
the truck was left unattended by its driver and was taken
while he was visiting his girlfriend. (Pedro de Guzman v CA
L-47822 Dec 22,88 168 scra 612).
Common Carriers; Liability for Loss (1991)
Alejandor Camaling of Alegria, Cebu, is engaged in buying
copra, charcoal, firewood, and used bottles and in reselling
them in Cebu City. He uses 2 big Isuzu trucks for the
purpose; however, he has no certificate of public
convenience or franchise to do business as a common
carrier. On the return trips to Alegria, he loads his trucks
with various merchandise of other merchants in Alegria
and the neighboring municipalities of Badian and Ginatilan.
He charges them freight rates much lower than the regular
rates. In one of the return trips, which left Cebu City at
8:30 p.m. 1 cargo truck was loaded with several boxes of
sardines, valued at P100th, belonging to one of his
customers, Pedro Rabor. While passing the zigzag road
between Carcar and Barili, Cebu, which is midway between
Cebu City and Alegria, the truck was hijacked by 3 armed
men who took all the boxes of
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
sardines and kidnapped the driver and his helper, releasing
them in Cebu City only 2 days later.
Pedro Rabor sought to recover from Alejandro the value
of the sardines. The latter contends that he is not liable
therefore because he is not a common carrier under the
Civil Code and, even granting for the sake of argument
that he is, he is not liable for the occurrence of the loss as
it was due to a cause beyond his control. If you were the
judge, would you sustain the contention of Alejandro?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
If I were the Judge, I would hold Alejandro as having
engaged as a common carrier. A person who offers his
services to carry passengers or goods for a fee is a
common carrier regardless of whether he has a certificate
of public convenience or not, whether it is his main
business or incidental to such business, whether it is
scheduled or unscheduled service, and whether he offers
his services to the general public or to a limited few (De
Guzman v CA GR 47822 27Dec1988)
I will however, sustain the contention of Alejandro that he
is not liable for the loss of the goods. A common carrier is
not an insurer of the cargo. If it can be established that the
loss, despite the exercise of extraordinary diligence, could
not have been avoided, liability does not ensue against the
carrier. The hijacking by 3 armed men of the truck used by
Alejandro is one of such cases (De Guzman v CA GR 47822
27Dec1988).
Common vs. Private Carrier; Defenses (2002)
Name two (2) characteristics which differentiate a common
carrier from a private carrier. (3%).
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Two (2) characteristics that differentiate a common carrier
from a private carrier are:
1 A common carrier offers its service to the public; a
private carrier does not.
2 A common carrier is required to observe extraordinary
diligence; a private carrier is not so required.
Kabit System (2005)
Discuss the kabit system in land transportation and its
legal consequences. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The kabit system is an arrangement where a person
granted a certificate of public convenience allows other
persons to operate their motor vehicles under his license,
for a fee or percentage of their earnings (Lim v. Court of Appeals
and Gonzalez, G.R, No. 125817, January 16, 2002, citing Baliwag
Trannit v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 57493, January 7, 1987) The
law enjoining the kabit system aims to identify the person
responsible for an accident in order to protect the riding
public. The policy has no force when the public at large is
neither deceived nor involved.
The law does not penalize the parties to a kabit agreement.
But the kabit system is contrary to public
Page 97 of 103 policy and therefore void and inexistent.
(Art. 1409[1], Civil Code)
Kabit System; Agent of the Registered Owner (2005)
Procopio purchased an Isuzu passenger jeepney from
Enteng, a holder of a certificate of public convenience for
the operation of public utility vehicle plying the
Calamba-Los Baos route. While Procopio continued
offering the jeepney for public transport services, he did
not have the registration of the vehicle transferred in his
name. Neither did he secure for himself a certificate of
public convenience for its operation. Thus, per the records
of the Land Transportation Franchising and Regulatory
Board, Enteng remained its registered owner and operator.
One day, while the jeepney was traveling southbound, it
collided with a ten-wheeler truck owned by Emmanuel.
The driver of the truck admitted responsibility for the
accident, explaining that the truck lost its brakes.
Procopio sued Emmanuel for damages, but the latter
moved to dismiss the case on the ground that Procopio is
not the real party in interest since he is not the registered
owner of the jeepney. Resolve the motion with reasons.
(3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The motion to dismiss should be denied because Procopio,
as the real owner of the jeepney, is the real party in interest.
Procopio falls under the Kabit system. However, the legal
restriction as regards the Kabit system does not apply in
this case because the public at large is not deceived nor
involved. (Lim v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 125817, January
16, 2002, citing Baliwag Transit v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No.
57493, January 7, 1987)
In any event, Procoprio is deemed to be "the agent" of the
registered owner. (First Malayan Leasing v. Court of Appeals,
G.R. No. 91378, June 9,1992; and "F" Transit Co., Inc. v.
NLRC, G.R. Nos, 88195-96, January 27, 1994)
Maritime Commerce; Bareboat (2003)
For the transportation of its cargo from the Port of Manila
to the Port of Kobe, Japan, Osawa & Co., chartered
bareboat M/V Ilog of Karagatan Corporation. M/V Ilog
met a sea accident resulting in the loss of the cargo and the
death of some of the seamen manning the vessel. Who
should bear the loss of the cargo and the death of the
seamen? Why? (4%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
(per Dondee) Osawa and Co. shall bear the loss because
under a demise or bareboat charter, the charterer (Osawa
& Co.) mans the vessel with his own people and becomes,
in effect, the owner for the voyage or service stipulated,
subject to liability for damages caused by negligence.
Prior Operator Rule (2003)
Bayan Bus Lines had been operating satisfactorily a bus
service over the route Manila to Tarlac and vice versa via
the McArthur Highway. With the upgrading of the new
North Expressway, Bayan Bus Lines service became
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
seemingly inadequate despite its efforts of improving the
same. Pasok Transportation, Inc., now applies for the
issuance to it by the Land Transportation Franchising and
Regulatory Board of a certificate of public convenience for
the same Manila-Tarlac-Manila route. Could Bayan Bus
Lines, Inc., invoke the prior operator rules against Pasok
Transportation, Inc.? Why? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
(per Dondee) No, Bayan Bus Lines, Inc., cannot invoke
the prior operator rules against Pasok Transportation,
Inc. because such Prior or Old Operator Rule under the
Public Service Act only applies as a policy of the law of the
Public Service Commission to issue a certificate of public
convenience to a second operator when prior operator is
rendering sufficient, adequate and satisfactory service, and
who in all things and respects is complying with the rule
and regulation of the Commission. In the facts of the case
at bar, Bayan Bus Lines service became seemingly
inadequate despite its efforts of improving the same.
Hence, in the interest of providing efficient public
transport services, the use of the 'prior operator' and the
'priority of filing' rules shall is untenable n this case.
Registered Owner; Conclusive Presumption (1990)
Johnny owns a Sarao jeepney. He asked his neighbor Van if
he could operate the said jeepney under Vans certificate of
public convenience. Van agreed and, accordingly, Johnny
registered his jeepney under Van name. On June 10, 1990,
one of the passenger jeepneys operated by Van bumped
Tomas. Tomas was injured and in due time, he filed a
complaint for damages against Van and his driver for the
injuries he suffered. The court rendered judgment in favor
of Tomas and ordered Van and his driver, jointly and
severally, to pay Tomas actual and moral damages,
attorneys fees, and costs.
The Sheriff levied on the jeepney belonging to Johnny but
registered in the name of Van. Johnny filed a 3rd party
claim with the Sheriff alleging ownership of the jeepney
levied upon and stating that the jeepney was registered in
the name of Van merely to enable Johnny to make use of
Vans certificate of public convenience. May the Sheriff
proceed with the public auction of Johnnys jeepney.
Discuss with reasons.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Yes, the Sheriff may proceed with the auction sale of
Johnnys jeepney. In contemplation of law as regards the
public and third persons, the vehicle is considered the
property of the registered operator (Santos v Sibug 104 S 520)
Trans-Shipment; Bill of Lading; binding contract (1993)
JRT Inc entered into a contract with C Co of Japan to
export anahaw fans valued at $23,000. As payment thereof,
a letter of credit was issued to JRT by the buyer. The letter
of credit required the issuance of an on-board bill of lading
and prohibited the transshipment. The President of JRT
then contracted a shipping agent to ship the anahaw fans
through O Containers Lines, specifying the requirements
of the letter of credit. However, the bill of lading issued by
the shipping lines bore the notation
Page 98 of 103 received for shipment and contained an
entry indicating transshipment in Hongkong. The President
of JRT personally received and signed the bill of lading and
despite the entries, he delivered the corresponding check in
payment of the freight. The shipment was delivered at the
port of discharge but the buyer refused to accept the
anahaw fans because there was no on-board bill of lading,
and there was transshipment since the goods were
transferred in Hongkong from MV Pacific, the feeder
vessel, to MV Oriental, a mother vessel. JRT argued that
the same cannot be considered transshipment because both
vessels belong to the same shipping company. 1) Was there
transshipment? Explain 2) JRT further argued that
assuming that there was transshipment, it cannot be
deemed to have agreed thereto even if it signed the bill of
lading containing such entry because it was made known to
the shipping lines from the start that transshipment was
prohibited under the letter of credit and that, therefore, it
had no intention to allow transshipment of the subject
cargo. Is the argument tenable? Reason.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) Yes. Transshipment is the act of taking cargo out of one
ship and loading it in another. It is immaterial whether or
not the same person, firm, or entity owns the two vessels.
(Magellan v CA 201 s 102)
2) No. JRT is bound by the terms of the bill of lading
when it accepted the bill of lading with full knowledge of
its contents which included transshipment in Hongkong.
Acceptance under such circumstances makes the bill of
lading a binding contract. (Magellan v Ca 201 s 102)
Trust Receipts Law
Trust Receipts Law; Acts & Omissions; Covered (2006)
What acts or omissions are penalized under the Trust
Receipts Law? (2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The Trust Receipts Law (P.D. No. 115) declares the failure
to turn over goods or proceeds realized from sale thereof,
as a criminal offense under Art. 315(l)(b) of Revised Penal
Code. The law is violated whenever the entrustee or
person to whom trust receipts were issued fails to: (a)
return the goods covered by the trust receipts; or (b)
return the proceeds of the sale of said goods
(Metropolitan Bank v. Tonda, G.R. No. 134436, August 16, 2000).
Is lack of intent to defraud a bar to the prosecution of
these acts or omissions? (2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. The Trust Receipts Law is violated whenever the
entrustee fails to: (1) turn over the proceeds of the sale of
the goods, or (2) return the goods covered by the trust
receipts if the goods are not sold. The mere failure to
account or return gives rise to the crime which is malum
prohibitum. There is no requirement to prove intent to
defraud (Ching v. Secretary of Justice, G.R. No. 164317, February 6,
2006; Colinares v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 90828, September 5,
2000; Ong v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 119858, April 29, 2003).
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
Trust Receipts Law; Liability for estafa (1991)
Mr. Noble, as the President of ABC Trading Inc executed
a trust receipt in favor of BPI Bank to secure the
importation by his company of certain goods. After release
and sale of the imported goods, the proceeds from the sale
were not turned over to BPI. Would BPI be justified in
filing a case for estafa against Noble?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
BPI would be justified in filing a case for estafa under PD
115 against Noble. The fact that the trust receipt was
issued in favor of a bank, instead of a seller, to secure the
importation of the goods did not preclude the application
of the Trust Receipt Law. (PD 115) Under the law, any
officer or employee of a corporation responsible for the
violation of a trust receipt is subject to the penal liability
thereunder (Sia v People 166s655)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
The filing of a case for estafa under the penal provisions of
the RPC would not be justified. It has been held in Sia v
People (161 s 655) that corporate officers and directors are
not criminally liable for a violation of said Code. 2
conditions are required before a corporate officer may be
criminally liable for an offense committed by the
corporation; viz:
1 There must be a specific provision of law
mandating a corporation to act or not to act; and
2 There must be an explicit statement in the law itself
that, in case of such violation by a corporation, the officers
and directors thereof are to be personally and criminally
liable therefore.
These conditions are not met in the penal provisions of
the RPC on trust receipts.
Trust Receipts Law; Liability for Estafa (1997)
A buys goods from a foreign supplier using his credit line
with a bank to pay for the goods. Upon arrival of the goods
at the pier, the bank requires A to sign a trust receipt before
A is allowed to take delivery of the goods. The trust receipt
contains the usual language. A disposes of the goods and
receives payment but does not pay the bank. The bank files
a criminal action against A for violation of the Trust Receipts
Law. A asserts that the trust receipt is only to secure his debt
and that a criminal action cannot lie against him because that
would be violative of his constitutional right against
imprisonment for nonpayment of a debt. Is he correct?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. Violation of a trust receipt is criminal as it is punished
as estafa under Art 315 of the RPC. There is a public
policy involved which is to assure the entruster the
reimbursement of the amount advanced or the balance
thereof for the goods subject of the trust receipt. The
execution of the trust receipt or the use thereof promotes
the smooth flow of commerce as it helps the importer or
buyer of the goods covered thereby.
Page 99 of 103
Trusts Receipt Law (2003)
PB & Co., Inc., a manufacturer of steel and steel
products, imported certain raw materials for use by it in
the manufacture of its products. The importation was
effected through a trust receipt arrangement with AB
Banking corporation. When it applied for the issuance by
AB Banking Corporation of a letter of credit, PB & Co.,
Inc., did not make any representation to the bank that it
would be selling what it had imported. It failed to pay the
bank. When demand was made upon it to account for the
importation, to return the articles, or to turn-over the
proceeds of the sale thereof to the bank, PB & Co., Inc.,
also failed. The bank sued PB & Co.s President who was
the signatory of the trust receipt for estafa. The President
put up the defense that he could not be made liable
because there was no deceit resulting in the violation of the
trust receipt. He also submitted that there was no violation
of the trust receipt because the raw materials were not sold
but used by the corporation in the manufacture of its
products. Would those defenses be sustainable? Why? (6%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No, the defenses are not sustainable. The lack of deceit
should not be sustained because the mere failure to
account for the importation, or return the articles
constitutes the abuse of confidence in the crime of estafa.
The fact that the goods arent sold but are used in the
manufacture of its products is immaterial because a
violation of the trust receipts law happened when it failed
to account for the goods or return them to the Bank upon
demand.
Usury Law
Usury Law (199)
Borrower obtained a loan from a money lending enterprise
for which he issued a promissory note undertaking to pay
at the end of a period of 30 days the principal plus interest
at the rate 5.5% per month plus 2% per annum as service
charge.
On maturity of the loan, borrower failed to pay the
principal debt as well as the stipulated interest and service
charge. Hence, he was sued.
1 How would you dispose of the issues raised
by the borrower?
2 That the stipulated interest rate is excessive
and unconscionable? (3%)
3 Is the interest rate usurious? (3%)
Recommendation: Since the subject matter of these two (2) questions is
not included within the scope of the Bar Questions in Mercantile Law,
it is suggested that whatever answer is given by the examinee, or the
lack of answer should be given full credit. If the examinee gives a good
answer, he should be given additional credit.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a. The rate of interest of 5.5% per month is excessive and
unconscionable.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
b. The interest cannot be considered usurious. The Usury
Law has been suspended in its application, and the interest
rates are made floating.
Warehouse Receipts Law
Bill of Lading (1998)
1. What do you understand by a bill of lading? (2%)
2. Explain the two-fold character of a bill of lading.
(3%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1. A bill of lading may be defined as a written
acknowledgement of the receipt of goods and an agreement
to transport and to deliver them at a specified place to a
person named therein or on his order.
2. A bill of lading has a two-fold character, namely, a) it is a
receipt of the goods to be transported; and b) it constitutes a
contract of carriage of the goods.
Delivery of Goods; Requisites (1998)
Luzon Warehousing Co received from Pedro 200 cavans of
rice for deposit in its warehouse for which a negotiable
receipt was issued. While the goods were stored in said
warehouse, Cicero obtained a judgment against Pedro for
the recover of a sum of money. The sheriff proceeded to
levy upon the goods on a writ of execution and directed
the warehouseman to deliver the goods. Is the
warehouseman under obligation to comply with the
sheriffs order? (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. There was a valid negotiable receipt as there was a
valid delivery of 200 cavans of rice for deposit. In such
case, the warehouseman (LWC) is not obliged to deliver
the 200 cavans of rice deposited to any person, except to
the one who can comply with sec 8 of the Warehouse
Receipts Law, namely:
1 surrender the receipt of which he is a holder;
2 willing to sign a receipt for the delivery of the
goods; and
3 pays the warehousemans liens that is, his fees and
advances, if any.
The sheriff cannot comply with these requisites especially
the first, as he is not the holder of the receipt.
Delivery of the Goods (1991)
When is a warehouseman bound to deliver the goods,
upon a demand made either by the holder of a receipt for
the goods or by the depositor?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The warehouseman is bound to deliver the goods upon
demand made either by the holder of the receipt for the
goods or by the depositor if the demand is accompanied
by
1 an offer to satisfy the warehousemans lien,
2 an offer to surrender the receipt, if negotiable, with
such indorsements as would be necessary for the negotiation
thereof,
Page 100 of 103
3. and readiness and willingness to sign when the
goods are delivered if so requested by the warehouseman
(Sec 8 Warehouse Receipts Law).
Garnishment or Attachment of Goods (1999)
A Warehouse Company received for safekeeping 1000 bags
of rice from a merchant. To evidence the transaction, the
Warehouse Company issued a receipt expressly providing
that the goods be delivered to the order of said merchant.
A month after, a creditor obtained judgment against the
said merchant for a sum of money. The sheriff proceeded
to levy on the rice and directed the Warehouse Company to
deliver to him the deposited rice.
What advice will you give the Warehouse
Company? Explain (2%)
Assuming that a week prior to the levy, the
receipt was sold to a rice mill on the basis of which it filed
a claim with the sheriff. Would the rice mill have better
rights to the rice than the creditor? Explain your answer.
(2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The 1000 bags of rice were delivered to the
Warehouse Company by a merchant, and a negotiable
receipt was issued therefor. The rice cannot thereafter,
while in the possession of the Warehouse Company, be
attached by garnishment or otherwise, or be levied upon
under an execution unless the receipt be first surrendered to
the warehouseman, or its negotiation enjoined. The
Warehouse Company cannot be compelled to deliver the
actual possession of the rice until the receipt is surrendered
to it or impounded by the court.
Yes. The rice mill, as a holder for value of the
receipt, has a better right to the rice than the creditor. It is
the rice mill that can surrender the receipt which is in its
possession and can comply with the other requirements
which will oblige the warehouseman to deliver the rice,
namely, to sign a receipt for the delivery of the rice, and to
pay the warehousemans liens and fees and other charges.
Negotiable Documents of Title (1992)
For a cargo of machinery shipped from abroad to a sugar
central in Dumaguete, Negros Oriental, the Bill of Lading
(B/L) stipulated to shippers order, with notice of arrival
to be addressed to the Central. The cargo arrived at its
destination and was released to the Central without
surrender of the B/L on the basis of the latters
undertaking to hold the carrier free and harmless from any
liability.
Subsequently, a Bank to whom the central was indebted,
claimed the cargo and presented the original of the B/L
stating that the Central had failed to settle its obligations
with the Bank.
Was there misdelivery by the carrier to the sugar central
considering the non-surrender of the B/L? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
There was no misdelivery by the carrier since the cargo
was considered consigned to the Sugar central per the
Shippers Order (Eastern Shipping Lines v CA 190 s
512)
ALTERNATIVE ANSWER:
There was misdelivery. The B/L was a negotiable
document of title because it was to the Shippers Order.
Hence, the common carrier should have delivered the
cargo to the Central only upon surrender of the B/L. The
non-surrender of the B/L will make it liable to holders in
due course.
Ownership of Goods Stored (1992)
To guarantee the payment of a loan obtained from a bank,
Raul pledged 500 bales of tobacco deposited in a
warehouse to said bank and endorsed in blank the
warehouse receipt. Before Raul could pay for the loan, the
tobacco disappeared from the warehouse. Who should
bear the loss the pledgor or the bank? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The pledgor should bear the loss. In the pledge of a
warehouse receipt the ownership of the goods remain with
depositor or his transferee. Any contract or real security,
among them a pledge, does not amount to or result in an
assumption of risk of loss by the creditor. The Warehouse
Receipts Law did not deviate from this rule.
Right to the Goods (2005)
Jojo deposited several cartons of goods with SN Warehouse
Corporation. The corresponding warehouse receipt was issued
to the order of Jojo. He endorsed the warehouse receipt to EJ
who paid the value of the goods deposited. Before EJ could
withdraw the goods, Melchor informed SN Warehouse
Corporation that the goods belonged to him and were taken
by Jojo without his consent. Melchor wants to get the goods,
but EJ also wants to withdraw the same. (5%)
Who has a better right to the goods? Why?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
EJ has a better right to the goods, being covered by a
negotiable document of title, namely the warehouse
receipts issued to the "order of Jojo." Under the Sales
provisions of the Civil Code on negotiable documents of
title, and under the provisions of the Warehouse Receipts
Law, when goods deposited with the bailee are covered by
a negotiable document of title, the endorsement and
delivery of the document transfers ownership of the goods
to the transferee. By operation of law, the transferee
obtains the direct obligation of the bailee to hold the goods
in his name." (Art. 1513, Civil Code; Section 41,
Warehouse Receipts Law) Since EJ is the holder of the
warehouse receipt, he has the better right to the goods. SN
Warehouse is obliged to hold the goods in his name.
If SN Warehouse Corporation is uncertain as to
who is entitled to the property, what is the proper recourse
of the corporation? Explain.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Page 101 of 103 SN Warehouse can file an
INTERPLEADER to compel EJ and Melchor to litigate
against each other for the ownership of the goods. Sec. 17
of the Warehouse Receipts Law states, "If more than one
person claims the title or possession of the goods, the
warehouse may, either as a defense to an action brought
against him for non-delivery of the goods or as an original
suit, whichever is appropriate, require all known claimants
to interplead."
Unpaid Seller; Negotiation of the Receipt (1993)
A purchased from S 150 cavans of palay on credit. A
deposited the palay in Ws warehouse. W issued to A a
negotiable warehouse receipt in the name of A. Thereafter,
A negotiated the receipt to B who purchased the said
receipt for value and in good faith. 1) Who has a better
right to the deposit, S, the unpaid vendor or b, the
purchaser of the receipt for value and in good faith? Why?
2) When can the warehouseman be obliged to deliver the
palay to A?
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
1) B has a better right than S. The right of the unpaid
seller, S, to the goods was defeated by the act of A in
endorsing the receipt to B.
2) The warehouseman can be obliged to deliver the palay
to A if B negotiates back the receipt to A. In that case, A
becomes a holder again of the receipt, and A can comply
with Sec 8 of the Warehouse Receipts Law.
Validity of stipulations excusing warehouseman from
negligence (2000)
S stored hardware materials in the bonded warehouse of W,
a licensed warehouseman under the General Bonded
Warehouse Law (Act 3893 as amended). W issued the
corresponding warehouse receipt in the form he ordinarily
uses for such purpose in the course of his business. All the
essential terms required under Section 2 of the Warehouse
Receipts Law (Act 2137 as amended) are embodied in the
form. In addition, the receipt issued to S contains a
stipulation that W would not be responsible for the loss of
all or any portion of the hardware materials covered by the
receipt even if such loss is caused by the negligence of W or
his representatives or employees. S endorsed and
negotiated the warehouse receipt to B, who demanded
delivery of the goods. W could not deliver because the
goods were nowhere to be found in his warehouse. He
claims he is not liable because of the free-from-liability
clause stipulated in the receipt. Do you agree with Ws
contention? Explain. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
No. I do not agree with the contention of W. The
stipulation that W would not be responsible for the loss of
all or any portion of the hardware materials covered by the
receipt even if such loss is caused by the negligence of W
or his representative or employees is void. The law requires
that a warehouseman should exercise due diligence in the
care and custody of the things deposited in his warehouse.
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006) Page 102 of 103
Miscellaneous
Energy Regulatory Commission: Jurisdiction & Power
(2004)
CG, acustomer, sued MERALCO in the MM Regional
Trial Court to disclose the basis of the computation of the
purchased power adjustment (PPA). The trial court ruled it
had no jurisdiction over the case because, as contended by
the defendant, the customer not only demanded a
breakdown of MERALCO's bill with respect to PPA but
questioned as well the imposition of the PPA, a matter to
be decided by the Board of Energy, the regulatory agency
which should also have jurisdiction over the instant suit. Is
the trial court's ruling correct or not? Reason briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The trial court's ruling is correct. As held in Manila Electric
Company v. Court of Appeals, 271SCRA 417 (1997), the
Board of Energy had the power to regulate and fix power
rates to be charged by franchised electric utilities like
MERALCO. In fact pursuant to Executive Order No. 478
(April 17, 1998), this power has been transferred to the
Energy Regulatory Board (now the Energy Regulatory
Commission). Under Section 43(u) of the Electric Power
Industry Reform Act of 2001, the Energy Regulatory
Commission has original and exclusive jurisdiction over all
cases contesting power rates.
Four ACID Problems of Philippine Judiciary (2006)
In several policy addresses extensively covered by media
since his appointment on December 21, 2005, Chief
Justice Artemio V. Panganiban vowed to leave a judiciary
characterized by "four Ins" and to focus in solving the
"four ACID" problems that corrode the administration of
justice in our country. Explain this "four Ins" and "four
ACID" problems.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Upon assuming his office, Chief Justice Panganiban vowed
to lead a judiciary characterized by the "four Ins:" Integrity,
Independence, Industry and Intelligence; one that is morally
courageous to resist influence, interference, indifference and
insolence. He envisions a judiciary that is impervious to the
plague of undue influence brought about by kinship,
relationship, friendship and fellowship. He calls on the
judiciary to battle the "Four ACID" problems corroding our
justice system: (1) limited access to justice by the poor; (2)
corruption; (3) incompetence; and (4) delay in the delivery
of quality judgments. The judicial department should
discharge its functions with transparency, accountability and
dignity.
(NOTA BENE: It is respectfully
suggested that all Bar Candidates receive
a 2.5% bonus for the above question
regardless of the answer)
2. The Chief Justice also said that the judiciary must
"safeguard the liberty" and "nurture the prosperity" of our
people. Explain this philosophy. Cite Decisions of the
Supreme Court implementing each of these twin beacons
of the Chief Justice. (2.5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The Chief Justice's philosophy "Safeguarding Liberty,
Nurturing Prosperity" embodies the Supreme Court's
approach in decision-making in the exercise of its
constitutional power of judicial review which provides: In
cases involving liberty, the scales of justice should weight
heavily against government and in favor of the poor, the
oppressed, the marginalized, the dispossessed and the weak;
and that laws and action that restrict fundamental rights
come to the court "with a heavy presumption against their
constitutional validity. On the other hand, as a general rule,
the Supreme Court must adopt a deferential or respectful
attitude towards actions taken by the governmental agencies
that have primary responsibility for the economic
development of the country; and only when an act has been
clearly made or executed with grave abuse of discretion does
the Court get involved in policy issues.
Decisions implementing the "safeguarding of liberty" in-
clude those involving the constitutionality of Presidential
Proclamation No. 1017 (David v. Arroyo, G.R. No. 171390,
May 3, 2006); the validity of Calibrated Pre-emptive Response
(CPR) and B.P. Big. 880 or the Public Assembly Act (Bayan v.
Ermita, G.R. No. 169848, April 25, 2006); and the legality of
Executive Order No. 464 and the President's exercise of Executive
Privilege (Senate of the Philippines v. Ermita, G.R. No. 169777,
April 20, 2006).
On the other hand, cases that relate to "nurturing the
prosperity" of the people include the question the
constitutionality of the Mining Law (La Bugal-B'Laan v.
Ramos, G.R. No. 127882, Dec. 1, 2004) and the WTO
Agreement (Tanada v. Angara, G.R. 118295, May 2,1997).
Government Deregulation vs. Privatization of an Industry
(2004)
What is the difference between government deregulation
and the privatization of an industry? Explain briefly. (2%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Government deregulation is the relaxation or removal of
regulatory constraints on firms or individuals, with a view to
promoting competition and market-oriented approaches
toward pricing, output, entry, and other related economic
decisions.
Privatization of an industry refers to the transfer of
ownership and control by the government of assets, firms
and operations in an industry to private investors.
Political Law; WTO (1999)
Government plans to impose an additional duty on
imported sugar on top of the current tariff rate. The intent
is to ensure that the landed cost of sugar shall not be lower
than P800 per bag. This is the price at which locally
produced sugar would be sold in order to enable sugar
producers to realize reasonable profits. Without
Mercantile Law Bar Examination Q & A (1990-2006)
this additional duty, the current low price of sugar in the
world market will surely pull the domestic price to levels
lower than the cost to producer domestic sugar a
situation that could spell the demise of the Phil sugar
industry. a) Discuss the validity of this proposal to impose
an additional levy on imported sugar (3%) b) Would the
proposal be consistent with the tenets of the World Trade
Organization (WTO)? (3%)
Recommendation: Since the subject matter of these
two (2) questions is not included within the scope of
the Bar Questions in Mercantile Law, it is suggested
that whatever answer is given by the examinee, or the
lack of answer should be given full credit. If the
examinee gives a good answer, he should be given
additional credit.
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
a) The proposal to impose an additional duty on imported
sugar on top of the current tariff rate is valid, not being
prohibited by the Constitution. It would enable producers
to realize reasonable profits, and would allow the sugar
industry of the country to survive.
b) No. The proposal would not be consistent with the
tenets of the WTO which call for the liberalization of
trade. However, such proposal may be acceptable within
the allowable period under the WTO for adjustment of
the local industry
Power of the State: Regulating of Domestic Trade (2004)
In its exercise of police power and business regulation, the
legislature of LVM State passed a law prohibiting aliens
from engaging in domestic timber trade. Violators
including dummies would, after proper trial, be fined and
imprisoned or deported. Mrs. BC, a citizen of LVM but
married to ZC, an alien merchant of PNG, filed suit to
invalidate the law or exempt from its coverage their timber
business.
She contended that the law is, inter alia, gravely oppressive
and discriminatory. It violated the Universal Declaration of
Human Rights (UDHR) passed in 1948 by the United
Nations, of which LVM is a member, she said, as well as
the reciprocity provisions of the World Trade Organization
(WTO) Agreement of 1994, of which PNG and LVM are
parties. Aside from denying them equal protection,
according to BC, the law will also deprive her family their
livelihood without due process nor just compensation.
Assuming that the legal system of LVM is similar to ours,
would Mrs. BC's contention be tenable or not? Reason
briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
Mrs. BC's contention is not tenable. First, the UDHR does
not purport to limit the right of states (like LVM) to regulate
domestic trade. Second, the WTO Agreement involves
international trade between states or governments, not
domestic trade in timber or other commodities. Third,
nationality is an accepted norm for making classifications
that do not run counter to the
Page 103 of 103 equal protection of law clause of the
Constitution. Fourth, there is no impairment of due
process here because violators of the law will be punished
only after "proper trial." Fifth, the issue of "just
compensation" does not arise, because the property of
Mrs. BC is not being expropriated. On the contrary, as a
citizen of LVM, Mrs. BC is freely allowed to engage in
domestic timber trade in LVM.
Tariff and Customs Code: Violation of Customs Laws
(2004)
The Collector of Customs ordered the seizure and
forfeiture of new electronic appliances shipped by TON
Corp. from Hongkong for violation of customs laws
because they were falsely declared as used office equipment
and then undervalued for purposes of customs duties.
TON filed a complaint before the MM Regional Trial
Court for replevin, alleging that the Customs officials erred
in the classification and valuation of its shipment, as well as
in the issuance of the warrant of seizure. The Collector
moved to dismiss the suit for lack of jurisdiction on the
part of the trial court. Should the Collector's motion be
granted or denied? Reason briefly. (5%)
SUGGESTED ANSWER:
The Collector's motion should be granted. Under Section
602(g) of the Tariff and Customs Code, the Bureau of
Customs has exclusive original jurisdiction over seizure
and forfeiture cases under the tariff and customs laws.
NOTE: (This question is outside the coverage of the
Bar Examinations. It is therefore recommended that
whatever answer made by the candidate should be
given full credit.)